* NEWS: Document target described register support for PowerPC.
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,
3 @c 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006
4 @c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 @c
6 @c %**start of header
7 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
8 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
9 @setfilename gdb.info
10 @c
11 @include gdb-cfg.texi
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @syncodeindex ky cp
24
25 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
26 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
27 @syncodeindex vr cp
28 @syncodeindex fn cp
29
30 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
31 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
32 @set EDITION Ninth
33
34 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
35 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
36
37 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
38
39 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
40 @c manuals to an info tree.
41 @dircategory Software development
42 @direntry
43 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
44 @end direntry
45
46 @ifinfo
47 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
48
49
50 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
51 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
52 Version @value{GDBVN}.
53
54 Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,@*
55 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006@*
56 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
57
58 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
59 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
60 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
61 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
62 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
63 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
64
65 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
66 this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
67 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
68 @end ifinfo
69
70 @titlepage
71 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
72 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
73 @sp 1
74 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
75 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
76 @page
77 @tex
78 {\parskip=0pt
79 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to bug-gdb\@gnu.org.)\par
80 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
81 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
82 }
83 @end tex
84
85 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
86 Copyright @copyright{} 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995,
87 1996, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2006
88 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
89 @sp 2
90 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
91 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
92 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
93 ISBN 1-882114-77-9 @*
94
95 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
96 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
97 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
98 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
99 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
100 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
101
102 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
103 this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
104 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
105 @page
106 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
107 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
108 software in general. We will miss him.
109 @end titlepage
110 @page
111
112 @ifnottex
113 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
114
115 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
116
117 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
118
119 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} Version
120 @value{GDBVN}.
121
122 Copyright (C) 1988-2006 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
123
124 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
125 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
126 software in general. We will miss him.
127
128 @menu
129 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
130 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
131
132 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
133 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
134 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
135 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
136 * Stack:: Examining the stack
137 * Source:: Examining source files
138 * Data:: Examining data
139 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
140 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
141 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
142
143 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
144
145 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
146 * Altering:: Altering execution
147 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
148 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
149 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
150 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
151 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
152 * Sequences:: Canned sequences of commands
153 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
154 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
155 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
156 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
157 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
158
159 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
160
161 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
162 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
163 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
164 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
165 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
166 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
167 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
168 * Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to
169 @value{GDBN}
170 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
171 how you can copy and share GDB
172 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
173 * Index:: Index
174 @end menu
175
176 @end ifnottex
177
178 @contents
179
180 @node Summary
181 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
182
183 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
184 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
185 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
186
187 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
188 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
189
190 @itemize @bullet
191 @item
192 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
193
194 @item
195 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
196
197 @item
198 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
199
200 @item
201 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
202 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
203 @end itemize
204
205 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
206 For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}.
207 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
208
209 @cindex Modula-2
210 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
211 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
212
213 @cindex Pascal
214 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
215 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
216 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
217 syntax.
218
219 @cindex Fortran
220 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
221 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
222 underscore.
223
224 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
225 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
226
227 @menu
228 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
229 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
230 @end menu
231
232 @node Free Software
233 @unnumberedsec Free Software
234
235 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
236 General Public License
237 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
238 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
239 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
240 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
241 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
242 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
243
244 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
245 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
246 from anyone else.
247
248 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
249
250 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
251 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
252 include with the free software. Many of our most important
253 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
254 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
255 when an important free software package does not come with a free
256 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
257 gaps today.
258
259 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
260 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
261 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
262 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
263 them from the free software world.
264
265 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
266 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
267 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
268 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
269 contract to make it non-free.
270
271 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
272 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
273 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
274 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
275 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
276 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
277 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
278
279 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
280 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
281 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
282 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
283
284 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
285 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
286 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
287 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
288 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
289 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
290 community.
291
292 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
293 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
294 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
295 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
296 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
297 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
298 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
299 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
300 of the manual.
301
302 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
303 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
304 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
305 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
306 manual to replace it.
307
308 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
309 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
310 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
311 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
312 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
313 the free software community.
314
315 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
316 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
317 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
318 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
319 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
320 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
321 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
322 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
323 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
324
325 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
326 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
327 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
328 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
329 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
330 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
331 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
332 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
333
334 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
335 published by other publishers, at
336 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
337
338 @node Contributors
339 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
340
341 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
342 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
343 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
344 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
345 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
346 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
347 blow-by-blow account.
348
349 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
350
351 @quotation
352 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
353 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
354 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
355 @end quotation
356
357 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
358 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
359 releases:
360 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
361 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
362 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
363 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
364 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
365 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
366 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
367 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
368 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
369
370 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
371 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
372
373 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
374 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
375 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
376 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
377 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
378
379 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
380 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
381 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
382
383 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
384 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
385
386 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
387
388 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
389 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
390 support.
391 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
392 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
393 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
394 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
395 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
396 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
397 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
398 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
399 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
400 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
401 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
402 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
403 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
404 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
405 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
406 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
407
408 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
409
410 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
411 libraries.
412
413 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
414 about several machine instruction sets.
415
416 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
417 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
418 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
419 and RDI targets, respectively.
420
421 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
422 command-line editing and command history.
423
424 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
425 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
426
427 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
428 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
429 symbols.
430
431 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
432 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
433
434 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
435
436 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
437 processors.
438
439 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
440
441 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
442
443 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
444
445 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
446 watchpoints.
447
448 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
449
450 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
451
452 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
453 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
454
455 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
456 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
457 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
458 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
459 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
460 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
461 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
462
463 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
464 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
465
466 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
467 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
468 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
469 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
470 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
471 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
472 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
473 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
474 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
475 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
476 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
477 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
478 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
479 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
480 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
481
482 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
483 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
484
485 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
486 Hat.
487
488 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
489 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
490 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
491 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
492 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
493 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
494
495 Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
496 unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
497 frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
498 Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
499 libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
500 trad unwinders. The architecture-specific changes, each involving a
501 complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
502 Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
503 Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
504 Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
505 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
506 Weigand.
507
508 Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
509 Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
510 who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
511 Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
512
513 @node Sample Session
514 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
515
516 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
517 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
518 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
519
520 @iftex
521 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
522 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
523 @end iftex
524
525 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
526 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
527
528 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
529 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
530 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
531 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
532 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
533 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
534 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
535 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
536 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
537
538 @smallexample
539 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
540 $ @b{./m4}
541 @b{define(foo,0000)}
542
543 @b{foo}
544 0000
545 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
546
547 @b{bar}
548 0000
549 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
550
551 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
552 @b{baz}
553 @b{Ctrl-d}
554 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
555 @end smallexample
556
557 @noindent
558 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
559
560 @smallexample
561 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
562 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
563 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
564 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
565 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
566 the conditions.
567 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
568 for details.
569
570 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
571 (@value{GDBP})
572 @end smallexample
573
574 @noindent
575 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
576 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
577 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
578 that examples fit in this manual.
579
580 @smallexample
581 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
582 @end smallexample
583
584 @noindent
585 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
586 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
587 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
588 @code{break} command.
589
590 @smallexample
591 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
592 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
593 @end smallexample
594
595 @noindent
596 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
597 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
598 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
599
600 @smallexample
601 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
602 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
603 @b{define(foo,0000)}
604
605 @b{foo}
606 0000
607 @end smallexample
608
609 @noindent
610 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
611 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
612 context where it stops.
613
614 @smallexample
615 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
616
617 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
618 at builtin.c:879
619 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
620 @end smallexample
621
622 @noindent
623 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
624 the next line of the current function.
625
626 @smallexample
627 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
628 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
629 : nil,
630 @end smallexample
631
632 @noindent
633 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
634 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
635 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
636 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
637
638 @smallexample
639 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
640 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
641 at input.c:530
642 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
643 @end smallexample
644
645 @noindent
646 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
647 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
648 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
649 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
650 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
651 stack frame for each active subroutine.
652
653 @smallexample
654 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
655 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
656 at input.c:530
657 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
658 at builtin.c:882
659 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
660 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
661 at macro.c:71
662 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
663 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
664 @end smallexample
665
666 @noindent
667 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
668 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
669 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
670
671 @smallexample
672 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
673 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
674 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
675 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
676 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
677 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
678 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
679 : xstrdup(rq);
680 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
681 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
682 @end smallexample
683
684 @noindent
685 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
686 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
687 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
688 (@code{print}) to see their values.
689
690 @smallexample
691 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
692 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
693 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
694 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
695 @end smallexample
696
697 @noindent
698 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
699 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
700 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
701
702 @smallexample
703 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
704 533 xfree(rquote);
705 534
706 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
707 : xstrdup (lq);
708 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
709 : xstrdup (rq);
710 537
711 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
712 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
713 540 @}
714 541
715 542 void
716 @end smallexample
717
718 @noindent
719 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
720 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
721
722 @smallexample
723 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
724 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
725 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
726 540 @}
727 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
728 $3 = 9
729 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
730 $4 = 7
731 @end smallexample
732
733 @noindent
734 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
735 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
736 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
737 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
738 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
739 assignments.
740
741 @smallexample
742 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
743 $5 = 7
744 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
745 $6 = 9
746 @end smallexample
747
748 @noindent
749 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
750 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
751 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
752 example that caused trouble initially:
753
754 @smallexample
755 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
756 Continuing.
757
758 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
759
760 baz
761 0000
762 @end smallexample
763
764 @noindent
765 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
766 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
767 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
768
769 @smallexample
770 @b{Ctrl-d}
771 Program exited normally.
772 @end smallexample
773
774 @noindent
775 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
776 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
777 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
778
779 @smallexample
780 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
781 @end smallexample
782
783 @node Invocation
784 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
785
786 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
787 The essentials are:
788 @itemize @bullet
789 @item
790 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
791 @item
792 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
793 @end itemize
794
795 @menu
796 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
797 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
798 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
799 * Logging Output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
800 @end menu
801
802 @node Invoking GDB
803 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
804
805 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
806 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
807
808 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
809 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
810
811 The command-line options described here are designed
812 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
813 options may effectively be unavailable.
814
815 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
816 specifying an executable program:
817
818 @smallexample
819 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
820 @end smallexample
821
822 @noindent
823 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
824 specified:
825
826 @smallexample
827 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
828 @end smallexample
829
830 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
831 to debug a running process:
832
833 @smallexample
834 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
835 @end smallexample
836
837 @noindent
838 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
839 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
840
841 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
842 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
843 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
844 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
845 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
846
847 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
848 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
849 option processing.
850 @smallexample
851 @value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
852 @end smallexample
853 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
854 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
855
856 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
857 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}:
858
859 @smallexample
860 @value{GDBP} -silent
861 @end smallexample
862
863 @noindent
864 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
865 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
866
867 @noindent
868 Type
869
870 @smallexample
871 @value{GDBP} -help
872 @end smallexample
873
874 @noindent
875 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
876 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
877
878 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
879 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
880 @samp{-x} option is used.
881
882
883 @menu
884 * File Options:: Choosing files
885 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
886 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
887 @end menu
888
889 @node File Options
890 @subsection Choosing Files
891
892 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
893 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
894 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
895 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
896 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
897 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
898 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
899 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
900 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
901 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
902 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
903 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
904 prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
905
906 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
907 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
908 argument and ignore it.
909
910 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
911 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
912 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
913 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
914 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
915
916 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
917 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
918 @c it.
919
920 @table @code
921 @item -symbols @var{file}
922 @itemx -s @var{file}
923 @cindex @code{--symbols}
924 @cindex @code{-s}
925 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
926
927 @item -exec @var{file}
928 @itemx -e @var{file}
929 @cindex @code{--exec}
930 @cindex @code{-e}
931 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
932 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
933
934 @item -se @var{file}
935 @cindex @code{--se}
936 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
937 file.
938
939 @item -core @var{file}
940 @itemx -c @var{file}
941 @cindex @code{--core}
942 @cindex @code{-c}
943 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
944
945 @item -c @var{number}
946 @item -pid @var{number}
947 @itemx -p @var{number}
948 @cindex @code{--pid}
949 @cindex @code{-p}
950 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
951 If there is no such process, @value{GDBN} will attempt to open a core
952 file named @var{number}.
953
954 @item -command @var{file}
955 @itemx -x @var{file}
956 @cindex @code{--command}
957 @cindex @code{-x}
958 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}. @xref{Command
959 Files,, Command files}.
960
961 @item -eval-command @var{command}
962 @itemx -ex @var{command}
963 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
964 @cindex @code{-ex}
965 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
966
967 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
968 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
969
970 @smallexample
971 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
972 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
973 @end smallexample
974
975 @item -directory @var{directory}
976 @itemx -d @var{directory}
977 @cindex @code{--directory}
978 @cindex @code{-d}
979 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
980
981 @item -r
982 @itemx -readnow
983 @cindex @code{--readnow}
984 @cindex @code{-r}
985 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
986 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
987 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
988
989 @end table
990
991 @node Mode Options
992 @subsection Choosing Modes
993
994 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
995 batch mode or quiet mode.
996
997 @table @code
998 @item -nx
999 @itemx -n
1000 @cindex @code{--nx}
1001 @cindex @code{-n}
1002 Do not execute commands found in any initialization files. Normally,
1003 @value{GDBN} executes the commands in these files after all the command
1004 options and arguments have been processed. @xref{Command Files,,Command
1005 Files}.
1006
1007 @item -quiet
1008 @itemx -silent
1009 @itemx -q
1010 @cindex @code{--quiet}
1011 @cindex @code{--silent}
1012 @cindex @code{-q}
1013 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1014 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1015
1016 @item -batch
1017 @cindex @code{--batch}
1018 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1019 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1020 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1021 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1022 in the command files.
1023
1024 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1025 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1026 make this more useful, the message
1027
1028 @smallexample
1029 Program exited normally.
1030 @end smallexample
1031
1032 @noindent
1033 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1034 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1035 mode.
1036
1037 @item -batch-silent
1038 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1039 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1040 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1041 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1042 for an interactive session.
1043
1044 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1045 messages, for example.
1046
1047 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1048 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1049
1050 @item -return-child-result
1051 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1052 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1053 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1054
1055 @itemize @bullet
1056 @item
1057 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1058 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1059 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1060 @item
1061 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1062 @item
1063 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1064 the exit code will be -1.
1065 @end itemize
1066
1067 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1068 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1069 interface.
1070
1071 @item -nowindows
1072 @itemx -nw
1073 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1074 @cindex @code{-nw}
1075 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1076 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1077 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1078
1079 @item -windows
1080 @itemx -w
1081 @cindex @code{--windows}
1082 @cindex @code{-w}
1083 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1084 used if possible.
1085
1086 @item -cd @var{directory}
1087 @cindex @code{--cd}
1088 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1089 instead of the current directory.
1090
1091 @item -fullname
1092 @itemx -f
1093 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1094 @cindex @code{-f}
1095 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1096 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1097 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1098 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1099 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1100 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1101 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1102 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1103 frame.
1104
1105 @item -epoch
1106 @cindex @code{--epoch}
1107 The Epoch Emacs-@value{GDBN} interface sets this option when it runs
1108 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to modify its print
1109 routines so as to allow Epoch to display values of expressions in a
1110 separate window.
1111
1112 @item -annotate @var{level}
1113 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1114 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1115 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1116 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1117 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1118 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1119 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1120 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1121 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1122
1123 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1124 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1125
1126 @item --args
1127 @cindex @code{--args}
1128 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1129 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1130 This option stops option processing.
1131
1132 @item -baud @var{bps}
1133 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1134 @cindex @code{--baud}
1135 @cindex @code{-b}
1136 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1137 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1138
1139 @item -l @var{timeout}
1140 @cindex @code{-l}
1141 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1142 for remote debugging.
1143
1144 @item -tty @var{device}
1145 @itemx -t @var{device}
1146 @cindex @code{--tty}
1147 @cindex @code{-t}
1148 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1149 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1150
1151 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1152 @item -tui
1153 @cindex @code{--tui}
1154 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1155 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1156 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1157 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Alternatively, the
1158 Text User Interface can be enabled by invoking the program
1159 @samp{@value{GDBTUI}}. Do not use this option if you run @value{GDBN} from
1160 Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1161
1162 @c @item -xdb
1163 @c @cindex @code{--xdb}
1164 @c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
1165 @c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
1166 @c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
1167 @c systems.
1168
1169 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1170 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1171 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1172 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1173 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1174 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1175
1176 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1177 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1178 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1179 previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1180 selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier
1181 @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
1182
1183 @item -write
1184 @cindex @code{--write}
1185 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1186 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1187 (@pxref{Patching}).
1188
1189 @item -statistics
1190 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1191 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1192 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1193
1194 @item -version
1195 @cindex @code{--version}
1196 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1197 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1198
1199 @end table
1200
1201 @node Startup
1202 @subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup
1203 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1204
1205 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1206
1207 @enumerate
1208 @item
1209 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1210 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1211
1212 @item
1213 @cindex init file
1214 Reads the @dfn{init file} (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1215 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1216 @code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1217 that file.
1218
1219 @item
1220 Processes command line options and operands.
1221
1222 @item
1223 Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1224 working directory. This is only done if the current directory is
1225 different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1226 init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1227 to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1228 @value{GDBN}.
1229
1230 @item
1231 Reads command files specified by the @samp{-x} option. @xref{Command
1232 Files}, for more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1233
1234 @item
1235 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1236 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1237 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1238 @end enumerate
1239
1240 Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1241 Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1242 file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1243 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1244 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1245 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing Modes}).
1246
1247 @cindex init file name
1248 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1249 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1250 The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1251 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1252 the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1253 ports of @value{GDBN} use the standard name, but if they find a
1254 @file{gdb.ini} file, they warn you about that and suggest to rename
1255 the file to the standard name.
1256
1257
1258 @node Quitting GDB
1259 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1260 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1261 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1262
1263 @table @code
1264 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1265 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1266 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1267 @itemx q
1268 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1269 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1270 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1271 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1272 error code.
1273 @end table
1274
1275 @cindex interrupt
1276 An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1277 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1278 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1279 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1280 until a time when it is safe.
1281
1282 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1283 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1284 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
1285
1286 @node Shell Commands
1287 @section Shell Commands
1288
1289 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1290 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1291 just use the @code{shell} command.
1292
1293 @table @code
1294 @kindex shell
1295 @cindex shell escape
1296 @item shell @var{command string}
1297 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command string}.
1298 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1299 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1300 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1301 @end table
1302
1303 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1304 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1305 @value{GDBN}:
1306
1307 @table @code
1308 @kindex make
1309 @cindex calling make
1310 @item make @var{make-args}
1311 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1312 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1313 @end table
1314
1315 @node Logging Output
1316 @section Logging Output
1317 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1318 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1319
1320 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1321 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1322
1323 @table @code
1324 @kindex set logging
1325 @item set logging on
1326 Enable logging.
1327 @item set logging off
1328 Disable logging.
1329 @cindex logging file name
1330 @item set logging file @var{file}
1331 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1332 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1333 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1334 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1335 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1336 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1337 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1338 @kindex show logging
1339 @item show logging
1340 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1341 @end table
1342
1343 @node Commands
1344 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1345
1346 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1347 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1348 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1349 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1350 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1351
1352 @menu
1353 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1354 * Completion:: Command completion
1355 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1356 @end menu
1357
1358 @node Command Syntax
1359 @section Command Syntax
1360
1361 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1362 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1363 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1364 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1365 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1366 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1367
1368 @cindex abbreviation
1369 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1370 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1371 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1372 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1373 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1374 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1375 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1376
1377 @cindex repeating commands
1378 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1379 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1380 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1381 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1382 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1383 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1384 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1385
1386 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1387 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1388 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1389
1390 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1391 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1392 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}). Since it is easy to press one
1393 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1394 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1395
1396 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1397 @cindex comment
1398 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1399 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1400 Files,,Command Files}).
1401
1402 @cindex repeating command sequences
1403 @kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1404 The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1405 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1406 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1407 for editing.
1408
1409 @node Completion
1410 @section Command Completion
1411
1412 @cindex completion
1413 @cindex word completion
1414 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1415 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1416 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1417 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1418
1419 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1420 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1421 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1422 enter it). For example, if you type
1423
1424 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1425 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1426 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1427 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1428 @smallexample
1429 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1430 @end smallexample
1431
1432 @noindent
1433 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1434 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1435
1436 @smallexample
1437 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1438 @end smallexample
1439
1440 @noindent
1441 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1442 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1443 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1444 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1445 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1446 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1447
1448 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1449 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1450 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1451 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1452 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1453 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1454 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1455 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1456 example:
1457
1458 @smallexample
1459 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1460 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1461 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1462 make_abs_section make_function_type
1463 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1464 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1465 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1466 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1467 @end smallexample
1468
1469 @noindent
1470 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1471 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1472 command.
1473
1474 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1475 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1476 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1477 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1478 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1479
1480 @cindex quotes in commands
1481 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1482 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1483 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1484 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1485 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1486 @value{GDBN} commands.
1487
1488 The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1489 name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1490 overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1491 by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1492 may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1493 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1494 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1495 word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1496 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1497 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1498 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1499
1500 @smallexample
1501 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1502 bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1503 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1504 @end smallexample
1505
1506 In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1507 quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1508 completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1509 place:
1510
1511 @smallexample
1512 (@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1513 @exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1514 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1515 @end smallexample
1516
1517 @noindent
1518 In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1519 you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1520 completion on an overloaded symbol.
1521
1522 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus
1523 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1524 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1525 see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
1526
1527
1528 @node Help
1529 @section Getting Help
1530 @cindex online documentation
1531 @kindex help
1532
1533 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1534 using the command @code{help}.
1535
1536 @table @code
1537 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1538 @item help
1539 @itemx h
1540 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1541 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1542
1543 @smallexample
1544 (@value{GDBP}) help
1545 List of classes of commands:
1546
1547 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1548 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1549 data -- Examining data
1550 files -- Specifying and examining files
1551 internals -- Maintenance commands
1552 obscure -- Obscure features
1553 running -- Running the program
1554 stack -- Examining the stack
1555 status -- Status inquiries
1556 support -- Support facilities
1557 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without
1558 stopping the program
1559 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1560
1561 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1562 commands in that class.
1563 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1564 documentation.
1565 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1566 (@value{GDBP})
1567 @end smallexample
1568 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1569
1570 @item help @var{class}
1571 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1572 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1573 help display for the class @code{status}:
1574
1575 @smallexample
1576 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1577 Status inquiries.
1578
1579 List of commands:
1580
1581 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1582 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1583 info -- Generic command for showing things
1584 about the program being debugged
1585 show -- Generic command for showing things
1586 about the debugger
1587
1588 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1589 documentation.
1590 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1591 (@value{GDBP})
1592 @end smallexample
1593
1594 @item help @var{command}
1595 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1596 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1597
1598 @kindex apropos
1599 @item apropos @var{args}
1600 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1601 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1602 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1603
1604 @smallexample
1605 apropos reload
1606 @end smallexample
1607
1608 @noindent
1609 results in:
1610
1611 @smallexample
1612 @c @group
1613 set symbol-reloading -- Set dynamic symbol table reloading
1614 multiple times in one run
1615 show symbol-reloading -- Show dynamic symbol table reloading
1616 multiple times in one run
1617 @c @end group
1618 @end smallexample
1619
1620 @kindex complete
1621 @item complete @var{args}
1622 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1623 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1624 command you want completed. For example:
1625
1626 @smallexample
1627 complete i
1628 @end smallexample
1629
1630 @noindent results in:
1631
1632 @smallexample
1633 @group
1634 if
1635 ignore
1636 info
1637 inspect
1638 @end group
1639 @end smallexample
1640
1641 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1642 @end table
1643
1644 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1645 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1646 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1647 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1648 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Index point to
1649 all the sub-commands. @xref{Index}.
1650
1651 @c @group
1652 @table @code
1653 @kindex info
1654 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1655 @item info
1656 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1657 program. For example, you can list the arguments given to your program
1658 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1659 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1660 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1661 @w{@code{help info}}.
1662
1663 @kindex set
1664 @item set
1665 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1666 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1667 @code{set prompt $}.
1668
1669 @kindex show
1670 @item show
1671 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1672 @value{GDBN} itself.
1673 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1674 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1675 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1676 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1677
1678 @kindex info set
1679 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1680 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1681 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1682 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1683 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1684 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1685 @end table
1686 @c @end group
1687
1688 Here are three miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1689 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1690
1691 @table @code
1692 @kindex show version
1693 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1694 @item show version
1695 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1696 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1697 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1698 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1699 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1700 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1701 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1702 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1703 @value{GDBN}.
1704
1705 @kindex show copying
1706 @kindex info copying
1707 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1708 @item show copying
1709 @itemx info copying
1710 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1711
1712 @kindex show warranty
1713 @kindex info warranty
1714 @item show warranty
1715 @itemx info warranty
1716 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1717 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1718
1719 @end table
1720
1721 @node Running
1722 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1723
1724 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1725 debugging information when you compile it.
1726
1727 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1728 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1729 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1730 kill a child process.
1731
1732 @menu
1733 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1734 * Starting:: Starting your program
1735 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1736 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1737
1738 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1739 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1740 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1741 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1742
1743 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1744 * Processes:: Debugging programs with multiple processes
1745 * Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1746 @end menu
1747
1748 @node Compilation
1749 @section Compiling for Debugging
1750
1751 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1752 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1753 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1754 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1755 and addresses in the executable code.
1756
1757 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1758 the compiler.
1759
1760 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
1761 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, many
1762 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
1763 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1764 executables containing debugging information.
1765
1766 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1767 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1768 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1769 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1770 in pushing your luck.
1771
1772 @cindex optimized code, debugging
1773 @cindex debugging optimized code
1774 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
1775 optimizer is rearranging your code; the debugger shows you what is
1776 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
1777 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
1778 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
1779 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
1780
1781 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
1782 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
1783 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
1784 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
1785 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
1786
1787 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1788 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1789 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1790
1791 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
1792 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
1793 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
1794 the @option{-g} flag alone, because this information is rather large.
1795 Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
1796 provides macro information if you specify the options
1797 @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3}; the former option requests
1798 debugging information in the Dwarf 2 format, and the latter requests
1799 ``extra information''. In the future, we hope to find more compact
1800 ways to represent macro information, so that it can be included with
1801 @option{-g} alone.
1802
1803 @need 2000
1804 @node Starting
1805 @section Starting your Program
1806 @cindex starting
1807 @cindex running
1808
1809 @table @code
1810 @kindex run
1811 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
1812 @item run
1813 @itemx r
1814 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1815 You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1816 argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1817 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1818 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
1819
1820 @end table
1821
1822 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1823 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1824 that process run your program. (In environments without processes,
1825 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program.)
1826
1827 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
1828 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
1829 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
1830 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
1831 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
1832 divided into four categories:
1833
1834 @table @asis
1835 @item The @emph{arguments.}
1836 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
1837 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
1838 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
1839 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
1840 the arguments.
1841 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
1842 @code{SHELL} environment variable.
1843 @xref{Arguments, ,Your Program's Arguments}.
1844
1845 @item The @emph{environment.}
1846 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
1847 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
1848 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
1849 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}.
1850
1851 @item The @emph{working directory.}
1852 Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
1853 the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
1854 @xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working Directory}.
1855
1856 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
1857 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
1858 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
1859 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
1860 set a different device for your program.
1861 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}.
1862
1863 @cindex pipes
1864 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
1865 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
1866 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
1867 wrong program.
1868 @end table
1869
1870 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
1871 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion
1872 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
1873 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
1874 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
1875
1876 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
1877 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
1878 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
1879 your current breakpoints.
1880
1881 @table @code
1882 @kindex start
1883 @item start
1884 @cindex run to main procedure
1885 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
1886 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
1887 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
1888 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
1889 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
1890 procedure, depending on the language used.
1891
1892 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
1893 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
1894 the @samp{run} command.
1895
1896 @cindex elaboration phase
1897 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
1898 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
1899 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
1900 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
1901 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
1902 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
1903 will remain to halt execution.
1904
1905 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
1906 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
1907 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
1908 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
1909 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
1910
1911 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
1912 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution of
1913 your program too late, as the program would have already completed the
1914 elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, insert breakpoints in your
1915 elaboration code before running your program.
1916 @end table
1917
1918 @node Arguments
1919 @section Your Program's Arguments
1920
1921 @cindex arguments (to your program)
1922 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
1923 @code{run} command.
1924 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
1925 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
1926 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
1927 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
1928 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
1929
1930 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
1931 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
1932 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
1933 the program, not by the shell.
1934
1935 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
1936 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
1937
1938 @table @code
1939 @kindex set args
1940 @item set args
1941 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
1942 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
1943 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
1944 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
1945 it again without arguments.
1946
1947 @kindex show args
1948 @item show args
1949 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
1950 @end table
1951
1952 @node Environment
1953 @section Your Program's Environment
1954
1955 @cindex environment (of your program)
1956 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
1957 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
1958 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
1959 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
1960 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
1961 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
1962 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
1963
1964 @table @code
1965 @kindex path
1966 @item path @var{directory}
1967 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
1968 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
1969 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
1970 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
1971 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
1972 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
1973 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
1974
1975 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
1976 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
1977 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
1978 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
1979 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
1980 @var{directory} to the search path.
1981 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
1982 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
1983
1984 @kindex show paths
1985 @item show paths
1986 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
1987 environment variable).
1988
1989 @kindex show environment
1990 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
1991 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
1992 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
1993 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
1994 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
1995
1996 @kindex set environment
1997 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
1998 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
1999 changes for your program only, not for @value{GDBN} itself. @var{value} may
2000 be any string; the values of environment variables are just strings, and
2001 any interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
2002 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2003 null value.
2004 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2005 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2006
2007 For example, this command:
2008
2009 @smallexample
2010 set env USER = foo
2011 @end smallexample
2012
2013 @noindent
2014 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2015 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2016 are not actually required.)
2017
2018 @kindex unset environment
2019 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2020 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2021 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2022 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2023 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2024 @end table
2025
2026 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2027 the shell indicated
2028 by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it exists (or
2029 @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable names a shell
2030 that runs an initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, or
2031 @file{.bashrc} for BASH---any variables you set in that file affect
2032 your program. You may wish to move setting of environment variables to
2033 files that are only run when you sign on, such as @file{.login} or
2034 @file{.profile}.
2035
2036 @node Working Directory
2037 @section Your Program's Working Directory
2038
2039 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2040 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
2041 working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
2042 The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
2043 from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
2044 working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
2045
2046 The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
2047 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2048 Specify Files}.
2049
2050 @table @code
2051 @kindex cd
2052 @cindex change working directory
2053 @item cd @var{directory}
2054 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}.
2055
2056 @kindex pwd
2057 @item pwd
2058 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2059 @end table
2060
2061 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2062 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2063 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} is
2064 configured with the @file{/proc} support, you can use the @code{info
2065 proc} command (@pxref{SVR4 Process Information}) to find out the
2066 current working directory of the debuggee.
2067
2068 @node Input/Output
2069 @section Your Program's Input and Output
2070
2071 @cindex redirection
2072 @cindex i/o
2073 @cindex terminal
2074 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2075 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2076 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2077 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2078 running your program.
2079
2080 @table @code
2081 @kindex info terminal
2082 @item info terminal
2083 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2084 program is using.
2085 @end table
2086
2087 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2088 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2089
2090 @smallexample
2091 run > outfile
2092 @end smallexample
2093
2094 @noindent
2095 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2096
2097 @kindex tty
2098 @cindex controlling terminal
2099 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2100 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2101 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2102 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2103 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2104
2105 @smallexample
2106 tty /dev/ttyb
2107 @end smallexample
2108
2109 @noindent
2110 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2111 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2112 that as their controlling terminal.
2113
2114 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2115 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2116 terminal.
2117
2118 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2119 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2120 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2121 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2122
2123 @cindex inferior tty
2124 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2125 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2126 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2127 program.
2128
2129 @table @code
2130 @item set inferior-tty /dev/ttyb
2131 @kindex set inferior-tty
2132 Set the tty for the program being debugged to /dev/ttyb.
2133
2134 @item show inferior-tty
2135 @kindex show inferior-tty
2136 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2137 @end table
2138
2139 @node Attach
2140 @section Debugging an Already-running Process
2141 @kindex attach
2142 @cindex attach
2143
2144 @table @code
2145 @item attach @var{process-id}
2146 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2147 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2148 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2149 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2150 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2151
2152 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2153 executing the command.
2154 @end table
2155
2156 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2157 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2158 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2159 also have permission to send the process a signal.
2160
2161 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2162 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2163 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2164 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}). You can also use
2165 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2166 Specify Files}.
2167
2168 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2169 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2170 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2171 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2172 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2173 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2174 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2175
2176 @table @code
2177 @kindex detach
2178 @item detach
2179 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2180 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2181 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2182 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2183 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2184 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2185 executing the command.
2186 @end table
2187
2188 If you exit @value{GDBN} while you have an attached process, you detach
2189 that process. If you use the @code{run} command, you kill that process.
2190 By default, @value{GDBN} asks for confirmation if you try to do either of these
2191 things; you can control whether or not you need to confirm by using the
2192 @code{set confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
2193 Messages}).
2194
2195 @node Kill Process
2196 @section Killing the Child Process
2197
2198 @table @code
2199 @kindex kill
2200 @item kill
2201 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2202 @end table
2203
2204 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2205 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2206 is running.
2207
2208 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2209 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2210 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2211 outside the debugger.
2212
2213 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2214 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2215 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2216 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2217 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2218 breakpoint settings).
2219
2220 @node Threads
2221 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads
2222
2223 @cindex threads of execution
2224 @cindex multiple threads
2225 @cindex switching threads
2226 In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
2227 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2228 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2229 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2230 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2231 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2232 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2233
2234 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2235 programs:
2236
2237 @itemize @bullet
2238 @item automatic notification of new threads
2239 @item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
2240 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2241 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
2242 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2243 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2244 @end itemize
2245
2246 @quotation
2247 @emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
2248 @value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
2249 If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
2250 effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
2251 from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
2252 like this:
2253
2254 @smallexample
2255 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2256 (@value{GDBP}) thread 1
2257 Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
2258 see the IDs of currently known threads.
2259 @end smallexample
2260 @c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
2261 @c doesn't support threads"?
2262 @end quotation
2263
2264 @cindex focus of debugging
2265 @cindex current thread
2266 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2267 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2268 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2269 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2270 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2271
2272 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2273 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2274 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2275 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2276 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2277 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2278 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2279 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2280 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2281 @sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see
2282
2283 @smallexample
2284 [New Thread 46912507313328 (LWP 25582)]
2285 @end smallexample
2286
2287 @noindent
2288 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
2289 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2290 further qualifier.
2291
2292 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2293 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2294 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2295 @c program?
2296 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2297 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2298 @c threads ab initio?
2299
2300 @cindex thread number
2301 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2302 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2303 number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
2304
2305 @table @code
2306 @kindex info threads
2307 @item info threads
2308 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2309 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2310
2311 @enumerate
2312 @item
2313 the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2314
2315 @item
2316 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2317
2318 @item
2319 the current stack frame summary for that thread
2320 @end enumerate
2321
2322 @noindent
2323 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2324 indicates the current thread.
2325
2326 For example,
2327 @end table
2328 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2329
2330 @smallexample
2331 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2332 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2333 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2334 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2335 at threadtest.c:68
2336 @end smallexample
2337
2338 On HP-UX systems:
2339
2340 @cindex debugging multithreaded programs (on HP-UX)
2341 @cindex thread identifier (GDB), on HP-UX
2342 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2343 number---a small integer assigned in thread-creation order---with each
2344 thread in your program.
2345
2346 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message, on HP-UX
2347 @cindex thread identifier (system), on HP-UX
2348 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2349 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2350 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2351 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2352 both @value{GDBN}'s thread number and the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2353 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2354 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2355 HP-UX, you see
2356
2357 @smallexample
2358 [New thread 2 (system thread 26594)]
2359 @end smallexample
2360
2361 @noindent
2362 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread.
2363
2364 @table @code
2365 @kindex info threads (HP-UX)
2366 @item info threads
2367 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2368 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2369
2370 @enumerate
2371 @item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2372
2373 @item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2374
2375 @item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2376 @end enumerate
2377
2378 @noindent
2379 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2380 indicates the current thread.
2381
2382 For example,
2383 @end table
2384 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2385
2386 @smallexample
2387 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2388 * 3 system thread 26607 worker (wptr=0x7b09c318 "@@") \@*
2389 at quicksort.c:137
2390 2 system thread 26606 0x7b0030d8 in __ksleep () \@*
2391 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2392 1 system thread 27905 0x7b003498 in _brk () \@*
2393 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2394 @end smallexample
2395
2396 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
2397 Solaris-specific command:
2398
2399 @table @code
2400 @item maint info sol-threads
2401 @kindex maint info sol-threads
2402 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
2403 Display info on Solaris user threads.
2404 @end table
2405
2406 @table @code
2407 @kindex thread @var{threadno}
2408 @item thread @var{threadno}
2409 Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2410 argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2411 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2412 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2413 you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2414
2415 @smallexample
2416 @c FIXME!! This example made up; find a @value{GDBN} w/threads and get real one
2417 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
2418 [Switching to process 35 thread 23]
2419 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2420 @end smallexample
2421
2422 @noindent
2423 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2424 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
2425 threads.
2426
2427 @kindex thread apply
2428 @cindex apply command to several threads
2429 @item thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{command}
2430 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
2431 @var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the numbers of the
2432 threads that you want affected with the command argument
2433 @var{threadno}. It can be a single thread number, one of the numbers
2434 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display; or it
2435 could be a range of thread numbers, as in @code{2-4}. To apply a
2436 command to all threads, type @kbd{thread apply all @var{command}}.
2437 @end table
2438
2439 @cindex automatic thread selection
2440 @cindex switching threads automatically
2441 @cindex threads, automatic switching
2442 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
2443 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
2444 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
2445 message of the form @samp{[Switching to @var{systag}]} to identify the
2446 thread.
2447
2448 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for
2449 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
2450 programs with multiple threads.
2451
2452 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about
2453 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
2454
2455 @node Processes
2456 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Processes
2457
2458 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
2459 @cindex multiple processes
2460 @cindex processes, multiple
2461 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
2462 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
2463 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
2464 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
2465 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
2466 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
2467 will cause it to terminate.
2468
2469 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
2470 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
2471 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
2472 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
2473 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
2474 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
2475 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
2476 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
2477 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
2478 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
2479
2480 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs that
2481 create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork} functions.
2482 Currently, the only platforms with this feature are HP-UX (11.x and later
2483 only?) and GNU/Linux (kernel version 2.5.60 and later).
2484
2485 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
2486 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
2487
2488 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
2489 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
2490
2491 @table @code
2492 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
2493 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
2494 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
2495 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
2496 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
2497
2498 @table @code
2499 @item parent
2500 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
2501 unimpeded. This is the default.
2502
2503 @item child
2504 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
2505 unimpeded.
2506
2507 @end table
2508
2509 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
2510 @item show follow-fork-mode
2511 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
2512 @end table
2513
2514 @cindex debugging multiple processes
2515 On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
2516 command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
2517
2518 @table @code
2519 @kindex set detach-on-fork
2520 @item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
2521 Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
2522 retain debugger control over them both.
2523
2524 @table @code
2525 @item on
2526 The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
2527 @code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
2528 independently. This is the default.
2529
2530 @item off
2531 Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
2532 One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
2533 @code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
2534 is held suspended.
2535
2536 @end table
2537
2538 @kindex show detach-on-follow
2539 @item show detach-on-follow
2540 Show whether detach-on-follow mode is on/off.
2541 @end table
2542
2543 If you choose to set @var{detach-on-follow} mode off, then
2544 @value{GDBN} will retain control of all forked processes (including
2545 nested forks). You can list the forked processes under the control of
2546 @value{GDBN} by using the @w{@code{info forks}} command, and switch
2547 from one fork to another by using the @w{@code{fork}} command.
2548
2549 @table @code
2550 @kindex info forks
2551 @item info forks
2552 Print a list of all forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN}.
2553 The listing will include a fork id, a process id, and the current
2554 position (program counter) of the process.
2555
2556
2557 @kindex fork @var{fork-id}
2558 @item fork @var{fork-id}
2559 Make fork number @var{fork-id} the current process. The argument
2560 @var{fork-id} is the internal fork number assigned by @value{GDBN},
2561 as shown in the first field of the @samp{info forks} display.
2562
2563 @end table
2564
2565 To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
2566 from it by using the @w{@code{detach fork}} command (allowing it to
2567 run independently), or delete (and kill) it using the
2568 @w{@code{delete fork}} command.
2569
2570 @table @code
2571 @kindex detach fork @var{fork-id}
2572 @item detach fork @var{fork-id}
2573 Detach from the process identified by @value{GDBN} fork number
2574 @var{fork-id}, and remove it from the fork list. The process will be
2575 allowed to run independently.
2576
2577 @kindex delete fork @var{fork-id}
2578 @item delete fork @var{fork-id}
2579 Kill the process identified by @value{GDBN} fork number @var{fork-id},
2580 and remove it from the fork list.
2581
2582 @end table
2583
2584 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
2585 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
2586 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
2587 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
2588 the child process's @code{main}.
2589
2590 When a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you cannot debug the
2591 child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
2592
2593 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
2594 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent process,
2595 use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name as its
2596 argument.
2597
2598 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
2599 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
2600 Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}.
2601
2602 @node Checkpoint/Restart
2603 @section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later
2604
2605 @cindex checkpoint
2606 @cindex restart
2607 @cindex bookmark
2608 @cindex snapshot of a process
2609 @cindex rewind program state
2610
2611 On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
2612 @sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
2613 program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
2614 later.
2615
2616 Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
2617 happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
2618 includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
2619 system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
2620 moment when the checkpoint was saved.
2621
2622 Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
2623 getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
2624 a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
2625 the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
2626 from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
2627 start again from there.
2628
2629 This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
2630 steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
2631
2632 To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
2633
2634 @table @code
2635 @kindex checkpoint
2636 @item checkpoint
2637 Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
2638 The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
2639 is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
2640
2641 @kindex info checkpoints
2642 @item info checkpoints
2643 List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
2644 session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
2645 listed:
2646
2647 @table @code
2648 @item Checkpoint ID
2649 @item Process ID
2650 @item Code Address
2651 @item Source line, or label
2652 @end table
2653
2654 @kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
2655 @item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
2656 Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
2657 @var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
2658 etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
2659 was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
2660 in time when the checkpoint was saved.
2661
2662 Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
2663 are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
2664 only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
2665 the debugger.
2666
2667 @kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
2668 @item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
2669 Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
2670
2671 @end table
2672
2673 Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
2674 of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
2675 (OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
2676 a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
2677 so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
2678 opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
2679 previously read data can be read again.
2680
2681 Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
2682 external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
2683 from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
2684 but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
2685 be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
2686 been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
2687
2688 However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
2689 program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
2690 again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
2691 different execution path this time.
2692
2693 @cindex checkpoints and process id
2694 Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
2695 different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
2696 id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
2697 and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
2698 If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
2699 potentially pose a problem.
2700
2701 @subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints
2702
2703 On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
2704 is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
2705 difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
2706 absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
2707 absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
2708 next.
2709
2710 A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
2711 Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
2712 and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
2713 process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
2714 your symbols will all stay in the same place.
2715
2716 @node Stopping
2717 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
2718
2719 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
2720 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
2721 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
2722
2723 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
2724 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
2725 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
2726 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
2727 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
2728 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
2729 explicitly request this information at any time.
2730
2731 @table @code
2732 @kindex info program
2733 @item info program
2734 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
2735 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
2736 @end table
2737
2738 @menu
2739 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2740 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
2741 * Signals:: Signals
2742 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
2743 @end menu
2744
2745 @node Breakpoints
2746 @section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints
2747
2748 @cindex breakpoints
2749 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
2750 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
2751 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
2752 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
2753 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
2754 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
2755 program.
2756
2757 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
2758 the executable is run. There is a minor limitation on HP-UX systems:
2759 you must wait until the executable is run in order to set breakpoints
2760 in shared library routines that are not called directly by the program
2761 (for example, routines that are arguments in a @code{pthread_create}
2762 call).
2763
2764 @cindex watchpoints
2765 @cindex data breakpoints
2766 @cindex memory tracing
2767 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
2768 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
2769 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
2770 when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
2771 of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
2772 combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
2773 @dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
2774 watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside
2775 from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
2776 enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
2777 same commands.
2778
2779 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
2780 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
2781 Automatic Display}.
2782
2783 @cindex catchpoints
2784 @cindex breakpoint on events
2785 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
2786 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
2787 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
2788 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
2789 Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
2790 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
2791 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
2792
2793 @cindex breakpoint numbers
2794 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
2795 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2796 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
2797 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
2798 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
2799 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
2800 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
2801 enable it again.
2802
2803 @cindex breakpoint ranges
2804 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
2805 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
2806 operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
2807 @samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
2808 hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
2809 all breakpoints in that range are operated on.
2810
2811 @menu
2812 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
2813 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
2814 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
2815 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
2816 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
2817 * Conditions:: Break conditions
2818 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
2819 * Breakpoint Menus:: Breakpoint menus
2820 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
2821 * Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
2822 @end menu
2823
2824 @node Set Breaks
2825 @subsection Setting Breakpoints
2826
2827 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
2828 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
2829 @c
2830 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
2831
2832 @kindex break
2833 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
2834 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
2835 @cindex latest breakpoint
2836 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
2837 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
2838 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
2839 Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
2840 convenience variables.
2841
2842 You have several ways to say where the breakpoint should go.
2843
2844 @table @code
2845 @item break @var{function}
2846 Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function}.
2847 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
2848 C@t{++}, @var{function} may refer to more than one possible place to break.
2849 @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint Menus}, for a discussion of that situation.
2850
2851 @item break +@var{offset}
2852 @itemx break -@var{offset}
2853 Set a breakpoint some number of lines forward or back from the position
2854 at which execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}.
2855 (@xref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.)
2856
2857 @item break @var{linenum}
2858 Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in the current source file.
2859 The current source file is the last file whose source text was printed.
2860 The breakpoint will stop your program just before it executes any of the
2861 code on that line.
2862
2863 @item break @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2864 Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in source file @var{filename}.
2865
2866 @item break @var{filename}:@var{function}
2867 Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function} found in file
2868 @var{filename}. Specifying a file name as well as a function name is
2869 superfluous except when multiple files contain similarly named
2870 functions.
2871
2872 @item break *@var{address}
2873 Set a breakpoint at address @var{address}. You can use this to set
2874 breakpoints in parts of your program which do not have debugging
2875 information or source files.
2876
2877 @item break
2878 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
2879 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
2880 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
2881 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
2882 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
2883 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
2884 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
2885 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
2886 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
2887 inside loops.
2888
2889 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
2890 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
2891 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
2892 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
2893 existed when your program stopped.
2894
2895 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
2896 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
2897 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
2898 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
2899 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
2900 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
2901 ,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
2902
2903 @kindex tbreak
2904 @item tbreak @var{args}
2905 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} are the
2906 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
2907 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
2908 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
2909
2910 @kindex hbreak
2911 @cindex hardware breakpoints
2912 @item hbreak @var{args}
2913 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. @var{args} are the same as for the
2914 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
2915 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
2916 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
2917 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
2918 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
2919 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
2920 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
2921 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
2922 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
2923 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
2924 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
2925 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
2926 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}).
2927 @xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
2928 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
2929 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
2930 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
2931
2932
2933 @kindex thbreak
2934 @item thbreak @var{args}
2935 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args}
2936 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
2937 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
2938 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
2939 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
2940 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
2941 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
2942 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
2943
2944 @kindex rbreak
2945 @cindex regular expression
2946 @cindex breakpoints in functions matching a regexp
2947 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
2948 @item rbreak @var{regex}
2949 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
2950 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
2951 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
2952 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
2953 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
2954 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
2955
2956 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
2957 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
2958 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
2959 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
2960 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
2961 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
2962
2963 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
2964 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
2965 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
2966 classes.
2967
2968 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
2969 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
2970 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
2971
2972 @smallexample
2973 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
2974 @end smallexample
2975
2976 @kindex info breakpoints
2977 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
2978 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2979 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2980 @itemx info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2981 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
2982 not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
2983 about the specified breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint). For
2984 each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
2985
2986 @table @emph
2987 @item Breakpoint Numbers
2988 @item Type
2989 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
2990 @item Disposition
2991 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
2992 @item Enabled or Disabled
2993 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
2994 that are not enabled. An optional @samp{(p)} suffix marks pending
2995 breakpoints --- breakpoints for which address is either not yet
2996 resolved, pending load of a shared library, or for which address was
2997 in a shared library that was since unloaded. Such breakpoint won't
2998 fire until a shared library that has the symbol or line referred by
2999 breakpoint is loaded. See below for details.
3000 @item Address
3001 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. For a
3002 pending breakpoint whose address is not yet known, this field will
3003 contain @samp{<PENDING>}. A breakpoint with several locations will
3004 have @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in this field --- see below for details.
3005 @item What
3006 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
3007 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
3008 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
3009 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
3010 @end table
3011
3012 @noindent
3013 If a breakpoint is conditional, @code{info break} shows the condition on
3014 the line following the affected breakpoint; breakpoint commands, if any,
3015 are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is allowed to have a condition
3016 specified for it. The condition is not parsed for validity until a shared
3017 library is loaded that allows the pending breakpoint to resolve to a
3018 valid location.
3019
3020 @noindent
3021 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
3022 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
3023 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3024 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3025 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}).
3026
3027 @noindent
3028 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3029 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3030 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3031 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3032 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
3033 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3034 @end table
3035
3036 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3037 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
3038 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3039 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3040
3041 It is possible that a breakpoint corresponds to several locations
3042 in your program. Examples of this situation are:
3043
3044 @itemize @bullet
3045
3046 @item
3047 For a C@t{++} constructor, the @value{NGCC} compiler generates several
3048 instances of the function body, used in different cases.
3049
3050 @item
3051 For a C@t{++} template function, a given line in the function can
3052 correspond to any number of instantiations.
3053
3054 @item
3055 For an inlined function, a given source line can correspond to
3056 several places where that function is inlined.
3057
3058 @end itemize
3059
3060 In all those cases, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at all
3061 the relevant locations.
3062
3063 A breakpoint with multiple locations is displayed in the
3064 breakpoint table using several rows --- one header row, followed
3065 by one row for each breakpoint location. The header row
3066 has @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in the address column. The rows for
3067 individual locations contain the actual addresses for locations,
3068 and say what functions those locations are in. The number
3069 column for a location has number in the format
3070 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number}.
3071
3072 For example:
3073 @smallexample
3074 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
3075 1 breakpoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
3076 stop only if i==1
3077 breakpoint already hit 1 time
3078 1.1 y 0x080486a2 in void foo<int>() at t.cc:8
3079 1.2 y 0x080486ca in void foo<double>() at t.cc:8
3080 @end smallexample
3081
3082 Each location can be individually enabled or disabled by passing
3083 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number} as argument to the
3084 @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands.
3085
3086 @cindex pending breakpoints
3087 It's quite common to have a breakpoint inside a shared library.
3088 The shared library may be loaded and unloaded explicitly,
3089 and possibly repeatedly, as the program is executed. To support
3090 this use case, @value{GDBN} updates breakpoint locations whenever
3091 any shared library is loaded or unloaded. Typically, you would
3092 set a breakpoint in a shared library at the beginning of your
3093 debugging session, when the library is not loaded, and when the
3094 symbols from the library are not available. When you try to set
3095 breakpoint, @value{GDBN} will ask you if you want to set
3096 a so called @dfn{pending breakpoint} --- breakpoint whose address
3097 is not yet resolved.
3098
3099 After the program is run, whenever a new shared library is loaded,
3100 @value{GDBN} reevaluates all the breakpoints. When a newly loaded
3101 shared library contains the symbol or line referred to by some
3102 pending breakpoint, that breakpoint is resolved and becomes an
3103 ordinary breakpoint. When a library is unloaded, all breakpoints
3104 that refer to its symbols or source lines become pending again.
3105
3106 This logic works for breakpoints with multiple locations, too. For
3107 example, if you have a breakpoint in a C@t{++} template function, and
3108 a newly loaded shared library has an instantiation of that template,
3109 a new location is added to the list of locations for the breakpoint.
3110
3111 Except for having unresolved address, pending breakpoints do not
3112 differ from regular breakpoints. You can set conditions or commands,
3113 enable and disable them and perform other breakpoint operations.
3114
3115 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling what
3116 happens when the @samp{break} command cannot resolve breakpoint
3117 address specification to an address:
3118
3119 @kindex set breakpoint pending
3120 @kindex show breakpoint pending
3121 @table @code
3122 @item set breakpoint pending auto
3123 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
3124 location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
3125
3126 @item set breakpoint pending on
3127 This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
3128 result in a pending breakpoint being created.
3129
3130 @item set breakpoint pending off
3131 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
3132 unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
3133 not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
3134
3135 @item show breakpoint pending
3136 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
3137 @end table
3138
3139 The settings above only affect the @code{break} command and its
3140 variants. Once breakpoint is set, it will be automatically updated
3141 as shared libraries are loaded and unloaded.
3142
3143 @cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
3144 For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
3145 software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
3146 breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to
3147 breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
3148 breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For
3149 breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
3150 breakpoints.
3151
3152 You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands::
3153
3154 @kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
3155 @kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
3156 @table @code
3157 @item set breakpoint auto-hw on
3158 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
3159 will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
3160 breakpoint must be used.
3161
3162 @item set breakpoint auto-hw off
3163 This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
3164 type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
3165 trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
3166 @end table
3167
3168
3169 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
3170 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
3171 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
3172 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
3173 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
3174 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
3175 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
3176 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
3177
3178
3179 @node Set Watchpoints
3180 @subsection Setting Watchpoints
3181
3182 @cindex setting watchpoints
3183 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
3184 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
3185 this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
3186 The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
3187 as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
3188
3189 @itemize @bullet
3190 @item
3191 A reference to the value of a single variable.
3192
3193 @item
3194 An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
3195 @samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
3196 address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
3197
3198 @item
3199 An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
3200 expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
3201 language (@pxref{Languages}).
3202 @end itemize
3203
3204 @cindex software watchpoints
3205 @cindex hardware watchpoints
3206 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
3207 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
3208 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
3209 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
3210 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
3211 culprit.)
3212
3213 On some systems, such as HP-UX, @sc{gnu}/Linux and most other
3214 x86-based targets, @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware
3215 watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your program.
3216
3217 @table @code
3218 @kindex watch
3219 @item watch @var{expr}
3220 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
3221 expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
3222 changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
3223 to watch the value of a single variable:
3224
3225 @smallexample
3226 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo
3227 @end smallexample
3228
3229 @kindex rwatch
3230 @item rwatch @var{expr}
3231 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
3232 by the program.
3233
3234 @kindex awatch
3235 @item awatch @var{expr}
3236 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
3237 or written into by the program.
3238
3239 @kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3240 @item info watchpoints
3241 This command prints a list of watchpoints, breakpoints, and catchpoints;
3242 it is the same as @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
3243 @end table
3244
3245 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
3246 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
3247 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
3248 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
3249 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
3250 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
3251
3252 @cindex use only software watchpoints
3253 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
3254 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
3255 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
3256 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
3257 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
3258 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
3259 mechanism of watching expression values.)
3260
3261 @table @code
3262 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
3263 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
3264 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
3265
3266 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
3267 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
3268 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
3269 @end table
3270
3271 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3272 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3273 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3274
3275 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
3276
3277 @smallexample
3278 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
3279 @end smallexample
3280
3281 @noindent
3282 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
3283
3284 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
3285 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
3286 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
3287 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
3288 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
3289 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
3290 will print a message like this:
3291
3292 @smallexample
3293 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
3294 @end smallexample
3295
3296 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
3297 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
3298 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
3299 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
3300 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
3301 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
3302 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
3303 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
3304
3305 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
3306 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
3307 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
3308 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
3309 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
3310 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
3311
3312 @smallexample
3313 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
3314 @end smallexample
3315
3316 @noindent
3317 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
3318
3319 Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
3320 exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
3321 That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
3322 expression with separately allocated resources.
3323
3324 The SPARClite DSU will generate traps when a program accesses some data
3325 or instruction address that is assigned to the debug registers. For the
3326 data addresses, DSU facilitates the @code{watch} command. However the
3327 hardware breakpoint registers can only take two data watchpoints, and
3328 both watchpoints must be the same kind. For example, you can set two
3329 watchpoints with @code{watch} commands, two with @code{rwatch} commands,
3330 @strong{or} two with @code{awatch} commands, but you cannot set one
3331 watchpoint with one command and the other with a different command.
3332 @value{GDBN} will reject the command if you try to mix watchpoints.
3333 Delete or disable unused watchpoint commands before setting new ones.
3334
3335 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
3336 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
3337 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
3338
3339 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
3340 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
3341 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
3342 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
3343 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
3344 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
3345 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
3346 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
3347 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
3348
3349 @cindex watchpoints and threads
3350 @cindex threads and watchpoints
3351 In multi-threaded programs, watchpoints will detect changes to the
3352 watched expression from every thread.
3353
3354 @quotation
3355 @emph{Warning:} In multi-threaded programs, software watchpoints
3356 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
3357 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
3358 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
3359 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
3360 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
3361 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
3362 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
3363 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
3364 @end quotation
3365
3366 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
3367
3368 @node Set Catchpoints
3369 @subsection Setting Catchpoints
3370 @cindex catchpoints, setting
3371 @cindex exception handlers
3372 @cindex event handling
3373
3374 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
3375 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
3376 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
3377
3378 @table @code
3379 @kindex catch
3380 @item catch @var{event}
3381 Stop when @var{event} occurs. @var{event} can be any of the following:
3382 @table @code
3383 @item throw
3384 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
3385 The throwing of a C@t{++} exception.
3386
3387 @item catch
3388 The catching of a C@t{++} exception.
3389
3390 @item exception
3391 @cindex Ada exception catching
3392 @cindex catch Ada exceptions
3393 An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified
3394 at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
3395 the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
3396 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
3397
3398 @item exception unhandled
3399 An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program.
3400
3401 @item assert
3402 A failed Ada assertion.
3403
3404 @item exec
3405 @cindex break on fork/exec
3406 A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3407
3408 @item fork
3409 A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3410
3411 @item vfork
3412 A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3413
3414 @item load
3415 @itemx load @var{libname}
3416 @cindex break on load/unload of shared library
3417 The dynamic loading of any shared library, or the loading of the library
3418 @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3419
3420 @item unload
3421 @itemx unload @var{libname}
3422 The unloading of any dynamically loaded shared library, or the unloading
3423 of the library @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3424 @end table
3425
3426 @item tcatch @var{event}
3427 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
3428 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
3429
3430 @end table
3431
3432 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
3433
3434 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling
3435 (@code{catch throw} and @code{catch catch}) in @value{GDBN}:
3436
3437 @itemize @bullet
3438 @item
3439 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
3440 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
3441 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
3442 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
3443 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
3444 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
3445 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
3446 disabled within interactive calls.
3447
3448 @item
3449 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
3450
3451 @item
3452 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
3453 @end itemize
3454
3455 @cindex raise exceptions
3456 Sometimes @code{catch} is not the best way to debug exception handling:
3457 if you need to know exactly where an exception is raised, it is better to
3458 stop @emph{before} the exception handler is called, since that way you
3459 can see the stack before any unwinding takes place. If you set a
3460 breakpoint in an exception handler instead, it may not be easy to find
3461 out where the exception was raised.
3462
3463 To stop just before an exception handler is called, you need some
3464 knowledge of the implementation. In the case of @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, exceptions are
3465 raised by calling a library function named @code{__raise_exception}
3466 which has the following ANSI C interface:
3467
3468 @smallexample
3469 /* @var{addr} is where the exception identifier is stored.
3470 @var{id} is the exception identifier. */
3471 void __raise_exception (void **addr, void *id);
3472 @end smallexample
3473
3474 @noindent
3475 To make the debugger catch all exceptions before any stack
3476 unwinding takes place, set a breakpoint on @code{__raise_exception}
3477 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Exceptions}).
3478
3479 With a conditional breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions})
3480 that depends on the value of @var{id}, you can stop your program when
3481 a specific exception is raised. You can use multiple conditional
3482 breakpoints to stop your program when any of a number of exceptions are
3483 raised.
3484
3485
3486 @node Delete Breaks
3487 @subsection Deleting Breakpoints
3488
3489 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
3490 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
3491 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3492 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
3493 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
3494 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
3495
3496 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
3497 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
3498 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
3499 their breakpoint numbers.
3500
3501 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
3502 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
3503 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
3504
3505 @table @code
3506 @kindex clear
3507 @item clear
3508 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
3509 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). When
3510 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
3511 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
3512
3513 @item clear @var{function}
3514 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
3515 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
3516
3517 @item clear @var{linenum}
3518 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
3519 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
3520 @var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
3521
3522 @cindex delete breakpoints
3523 @kindex delete
3524 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
3525 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3526 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
3527 ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
3528 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
3529 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
3530 @end table
3531
3532 @node Disabling
3533 @subsection Disabling Breakpoints
3534
3535 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
3536 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
3537 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
3538 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
3539 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
3540
3541 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
3542 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying one
3543 or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} or
3544 @code{info watch} to print a list of breakpoints, watchpoints, and
3545 catchpoints if you do not know which numbers to use.
3546
3547 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of four different
3548 states of enablement:
3549
3550 @itemize @bullet
3551 @item
3552 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
3553 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
3554 @item
3555 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
3556 @item
3557 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
3558 disabled.
3559 @item
3560 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
3561 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
3562 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
3563 @end itemize
3564
3565 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
3566 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
3567
3568 @table @code
3569 @kindex disable
3570 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
3571 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3572 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
3573 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
3574 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
3575 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
3576 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
3577
3578 @kindex enable
3579 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3580 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
3581 become effective once again in stopping your program.
3582
3583 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
3584 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
3585 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
3586
3587 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
3588 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
3589 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
3590 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
3591 @end table
3592
3593 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
3594 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
3595 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
3596 ,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
3597 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
3598 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
3599 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
3600 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
3601 Stepping}.)
3602
3603 @node Conditions
3604 @subsection Break Conditions
3605 @cindex conditional breakpoints
3606 @cindex breakpoint conditions
3607
3608 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
3609 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
3610 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
3611 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
3612 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
3613 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
3614 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
3615 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
3616
3617 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
3618 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
3619 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
3620 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
3621 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
3622
3623 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
3624 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
3625 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
3626 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
3627 one.
3628
3629 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
3630 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
3631 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
3632 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
3633 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
3634 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
3635 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
3636 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
3637 conditions for the
3638 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
3639 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}).
3640
3641 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
3642 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
3643 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
3644 with the @code{condition} command.
3645
3646 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
3647 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
3648 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
3649 catchpoint.
3650
3651 @table @code
3652 @kindex condition
3653 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
3654 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
3655 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
3656 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
3657 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
3658 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
3659 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
3660 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
3661 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
3662 prints an error message:
3663
3664 @smallexample
3665 No symbol "foo" in current context.
3666 @end smallexample
3667
3668 @noindent
3669 @value{GDBN} does
3670 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
3671 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
3672 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
3673
3674 @item condition @var{bnum}
3675 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
3676 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
3677 @end table
3678
3679 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
3680 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
3681 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
3682 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
3683 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
3684 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
3685 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
3686 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
3687 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
3688 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
3689 your program reaches it.
3690
3691 @table @code
3692 @kindex ignore
3693 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
3694 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
3695 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
3696 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
3697 takes no action.
3698
3699 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
3700 a count of zero.
3701
3702 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
3703 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
3704 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
3705 Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}.
3706
3707 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
3708 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
3709 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
3710
3711 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
3712 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
3713 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
3714 Variables}.
3715 @end table
3716
3717 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
3718
3719
3720 @node Break Commands
3721 @subsection Breakpoint Command Lists
3722
3723 @cindex breakpoint commands
3724 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
3725 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
3726 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
3727 enable other breakpoints.
3728
3729 @table @code
3730 @kindex commands
3731 @kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
3732 @item commands @r{[}@var{bnum}@r{]}
3733 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
3734 @itemx end
3735 Specify a list of commands for breakpoint number @var{bnum}. The commands
3736 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
3737 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
3738
3739 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
3740 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
3741
3742 With no @var{bnum} argument, @code{commands} refers to the last
3743 breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most
3744 recently encountered).
3745 @end table
3746
3747 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
3748 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
3749
3750 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
3751 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
3752 that resumes execution.
3753
3754 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
3755 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
3756 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
3757 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
3758 ambiguities about which list to execute.
3759
3760 @kindex silent
3761 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
3762 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
3763 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
3764 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
3765 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
3766 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
3767
3768 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
3769 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
3770 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}.
3771
3772 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
3773 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
3774
3775 @smallexample
3776 break foo if x>0
3777 commands
3778 silent
3779 printf "x is %d\n",x
3780 cont
3781 end
3782 @end smallexample
3783
3784 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
3785 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
3786 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
3787 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
3788 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
3789 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
3790 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
3791
3792 @smallexample
3793 break 403
3794 commands
3795 silent
3796 set x = y + 4
3797 cont
3798 end
3799 @end smallexample
3800
3801 @node Breakpoint Menus
3802 @subsection Breakpoint Menus
3803 @cindex overloading
3804 @cindex symbol overloading
3805
3806 Some programming languages (notably C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit a
3807 single function name
3808 to be defined several times, for application in different contexts.
3809 This is called @dfn{overloading}. When a function name is overloaded,
3810 @samp{break @var{function}} is not enough to tell @value{GDBN} where you want
3811 a breakpoint. If you realize this is a problem, you can use
3812 something like @samp{break @var{function}(@var{types})} to specify which
3813 particular version of the function you want. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} offers
3814 you a menu of numbered choices for different possible breakpoints, and
3815 waits for your selection with the prompt @samp{>}. The first two
3816 options are always @samp{[0] cancel} and @samp{[1] all}. Typing @kbd{1}
3817 sets a breakpoint at each definition of @var{function}, and typing
3818 @kbd{0} aborts the @code{break} command without setting any new
3819 breakpoints.
3820
3821 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
3822 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
3823 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
3824
3825 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
3826 @smallexample
3827 @group
3828 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
3829 [0] cancel
3830 [1] all
3831 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
3832 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
3833 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
3834 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
3835 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
3836 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
3837 > 2 4 6
3838 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
3839 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
3840 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
3841 Multiple breakpoints were set.
3842 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
3843 breakpoints.
3844 (@value{GDBP})
3845 @end group
3846 @end smallexample
3847
3848 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
3849 @node Error in Breakpoints
3850 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3851 @c
3852 @c FIXME!! 14/6/95 Is there a real example of this? Let's use it.
3853 @c
3854 Under some operating systems, breakpoints cannot be used in a program if
3855 any other process is running that program. In this situation,
3856 attempting to run or continue a program with a breakpoint causes
3857 @value{GDBN} to print an error message:
3858
3859 @smallexample
3860 Cannot insert breakpoints.
3861 The same program may be running in another process.
3862 @end smallexample
3863
3864 When this happens, you have three ways to proceed:
3865
3866 @enumerate
3867 @item
3868 Remove or disable the breakpoints, then continue.
3869
3870 @item
3871 Suspend @value{GDBN}, and copy the file containing your program to a new
3872 name. Resume @value{GDBN} and use the @code{exec-file} command to specify
3873 that @value{GDBN} should run your program under that name.
3874 Then start your program again.
3875
3876 @item
3877 Relink your program so that the text segment is nonsharable, using the
3878 linker option @samp{-N}. The operating system limitation may not apply
3879 to nonsharable executables.
3880 @end enumerate
3881 @c @end ifclear
3882
3883 A similar message can be printed if you request too many active
3884 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints:
3885
3886 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
3887 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
3888 @smallexample
3889 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
3890 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
3891 @end smallexample
3892
3893 @noindent
3894 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
3895 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
3896 watchpoints it needs to insert.
3897
3898 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
3899 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
3900
3901 @node Breakpoint-related Warnings
3902 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3903 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
3904
3905 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
3906 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
3907 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
3908 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
3909
3910 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
3911 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
3912 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
3913 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
3914 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
3915 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
3916 first in the bundle.
3917
3918 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
3919 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
3920 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
3921 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
3922 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
3923 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
3924 is hit.
3925
3926 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
3927 that's been subject to address adjustment:
3928
3929 @smallexample
3930 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
3931 @end smallexample
3932
3933 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
3934 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
3935 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
3936 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
3937 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
3938 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
3939 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
3940 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
3941
3942 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
3943 adjusted breakpoints:
3944
3945 @smallexample
3946 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
3947 to 0x00010410.
3948 @end smallexample
3949
3950 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
3951 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
3952 frequently than expected.
3953
3954 @node Continuing and Stepping
3955 @section Continuing and Stepping
3956
3957 @cindex stepping
3958 @cindex continuing
3959 @cindex resuming execution
3960 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
3961 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
3962 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
3963 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
3964 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
3965 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
3966 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
3967 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3968
3969 @table @code
3970 @kindex continue
3971 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
3972 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
3973 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3974 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3975 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3976 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
3977 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
3978 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
3979 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
3980 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3981
3982 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
3983 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
3984 @code{continue} is ignored.
3985
3986 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
3987 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
3988 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
3989 @code{continue}.
3990 @end table
3991
3992 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
3993 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the
3994 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
3995 Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
3996
3997 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
3998 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the
3999 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
4000 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
4001 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
4002 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
4003
4004 @table @code
4005 @kindex step
4006 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
4007 @item step
4008 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
4009 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
4010 abbreviated @code{s}.
4011
4012 @quotation
4013 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
4014 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
4015 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
4016 @c distinction here.
4017 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
4018 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
4019 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
4020 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
4021 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
4022 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
4023 below.
4024 @end quotation
4025
4026 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
4027 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
4028 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
4029 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
4030 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
4031 called within the line.
4032
4033 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
4034 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
4035 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
4036 on MIPS machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
4037 was any debugging information about the routine.
4038
4039 @item step @var{count}
4040 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
4041 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
4042 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
4043
4044 @kindex next
4045 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
4046 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
4047 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
4048 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
4049 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
4050 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
4051 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
4052 is abbreviated @code{n}.
4053
4054 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
4055
4056
4057 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
4058 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
4059 @c
4060 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
4061 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
4062 @c function are executed without stopping.
4063
4064 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
4065 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
4066 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
4067
4068 @kindex set step-mode
4069 @item set step-mode
4070 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
4071 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
4072 @itemx set step-mode on
4073 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
4074 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
4075 information rather than stepping over it.
4076
4077 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
4078 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
4079 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
4080
4081 @item set step-mode off
4082 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
4083 debug information. This is the default.
4084
4085 @item show step-mode
4086 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
4087 source line debug information.
4088
4089 @kindex finish
4090 @item finish
4091 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
4092 returns. Print the returned value (if any).
4093
4094 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
4095 ,Returning from a Function}).
4096
4097 @kindex until
4098 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
4099 @cindex run until specified location
4100 @item until
4101 @itemx u
4102 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
4103 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
4104 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
4105 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
4106 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
4107 than the address of the jump.
4108
4109 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
4110 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
4111 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
4112 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
4113 through the next iteration.
4114
4115 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
4116 stack frame.
4117
4118 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
4119 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
4120 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
4121 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
4122 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
4123
4124 @smallexample
4125 (@value{GDBP}) f
4126 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
4127 206 expand_input();
4128 (@value{GDBP}) until
4129 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
4130 @end smallexample
4131
4132 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
4133 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
4134 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
4135 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
4136 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
4137 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
4138 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
4139
4140 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
4141 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
4142 argument.
4143
4144 @item until @var{location}
4145 @itemx u @var{location}
4146 Continue running your program until either the specified location is
4147 reached, or the current stack frame returns. @var{location} is any of
4148 the forms of argument acceptable to @code{break} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
4149 ,Setting Breakpoints}). This form of the command uses breakpoints, and
4150 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
4151 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
4152 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
4153 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
4154 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
4155 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner
4156 invocations have returned.
4157
4158 @smallexample
4159 94 int factorial (int value)
4160 95 @{
4161 96 if (value > 1) @{
4162 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
4163 98 @}
4164 99 return (value);
4165 100 @}
4166 @end smallexample
4167
4168
4169 @kindex advance @var{location}
4170 @itemx advance @var{location}
4171 Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
4172 required, which should be of the same form as arguments for the @code{break}
4173 command. Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
4174 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
4175 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
4176 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
4177
4178
4179 @kindex stepi
4180 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
4181 @item stepi
4182 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
4183 @itemx si
4184 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
4185
4186 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
4187 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
4188 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
4189 Display,, Automatic Display}.
4190
4191 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
4192
4193 @need 750
4194 @kindex nexti
4195 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
4196 @item nexti
4197 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
4198 @itemx ni
4199 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
4200 proceed until the function returns.
4201
4202 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
4203 @end table
4204
4205 @node Signals
4206 @section Signals
4207 @cindex signals
4208
4209 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
4210 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
4211 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
4212 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
4213 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
4214 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
4215 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
4216 requested an alarm).
4217
4218 @cindex fatal signals
4219 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
4220 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
4221 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
4222 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
4223 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
4224 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
4225
4226 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
4227 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
4228 signal.
4229
4230 @cindex handling signals
4231 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
4232 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
4233 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
4234 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
4235 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
4236
4237 @table @code
4238 @kindex info signals
4239 @kindex info handle
4240 @item info signals
4241 @itemx info handle
4242 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
4243 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
4244 the defined types of signals.
4245
4246 @item info signals @var{sig}
4247 Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
4248
4249 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
4250
4251 @kindex handle
4252 @item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
4253 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. @var{signal}
4254 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
4255 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
4256 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
4257 known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
4258 say what change to make.
4259 @end table
4260
4261 @c @group
4262 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
4263 Their full names are:
4264
4265 @table @code
4266 @item nostop
4267 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
4268 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
4269
4270 @item stop
4271 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
4272 the @code{print} keyword as well.
4273
4274 @item print
4275 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
4276
4277 @item noprint
4278 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
4279 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
4280
4281 @item pass
4282 @itemx noignore
4283 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
4284 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
4285 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
4286
4287 @item nopass
4288 @itemx ignore
4289 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
4290 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
4291 @end table
4292 @c @end group
4293
4294 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
4295 program until you
4296 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
4297 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
4298 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
4299 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
4300 program sees that signal when you continue.
4301
4302 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
4303 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
4304 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
4305 erroneous signals.
4306
4307 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
4308 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
4309 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
4310 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
4311 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
4312 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
4313 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
4314 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
4315 Program a Signal}.
4316
4317 @node Thread Stops
4318 @section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs
4319
4320 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
4321 Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set
4322 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
4323
4324 @table @code
4325 @cindex breakpoints and threads
4326 @cindex thread breakpoints
4327 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
4328 @item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
4329 @itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
4330 @var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
4331 writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
4332
4333 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
4334 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
4335 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. @var{threadno} is one of the
4336 numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
4337 column of the @samp{info threads} display.
4338
4339 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
4340 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
4341 program.
4342
4343 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
4344 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before the
4345 breakpoint condition, like this:
4346
4347 @smallexample
4348 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
4349 @end smallexample
4350
4351 @end table
4352
4353 @cindex stopped threads
4354 @cindex threads, stopped
4355 Whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
4356 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
4357 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
4358 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
4359 underfoot.
4360
4361 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
4362 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
4363 @cindex premature return from system calls
4364 There is an unfortunate side effect. If one thread stops for a
4365 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
4366 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
4367 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
4368 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
4369 stop execution.
4370
4371 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
4372 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
4373 style anyways.
4374
4375 For example, do not write code like this:
4376
4377 @smallexample
4378 sleep (10);
4379 @end smallexample
4380
4381 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
4382 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
4383
4384 Instead, write this:
4385
4386 @smallexample
4387 int unslept = 10;
4388 while (unslept > 0)
4389 unslept = sleep (unslept);
4390 @end smallexample
4391
4392 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
4393 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
4394 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
4395 @value{GDBN}.
4396
4397 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
4398 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
4399 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
4400 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
4401
4402 @cindex continuing threads
4403 @cindex threads, continuing
4404 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
4405 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
4406 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
4407
4408 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
4409 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
4410 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
4411 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
4412 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
4413 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
4414 stops.
4415
4416 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
4417 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
4418 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
4419 first thread completes whatever you requested.
4420
4421 On some OSes, you can lock the OS scheduler and thus allow only a single
4422 thread to run.
4423
4424 @table @code
4425 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
4426 @cindex scheduler locking mode
4427 @cindex lock scheduler
4428 Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
4429 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
4430 current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
4431 mode optimizes for single-stepping. It stops other threads from
4432 ``seizing the prompt'' by preempting the current thread while you are
4433 stepping. Other threads will only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
4434 when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
4435 function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
4436 like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
4437 thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, they will never steal the
4438 @value{GDBN} prompt away from the thread that you are debugging.
4439
4440 @item show scheduler-locking
4441 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
4442 @end table
4443
4444
4445 @node Stack
4446 @chapter Examining the Stack
4447
4448 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
4449 stopped and how it got there.
4450
4451 @cindex call stack
4452 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
4453 is generated.
4454 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
4455 the arguments of the call,
4456 and the local variables of the function being called.
4457 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
4458 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
4459 stack}.
4460
4461 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
4462 stack allow you to see all of this information.
4463
4464 @cindex selected frame
4465 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
4466 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
4467 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
4468 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
4469 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
4470 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
4471
4472 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
4473 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
4474 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}).
4475
4476 @menu
4477 * Frames:: Stack frames
4478 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
4479 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
4480 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
4481
4482 @end menu
4483
4484 @node Frames
4485 @section Stack Frames
4486
4487 @cindex frame, definition
4488 @cindex stack frame
4489 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
4490 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
4491 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
4492 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
4493 which the function is executing.
4494
4495 @cindex initial frame
4496 @cindex outermost frame
4497 @cindex innermost frame
4498 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
4499 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
4500 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
4501 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
4502 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
4503 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
4504 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
4505 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
4506
4507 @cindex frame pointer
4508 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
4509 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
4510 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
4511 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
4512 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
4513 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
4514
4515 @cindex frame number
4516 @value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
4517 zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
4518 and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
4519 they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
4520 frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
4521
4522 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
4523 @c underflow problems.
4524 @cindex frameless execution
4525 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
4526 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{NGCC} option
4527 @smallexample
4528 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
4529 @end smallexample
4530 generates functions without a frame.)
4531 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
4532 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
4533 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
4534 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
4535 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
4536 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
4537 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
4538
4539 @table @code
4540 @kindex frame@r{, command}
4541 @cindex current stack frame
4542 @item frame @var{args}
4543 The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
4544 and to print the stack frame you select. @var{args} may be either the
4545 address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
4546 @code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
4547
4548 @kindex select-frame
4549 @cindex selecting frame silently
4550 @item select-frame
4551 The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
4552 to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
4553 @code{frame}.
4554 @end table
4555
4556 @node Backtrace
4557 @section Backtraces
4558
4559 @cindex traceback
4560 @cindex call stack traces
4561 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
4562 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
4563 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
4564 stack.
4565
4566 @table @code
4567 @kindex backtrace
4568 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
4569 @item backtrace
4570 @itemx bt
4571 Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
4572 frames in the stack.
4573
4574 You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
4575 character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
4576
4577 @item backtrace @var{n}
4578 @itemx bt @var{n}
4579 Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
4580
4581 @item backtrace -@var{n}
4582 @itemx bt -@var{n}
4583 Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
4584
4585 @item backtrace full
4586 @itemx bt full
4587 @itemx bt full @var{n}
4588 @itemx bt full -@var{n}
4589 Print the values of the local variables also. @var{n} specifies the
4590 number of frames to print, as described above.
4591 @end table
4592
4593 @kindex where
4594 @kindex info stack
4595 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
4596 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
4597
4598 @cindex multiple threads, backtrace
4599 In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
4600 backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
4601 several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
4602 (@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
4603 apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
4604 the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
4605 multi-threaded program.
4606
4607 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
4608 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
4609 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
4610 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
4611 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
4612 line number.
4613
4614 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
4615 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
4616
4617 @smallexample
4618 @group
4619 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
4620 at builtin.c:993
4621 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600) at macro.c:242
4622 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
4623 at macro.c:71
4624 (More stack frames follow...)
4625 @end group
4626 @end smallexample
4627
4628 @noindent
4629 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
4630 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
4631 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
4632
4633 @cindex value optimized out, in backtrace
4634 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
4635 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
4636 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
4637 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
4638 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
4639 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
4640 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
4641 such a backtrace might look like:
4642
4643 @smallexample
4644 @group
4645 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
4646 at builtin.c:993
4647 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<value optimized out>) at macro.c:242
4648 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<value optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
4649 at macro.c:71
4650 (More stack frames follow...)
4651 @end group
4652 @end smallexample
4653
4654 @noindent
4655 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
4656 shown as @samp{<value optimized out>}.
4657
4658 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
4659 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
4660 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
4661
4662 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
4663 @cindex program entry point
4664 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
4665 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
4666 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
4667 @code{main}@footnote{
4668 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
4669 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
4670 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
4671 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
4672 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
4673 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
4674
4675 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
4676 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
4677
4678 @table @code
4679 @item set backtrace past-main
4680 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
4681 @kindex set backtrace
4682 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
4683
4684 @item set backtrace past-main off
4685 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
4686 default.
4687
4688 @item show backtrace past-main
4689 @kindex show backtrace
4690 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
4691
4692 @item set backtrace past-entry
4693 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
4694 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
4695 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
4696 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
4697
4698 @item set backtrace past-entry off
4699 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an
4700 application. This is the default.
4701
4702 @item show backtrace past-entry
4703 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
4704
4705 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
4706 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
4707 @cindex backtrace limit
4708 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of zero means
4709 unlimited.
4710
4711 @item show backtrace limit
4712 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
4713 @end table
4714
4715 @node Selection
4716 @section Selecting a Frame
4717
4718 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
4719 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
4720 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
4721 of the stack frame just selected.
4722
4723 @table @code
4724 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
4725 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
4726 @item frame @var{n}
4727 @itemx f @var{n}
4728 Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
4729 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
4730 innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
4731 @code{main}.
4732
4733 @item frame @var{addr}
4734 @itemx f @var{addr}
4735 Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
4736 chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
4737 impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
4738 addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
4739 switches between them.
4740
4741 On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
4742 select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
4743
4744 On the MIPS and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
4745 pointer and a program counter.
4746
4747 On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
4748 pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
4749
4750 @kindex up
4751 @item up @var{n}
4752 Move @var{n} frames up the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
4753 advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames
4754 that have existed longer. @var{n} defaults to one.
4755
4756 @kindex down
4757 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
4758 @item down @var{n}
4759 Move @var{n} frames down the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
4760 advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames
4761 that were created more recently. @var{n} defaults to one. You may
4762 abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
4763 @end table
4764
4765 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
4766 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
4767 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
4768 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
4769
4770 @need 1000
4771 For example:
4772
4773 @smallexample
4774 @group
4775 (@value{GDBP}) up
4776 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
4777 at env.c:10
4778 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
4779 @end group
4780 @end smallexample
4781
4782 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
4783 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
4784 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
4785 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
4786 @xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines},
4787 for details.
4788
4789 @table @code
4790 @kindex down-silently
4791 @kindex up-silently
4792 @item up-silently @var{n}
4793 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
4794 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
4795 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
4796 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
4797 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
4798 distracting.
4799 @end table
4800
4801 @node Frame Info
4802 @section Information About a Frame
4803
4804 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
4805 stack frame.
4806
4807 @table @code
4808 @item frame
4809 @itemx f
4810 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
4811 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
4812 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
4813 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
4814 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
4815
4816 @kindex info frame
4817 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
4818 @item info frame
4819 @itemx info f
4820 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
4821 including:
4822
4823 @itemize @bullet
4824 @item
4825 the address of the frame
4826 @item
4827 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
4828 @item
4829 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
4830 @item
4831 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
4832 @item
4833 the address of the frame's arguments
4834 @item
4835 the address of the frame's local variables
4836 @item
4837 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
4838 @item
4839 which registers were saved in the frame
4840 @end itemize
4841
4842 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
4843 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
4844 the usual conventions.
4845
4846 @item info frame @var{addr}
4847 @itemx info f @var{addr}
4848 Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
4849 selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
4850 command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
4851 architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
4852 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
4853
4854 @kindex info args
4855 @item info args
4856 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
4857
4858 @item info locals
4859 @kindex info locals
4860 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
4861 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
4862 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
4863
4864 @kindex info catch
4865 @cindex catch exceptions, list active handlers
4866 @cindex exception handlers, how to list
4867 @item info catch
4868 Print a list of all the exception handlers that are active in the
4869 current stack frame at the current point of execution. To see other
4870 exception handlers, visit the associated frame (using the @code{up},
4871 @code{down}, or @code{frame} commands); then type @code{info catch}.
4872 @xref{Set Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
4873
4874 @end table
4875
4876
4877 @node Source
4878 @chapter Examining Source Files
4879
4880 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
4881 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
4882 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
4883 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
4884 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
4885 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
4886 source files by explicit command.
4887
4888 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
4889 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
4890 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
4891
4892 @menu
4893 * List:: Printing source lines
4894 * Edit:: Editing source files
4895 * Search:: Searching source files
4896 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
4897 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
4898 @end menu
4899
4900 @node List
4901 @section Printing Source Lines
4902
4903 @kindex list
4904 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
4905 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
4906 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
4907 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to print.
4908
4909 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
4910
4911 @table @code
4912 @item list @var{linenum}
4913 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
4914 current source file.
4915
4916 @item list @var{function}
4917 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
4918 @var{function}.
4919
4920 @item list
4921 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
4922 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
4923 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
4924 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
4925 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
4926
4927 @item list -
4928 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4929 @end table
4930
4931 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
4932 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
4933 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
4934
4935 @table @code
4936 @kindex set listsize
4937 @item set listsize @var{count}
4938 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
4939 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
4940
4941 @kindex show listsize
4942 @item show listsize
4943 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
4944 @end table
4945
4946 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
4947 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
4948 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
4949 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
4950 each repetition moves up in the source file.
4951
4952 @cindex linespec
4953 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
4954 @dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
4955 of writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
4956 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
4957
4958 @table @code
4959 @item list @var{linespec}
4960 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
4961
4962 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
4963 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
4964 linespecs.
4965
4966 @item list ,@var{last}
4967 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
4968
4969 @item list @var{first},
4970 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
4971
4972 @item list +
4973 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
4974
4975 @item list -
4976 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4977
4978 @item list
4979 As described in the preceding table.
4980 @end table
4981
4982 Here are the ways of specifying a single source line---all the
4983 kinds of linespec.
4984
4985 @table @code
4986 @item @var{number}
4987 Specifies line @var{number} of the current source file.
4988 When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, this refers to
4989 the same source file as the first linespec.
4990
4991 @item +@var{offset}
4992 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines after the last line printed.
4993 When used as the second linespec in a @code{list} command that has
4994 two, this specifies the line @var{offset} lines down from the
4995 first linespec.
4996
4997 @item -@var{offset}
4998 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before the last line printed.
4999
5000 @item @var{filename}:@var{number}
5001 Specifies line @var{number} in the source file @var{filename}.
5002
5003 @item @var{function}
5004 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
5005 For example: in C, this is the line with the open brace.
5006
5007 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
5008 Specifies the line of the open-brace that begins the body of the
5009 function @var{function} in the file @var{filename}. You only need the
5010 file name with a function name to avoid ambiguity when there are
5011 identically named functions in different source files.
5012
5013 @item *@var{address}
5014 Specifies the line containing the program address @var{address}.
5015 @var{address} may be any expression.
5016 @end table
5017
5018 @node Edit
5019 @section Editing Source Files
5020 @cindex editing source files
5021
5022 @kindex edit
5023 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
5024 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
5025 The editing program of your choice
5026 is invoked with the current line set to
5027 the active line in the program.
5028 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
5029 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program.
5030
5031 Here are the forms of the @code{edit} command most commonly used:
5032
5033 @table @code
5034 @item edit
5035 Edit the current source file at the active line number in the program.
5036
5037 @item edit @var{number}
5038 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
5039
5040 @item edit @var{function}
5041 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
5042
5043 @item edit @var{filename}:@var{number}
5044 Specifies line @var{number} in the source file @var{filename}.
5045
5046 @item edit @var{filename}:@var{function}
5047 Specifies the line that begins the body of the
5048 function @var{function} in the file @var{filename}. You only need the
5049 file name with a function name to avoid ambiguity when there are
5050 identically named functions in different source files.
5051
5052 @item edit *@var{address}
5053 Specifies the line containing the program address @var{address}.
5054 @var{address} may be any expression.
5055 @end table
5056
5057 @subsection Choosing your Editor
5058 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
5059 @footnote{
5060 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
5061 following command-line syntax:
5062 @smallexample
5063 ex +@var{number} file
5064 @end smallexample
5065 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
5066 the file where to start editing.}.
5067 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
5068 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
5069 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
5070 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
5071 @smallexample
5072 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
5073 export EDITOR
5074 gdb @dots{}
5075 @end smallexample
5076 or in the @code{csh} shell,
5077 @smallexample
5078 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
5079 gdb @dots{}
5080 @end smallexample
5081
5082 @node Search
5083 @section Searching Source Files
5084 @cindex searching source files
5085
5086 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
5087 regular expression.
5088
5089 @table @code
5090 @kindex search
5091 @kindex forward-search
5092 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
5093 @itemx search @var{regexp}
5094 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
5095 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
5096 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
5097 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
5098 @code{fo}.
5099
5100 @kindex reverse-search
5101 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
5102 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
5103 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
5104 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
5105 this command as @code{rev}.
5106 @end table
5107
5108 @node Source Path
5109 @section Specifying Source Directories
5110
5111 @cindex source path
5112 @cindex directories for source files
5113 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
5114 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
5115 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
5116 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
5117 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
5118 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
5119 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
5120
5121 For example, suppose an executable references the file
5122 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
5123 @file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
5124 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
5125 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
5126 message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
5127 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
5128 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
5129 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
5130 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
5131 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
5132
5133 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
5134 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
5135 instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
5136 is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
5137 @file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
5138 that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
5139
5140 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
5141 source files.
5142
5143 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
5144 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
5145 each line is in the file.
5146
5147 @kindex directory
5148 @kindex dir
5149 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
5150 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
5151 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
5152
5153 The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
5154 script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
5155
5156 In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
5157 that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
5158 rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
5159 debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
5160 directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
5161 two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
5162 the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
5163 In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
5164 @var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
5165 of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
5166 source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
5167 name to look up the sources.
5168
5169 Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
5170 moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
5171 @value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
5172 @file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
5173 @file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
5174 of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
5175 substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
5176 (@pxref{set substitute-path}).
5177
5178 To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
5179 @var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
5180 For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
5181 @file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
5182 not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
5183 is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will
5184 not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
5185
5186 In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
5187 command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
5188 the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
5189 subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
5190 subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
5191 preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
5192 allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
5193 command.
5194
5195 @code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
5196 The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
5197 longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
5198 the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
5199 for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
5200 located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
5201 method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location.
5202
5203 @table @code
5204 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
5205 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
5206 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
5207 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
5208 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
5209 part of absolute file names) or
5210 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
5211 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
5212
5213 @kindex cdir
5214 @kindex cwd
5215 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
5216 @vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable}
5217 @cindex compilation directory
5218 @cindex current directory
5219 @cindex working directory
5220 @cindex directory, current
5221 @cindex directory, compilation
5222 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
5223 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
5224 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
5225 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
5226 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
5227 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
5228
5229 @item directory
5230 Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
5231
5232 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
5233 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
5234
5235 @item show directories
5236 @kindex show directories
5237 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
5238
5239 @anchor{set substitute-path}
5240 @item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
5241 @kindex set substitute-path
5242 Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
5243 current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
5244 @var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
5245
5246 For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
5247 @file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
5248
5249 @smallexample
5250 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/cross
5251 @end smallexample
5252
5253 @noindent
5254 will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/usr/src} with
5255 @samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
5256 @file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
5257
5258 In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
5259 the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
5260 defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
5261 the substitution.
5262
5263 For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
5264
5265 @smallexample
5266 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
5267 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
5268 @end smallexample
5269
5270 @noindent
5271 @value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
5272 @file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
5273 use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
5274 @file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
5275
5276
5277 @item unset substitute-path [path]
5278 @kindex unset substitute-path
5279 If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
5280 for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
5281 A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
5282
5283 If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
5284
5285 @item show substitute-path [path]
5286 @kindex show substitute-path
5287 If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
5288 which would rewrite that path, if any.
5289
5290 If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
5291 rules.
5292
5293 @end table
5294
5295 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
5296 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
5297 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
5298
5299 @enumerate
5300 @item
5301 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
5302
5303 @item
5304 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
5305 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
5306 directories in one command.
5307 @end enumerate
5308
5309 @node Machine Code
5310 @section Source and Machine Code
5311 @cindex source line and its code address
5312
5313 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
5314 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
5315 a range of addresses as machine instructions. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
5316 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
5317 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
5318 well as hex.
5319
5320 @table @code
5321 @kindex info line
5322 @item info line @var{linespec}
5323 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
5324 source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
5325 the ways understood by the @code{list} command (@pxref{List, ,Printing
5326 Source Lines}).
5327 @end table
5328
5329 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
5330 the object code for the first line of function
5331 @code{m4_changequote}:
5332
5333 @c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
5334 @c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
5335 @smallexample
5336 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
5337 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
5338 @end smallexample
5339
5340 @noindent
5341 @cindex code address and its source line
5342 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
5343 @var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
5344 @smallexample
5345 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
5346 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
5347 @end smallexample
5348
5349 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
5350 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
5351 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
5352 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
5353 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
5354 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
5355 ,Examining Memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
5356 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
5357 Variables}).
5358
5359 @table @code
5360 @kindex disassemble
5361 @cindex assembly instructions
5362 @cindex instructions, assembly
5363 @cindex machine instructions
5364 @cindex listing machine instructions
5365 @item disassemble
5366 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
5367 instructions. The default memory range is the function surrounding the
5368 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
5369 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
5370 surrounding this value. Two arguments specify a range of addresses
5371 (first inclusive, second exclusive) to dump.
5372 @end table
5373
5374 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
5375 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
5376
5377 @smallexample
5378 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4 0x32e4
5379 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
5380 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
5381 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
5382 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
5383 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
5384 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
5385 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
5386 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
5387 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
5388 End of assembler dump.
5389 @end smallexample
5390
5391 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
5392 mnemonics or other syntax.
5393
5394 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
5395 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
5396 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
5397 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
5398 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
5399
5400 @table @code
5401 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
5402 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
5403 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
5404 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
5405 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
5406 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
5407
5408 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
5409 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
5410 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
5411 assemblers for x86-based targets.
5412
5413 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
5414 @item show disassembly-flavor
5415 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
5416 @end table
5417
5418
5419 @node Data
5420 @chapter Examining Data
5421
5422 @cindex printing data
5423 @cindex examining data
5424 @kindex print
5425 @kindex inspect
5426 @c "inspect" is not quite a synonym if you are using Epoch, which we do not
5427 @c document because it is nonstandard... Under Epoch it displays in a
5428 @c different window or something like that.
5429 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
5430 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
5431 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
5432 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
5433 Different Languages}).
5434
5435 @table @code
5436 @item print @var{expr}
5437 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
5438 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
5439 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
5440 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
5441 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
5442 Formats}.
5443
5444 @item print
5445 @itemx print /@var{f}
5446 @cindex reprint the last value
5447 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
5448 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}). This allows you to
5449 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
5450 @end table
5451
5452 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
5453 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
5454 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
5455
5456 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
5457 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
5458 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
5459 Table}.
5460
5461 @menu
5462 * Expressions:: Expressions
5463 * Variables:: Program variables
5464 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
5465 * Output Formats:: Output formats
5466 * Memory:: Examining memory
5467 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
5468 * Print Settings:: Print settings
5469 * Value History:: Value history
5470 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
5471 * Registers:: Registers
5472 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
5473 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
5474 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
5475 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
5476 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
5477 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
5478 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
5479 character set than GDB does
5480 * Caching Remote Data:: Data caching for remote targets
5481 @end menu
5482
5483 @node Expressions
5484 @section Expressions
5485
5486 @cindex expressions
5487 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
5488 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
5489 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
5490 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
5491 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
5492 you compiled your program to include this information; see
5493 @ref{Compilation}.
5494
5495 @cindex arrays in expressions
5496 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
5497 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
5498 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to build up an array in
5499 memory that is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
5500
5501 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
5502 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
5503 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
5504 languages.
5505
5506 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
5507 expressions regardless of your programming language.
5508
5509 @cindex casts, in expressions
5510 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
5511 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
5512 at that address in memory.
5513 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
5514
5515 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
5516 to programming languages:
5517
5518 @table @code
5519 @item @@
5520 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
5521 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information.
5522
5523 @item ::
5524 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
5525 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}.
5526
5527 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
5528 @cindex type casting memory
5529 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
5530 @cindex casts, to view memory
5531 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
5532 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
5533 memory. @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or
5534 pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in
5535 a cast). This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is
5536 normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
5537 @end table
5538
5539 @node Variables
5540 @section Program Variables
5541
5542 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
5543 in your program.
5544
5545 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
5546 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either:
5547
5548 @itemize @bullet
5549 @item
5550 global (or file-static)
5551 @end itemize
5552
5553 @noindent or
5554
5555 @itemize @bullet
5556 @item
5557 visible according to the scope rules of the
5558 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
5559 @end itemize
5560
5561 @noindent This means that in the function
5562
5563 @smallexample
5564 foo (a)
5565 int a;
5566 @{
5567 bar (a);
5568 @{
5569 int b = test ();
5570 bar (b);
5571 @}
5572 @}
5573 @end smallexample
5574
5575 @noindent
5576 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
5577 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
5578 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
5579 the block where @code{b} is declared.
5580
5581 @cindex variable name conflict
5582 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
5583 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
5584 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
5585 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
5586 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
5587 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file,
5588 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
5589
5590 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
5591 @ifnotinfo
5592 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
5593 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
5594 @end ifnotinfo
5595 @smallexample
5596 @var{file}::@var{variable}
5597 @var{function}::@var{variable}
5598 @end smallexample
5599
5600 @noindent
5601 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
5602 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
5603 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
5604 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
5605
5606 @smallexample
5607 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
5608 @end smallexample
5609
5610 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
5611 This use of @samp{::} is very rarely in conflict with the very similar
5612 use of the same notation in C@t{++}. @value{GDBN} also supports use of the C@t{++}
5613 scope resolution operator in @value{GDBN} expressions.
5614 @c FIXME: Um, so what happens in one of those rare cases where it's in
5615 @c conflict?? --mew
5616
5617 @cindex wrong values
5618 @cindex variable values, wrong
5619 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
5620 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
5621 @quotation
5622 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
5623 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
5624 scope, and just before exit.
5625 @end quotation
5626 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
5627 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
5628 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
5629 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
5630 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
5631 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
5632 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
5633 variable definitions may be gone.
5634
5635 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
5636 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
5637 when compiling.
5638
5639 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
5640 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
5641 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
5642 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
5643 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
5644 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
5645 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
5646
5647 @smallexample
5648 No symbol "foo" in current context.
5649 @end smallexample
5650
5651 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
5652 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
5653 formats. For example, @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler,
5654 usually supports the @option{-gstabs+} option. @option{-gstabs+}
5655 produces debug info in a format that is superior to formats such as
5656 COFF. You may be able to use DWARF 2 (@option{-gdwarf-2}), which is also
5657 an effective form for debug info. @xref{Debugging Options,,Options
5658 for Debugging Your Program or GCC, gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu}
5659 Compiler Collection (GCC)}.
5660 @xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug info formats
5661 that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
5662
5663 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
5664 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
5665 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
5666 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
5667
5668 Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified
5669 signedness. Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get
5670 printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers. @code{-fsigned-char} or
5671 @code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN}
5672 defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign.
5673 For program code
5674
5675 @smallexample
5676 char var0[] = "A";
5677 signed char var1[] = "A";
5678 @end smallexample
5679
5680 You get during debugging
5681 @smallexample
5682 (gdb) print var0
5683 $1 = "A"
5684 (gdb) print var1
5685 $2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@}
5686 @end smallexample
5687
5688 @node Arrays
5689 @section Artificial Arrays
5690
5691 @cindex artificial array
5692 @cindex arrays
5693 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
5694 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
5695 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
5696 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
5697 program.
5698
5699 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
5700 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
5701 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
5702 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
5703 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
5704 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
5705 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
5706 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
5707 example. If a program says
5708
5709 @smallexample
5710 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
5711 @end smallexample
5712
5713 @noindent
5714 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
5715
5716 @smallexample
5717 p *array@@len
5718 @end smallexample
5719
5720 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
5721 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
5722 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
5723 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
5724 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out.
5725
5726 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
5727 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
5728 The value need not be in memory:
5729 @smallexample
5730 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
5731 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
5732 @end smallexample
5733
5734 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
5735 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
5736 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
5737 @smallexample
5738 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
5739 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
5740 @end smallexample
5741
5742 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
5743 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
5744 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
5745 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
5746 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
5747 Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
5748 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
5749 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
5750 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
5751 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
5752
5753 @smallexample
5754 set $i = 0
5755 p dtab[$i++]->fv
5756 @key{RET}
5757 @key{RET}
5758 @dots{}
5759 @end smallexample
5760
5761 @node Output Formats
5762 @section Output Formats
5763
5764 @cindex formatted output
5765 @cindex output formats
5766 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
5767 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
5768 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
5769 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
5770 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
5771
5772 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
5773 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
5774 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
5775 letters supported are:
5776
5777 @table @code
5778 @item x
5779 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
5780 hexadecimal.
5781
5782 @item d
5783 Print as integer in signed decimal.
5784
5785 @item u
5786 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
5787
5788 @item o
5789 Print as integer in octal.
5790
5791 @item t
5792 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
5793 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
5794 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
5795 see @ref{Memory,,Examining Memory}.}
5796
5797 @item a
5798 @cindex unknown address, locating
5799 @cindex locate address
5800 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
5801 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
5802 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
5803
5804 @smallexample
5805 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
5806 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
5807 @end smallexample
5808
5809 @noindent
5810 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
5811 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
5812
5813 @item c
5814 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
5815 prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
5816 character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
5817 for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
5818
5819 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays @code{char},
5820 @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} data as character
5821 constants. Single-byte members of vectors are displayed as integer
5822 data.
5823
5824 @item f
5825 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
5826 using typical floating point syntax.
5827
5828 @item s
5829 @cindex printing strings
5830 @cindex printing byte arrays
5831 Regard as a string, if possible. With this format, pointers to single-byte
5832 data are displayed as null-terminated strings and arrays of single-byte data
5833 are displayed as fixed-length strings. Other values are displayed in their
5834 natural types.
5835
5836 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays pointers to and arrays of
5837 @code{char}, @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} as
5838 strings. Single-byte members of a vector are displayed as an integer
5839 array.
5840 @end table
5841
5842 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
5843
5844 @smallexample
5845 p/x $pc
5846 @end smallexample
5847
5848 @noindent
5849 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
5850 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
5851
5852 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
5853 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
5854 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
5855
5856 @node Memory
5857 @section Examining Memory
5858
5859 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
5860 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
5861
5862 @cindex examining memory
5863 @table @code
5864 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
5865 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
5866 @itemx x @var{addr}
5867 @itemx x
5868 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
5869 @end table
5870
5871 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
5872 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
5873 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
5874 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
5875 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
5876
5877 @table @r
5878 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
5879 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
5880 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
5881 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
5882 @c 4.1.2.
5883
5884 @item @var{f}, the display format
5885 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
5886 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
5887 @samp{f}, @samp{s}), and in addition @samp{i} (for machine instructions).
5888 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes
5889 each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
5890
5891 @item @var{u}, the unit size
5892 The unit size is any of
5893
5894 @table @code
5895 @item b
5896 Bytes.
5897 @item h
5898 Halfwords (two bytes).
5899 @item w
5900 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
5901 @item g
5902 Giant words (eight bytes).
5903 @end table
5904
5905 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
5906 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. (For the @samp{s} and
5907 @samp{i} formats, the unit size is ignored and is normally not written.)
5908
5909 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
5910 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
5911 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
5912 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
5913 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
5914 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
5915 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
5916 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
5917 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
5918 a value from memory).
5919 @end table
5920
5921 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
5922 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
5923 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
5924 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
5925 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
5926
5927 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
5928 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
5929 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
5930 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
5931 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
5932
5933 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
5934 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
5935 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
5936 including any operands. For convenience, especially when used with
5937 the @code{display} command, the @samp{i} format also prints branch delay
5938 slot instructions, if any, beyond the count specified, which immediately
5939 follow the last instruction that is within the count. The command
5940 @code{disassemble} gives an alternative way of inspecting machine
5941 instructions; see @ref{Machine Code,,Source and Machine Code}.
5942
5943 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
5944 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
5945 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
5946 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
5947 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
5948 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
5949 for successive uses of @code{x}.
5950
5951 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
5952 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
5953 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
5954 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
5955 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
5956 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
5957 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
5958 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
5959 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
5960
5961 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
5962 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
5963 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
5964
5965 @cindex remote memory comparison
5966 @cindex verify remote memory image
5967 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
5968 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image in the
5969 remote machine's memory against the executable file you downloaded to
5970 the target. The @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such
5971 situations.
5972
5973 @table @code
5974 @kindex compare-sections
5975 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{]}
5976 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
5977 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
5978 the remote machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
5979 arguments, compares all loadable sections. This command's
5980 availability depends on the target's support for the @code{"qCRC"}
5981 remote request.
5982 @end table
5983
5984 @node Auto Display
5985 @section Automatic Display
5986 @cindex automatic display
5987 @cindex display of expressions
5988
5989 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
5990 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
5991 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
5992 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
5993 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
5994 The automatic display looks like this:
5995
5996 @smallexample
5997 2: foo = 38
5998 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
5999 @end smallexample
6000
6001 @noindent
6002 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
6003 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
6004 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
6005 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending your format
6006 specification---it uses @code{x} if you specify either the @samp{i}
6007 or @samp{s} format, or a unit size; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
6008
6009 @table @code
6010 @kindex display
6011 @item display @var{expr}
6012 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
6013 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
6014
6015 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
6016
6017 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
6018 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
6019 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
6020 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
6021 @xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}.
6022
6023 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
6024 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
6025 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
6026 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
6027 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
6028 @end table
6029
6030 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
6031 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
6032 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
6033
6034 @table @code
6035 @kindex delete display
6036 @kindex undisplay
6037 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
6038 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
6039 Remove item numbers @var{dnums} from the list of expressions to display.
6040
6041 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
6042 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
6043
6044 @kindex disable display
6045 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
6046 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
6047 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
6048 enabled again later.
6049
6050 @kindex enable display
6051 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
6052 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
6053 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
6054
6055 @item display
6056 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
6057 done when your program stops.
6058
6059 @kindex info display
6060 @item info display
6061 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
6062 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
6063 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
6064 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
6065 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
6066 @end table
6067
6068 @cindex display disabled out of scope
6069 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
6070 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
6071 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
6072 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
6073 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
6074 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
6075 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
6076 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
6077 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
6078 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
6079
6080 @node Print Settings
6081 @section Print Settings
6082
6083 @cindex format options
6084 @cindex print settings
6085 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
6086 and symbols are printed.
6087
6088 @noindent
6089 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
6090
6091 @table @code
6092 @kindex set print
6093 @item set print address
6094 @itemx set print address on
6095 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
6096 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
6097 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
6098 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
6099 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
6100 @code{set print address on}:
6101
6102 @smallexample
6103 @group
6104 (@value{GDBP}) f
6105 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
6106 at input.c:530
6107 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
6108 @end group
6109 @end smallexample
6110
6111 @item set print address off
6112 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
6113 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
6114
6115 @smallexample
6116 @group
6117 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
6118 (@value{GDBP}) f
6119 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
6120 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
6121 @end group
6122 @end smallexample
6123
6124 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
6125 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
6126 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
6127 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
6128
6129 @kindex show print
6130 @item show print address
6131 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
6132 @end table
6133
6134 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
6135 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
6136 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
6137 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
6138 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
6139 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
6140 it prints a symbolic address:
6141
6142 @table @code
6143 @item set print symbol-filename on
6144 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
6145 @cindex symbol, source file and line
6146 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
6147 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
6148
6149 @item set print symbol-filename off
6150 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
6151 default.
6152
6153 @item show print symbol-filename
6154 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
6155 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
6156 @end table
6157
6158 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
6159 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
6160 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
6161
6162 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
6163 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
6164
6165 @table @code
6166 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
6167 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
6168 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
6169 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
6170 @var{max-offset}. The default is 0, which tells @value{GDBN}
6171 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes it.
6172
6173 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
6174 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
6175 symbolic address.
6176 @end table
6177
6178 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
6179 @cindex pointer, finding referent
6180 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
6181 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
6182 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
6183 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
6184 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
6185 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
6186
6187 @smallexample
6188 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
6189 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
6190 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
6191 @end smallexample
6192
6193 @quotation
6194 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
6195 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
6196 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
6197 @end quotation
6198
6199 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
6200
6201 @table @code
6202 @item set print array
6203 @itemx set print array on
6204 @cindex pretty print arrays
6205 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
6206 but uses more space. The default is off.
6207
6208 @item set print array off
6209 Return to compressed format for arrays.
6210
6211 @item show print array
6212 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
6213 arrays.
6214
6215 @cindex print array indexes
6216 @item set print array-indexes
6217 @itemx set print array-indexes on
6218 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
6219 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
6220 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
6221
6222 @item set print array-indexes off
6223 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
6224
6225 @item show print array-indexes
6226 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
6227 arrays.
6228
6229 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
6230 @cindex number of array elements to print
6231 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
6232 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
6233 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
6234 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
6235 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
6236 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
6237 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to zero means that the printing is unlimited.
6238
6239 @item show print elements
6240 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
6241 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
6242
6243 @item set print repeats
6244 @cindex repeated array elements
6245 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
6246 elements. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
6247 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
6248 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
6249 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
6250 themselves. Setting the threshold to zero will cause all elements to
6251 be individually printed. The default threshold is 10.
6252
6253 @item show print repeats
6254 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
6255 elements.
6256
6257 @item set print null-stop
6258 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
6259 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
6260 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
6261 contain only short strings.
6262 The default is off.
6263
6264 @item show print null-stop
6265 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
6266 @sc{null} character.
6267
6268 @item set print pretty on
6269 @cindex print structures in indented form
6270 @cindex indentation in structure display
6271 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
6272 per line, like this:
6273
6274 @smallexample
6275 @group
6276 $1 = @{
6277 next = 0x0,
6278 flags = @{
6279 sweet = 1,
6280 sour = 1
6281 @},
6282 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
6283 @}
6284 @end group
6285 @end smallexample
6286
6287 @item set print pretty off
6288 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
6289
6290 @smallexample
6291 @group
6292 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
6293 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
6294 @end group
6295 @end smallexample
6296
6297 @noindent
6298 This is the default format.
6299
6300 @item show print pretty
6301 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
6302
6303 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
6304 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
6305 @cindex octal escapes in strings
6306 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
6307 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
6308 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
6309 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
6310 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
6311
6312 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
6313 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
6314 international character sets, and is the default.
6315
6316 @item show print sevenbit-strings
6317 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
6318
6319 @item set print union on
6320 @cindex unions in structures, printing
6321 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
6322 and other unions. This is the default setting.
6323
6324 @item set print union off
6325 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
6326 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
6327 instead.
6328
6329 @item show print union
6330 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
6331 structures and other unions.
6332
6333 For example, given the declarations
6334
6335 @smallexample
6336 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
6337 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
6338 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
6339 Bug_forms;
6340
6341 struct thing @{
6342 Species it;
6343 union @{
6344 Tree_forms tree;
6345 Bug_forms bug;
6346 @} form;
6347 @};
6348
6349 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
6350 @end smallexample
6351
6352 @noindent
6353 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
6354
6355 @smallexample
6356 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
6357 @end smallexample
6358
6359 @noindent
6360 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
6361
6362 @smallexample
6363 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
6364 @end smallexample
6365
6366 @noindent
6367 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
6368 and in Pascal.
6369 @end table
6370
6371 @need 1000
6372 @noindent
6373 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
6374
6375 @table @code
6376 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
6377 @item set print demangle
6378 @itemx set print demangle on
6379 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
6380 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
6381 linkage. The default is on.
6382
6383 @item show print demangle
6384 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
6385
6386 @item set print asm-demangle
6387 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
6388 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
6389 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
6390 The default is off.
6391
6392 @item show print asm-demangle
6393 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
6394 or demangled form.
6395
6396 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
6397 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
6398 @kindex set demangle-style
6399 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
6400 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
6401 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
6402
6403 @table @code
6404 @item auto
6405 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
6406
6407 @item gnu
6408 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
6409 This is the default.
6410
6411 @item hp
6412 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
6413
6414 @item lucid
6415 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
6416
6417 @item arm
6418 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
6419 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
6420 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
6421 require further enhancement to permit that.
6422
6423 @end table
6424 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
6425
6426 @item show demangle-style
6427 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
6428
6429 @item set print object
6430 @itemx set print object on
6431 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
6432 @cindex display derived types
6433 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
6434 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
6435 the virtual function table.
6436
6437 @item set print object off
6438 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
6439 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
6440
6441 @item show print object
6442 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
6443
6444 @item set print static-members
6445 @itemx set print static-members on
6446 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
6447 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
6448
6449 @item set print static-members off
6450 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
6451
6452 @item show print static-members
6453 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
6454
6455 @item set print pascal_static-members
6456 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
6457 @cindex static members of Pascal objects
6458 @cindex Pascal objects, static members display
6459 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
6460
6461 @item set print pascal_static-members off
6462 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
6463
6464 @item show print pascal_static-members
6465 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
6466
6467 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
6468 @item set print vtbl
6469 @itemx set print vtbl on
6470 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
6471 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
6472 @cindex VTBL display
6473 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
6474 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
6475 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
6476
6477 @item set print vtbl off
6478 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
6479
6480 @item show print vtbl
6481 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
6482 @end table
6483
6484 @node Value History
6485 @section Value History
6486
6487 @cindex value history
6488 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
6489 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
6490 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
6491 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
6492 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
6493 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
6494 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
6495 symbol table.
6496
6497 @cindex @code{$}
6498 @cindex @code{$$}
6499 @cindex history number
6500 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
6501 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
6502 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
6503 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
6504 history number.
6505
6506 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
6507 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
6508 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
6509 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
6510 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
6511 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
6512 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
6513
6514 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
6515 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
6516
6517 @smallexample
6518 p *$
6519 @end smallexample
6520
6521 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
6522 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
6523
6524 @smallexample
6525 p *$.next
6526 @end smallexample
6527
6528 @noindent
6529 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
6530 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
6531
6532 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
6533 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
6534
6535 @smallexample
6536 print x
6537 set x=5
6538 @end smallexample
6539
6540 @noindent
6541 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
6542 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
6543
6544 @table @code
6545 @kindex show values
6546 @item show values
6547 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
6548 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
6549 values} does not change the history.
6550
6551 @item show values @var{n}
6552 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
6553
6554 @item show values +
6555 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
6556 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
6557 @end table
6558
6559 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
6560 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
6561
6562 @node Convenience Vars
6563 @section Convenience Variables
6564
6565 @cindex convenience variables
6566 @cindex user-defined variables
6567 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
6568 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
6569 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
6570 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
6571 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
6572
6573 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
6574 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
6575 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
6576 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
6577 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.)
6578
6579 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
6580 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
6581 For example:
6582
6583 @smallexample
6584 set $foo = *object_ptr
6585 @end smallexample
6586
6587 @noindent
6588 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
6589 @code{object_ptr}.
6590
6591 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
6592 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
6593 value with another assignment at any time.
6594
6595 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
6596 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
6597 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
6598 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
6599
6600 @table @code
6601 @kindex show convenience
6602 @cindex show all user variables
6603 @item show convenience
6604 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values.
6605 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
6606
6607 @kindex init-if-undefined
6608 @cindex convenience variables, initializing
6609 @item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
6610 Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
6611 for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
6612 to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
6613 convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
6614 override default values used in a command script.
6615
6616 If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
6617 any side-effects do not occur.
6618 @end table
6619
6620 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
6621 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
6622 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
6623
6624 @smallexample
6625 set $i = 0
6626 print bar[$i++]->contents
6627 @end smallexample
6628
6629 @noindent
6630 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
6631
6632 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
6633 values likely to be useful.
6634
6635 @table @code
6636 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
6637 @item $_
6638 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
6639 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). Other
6640 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
6641 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
6642 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
6643 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
6644 to the type of @code{$__}.
6645
6646 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
6647 @item $__
6648 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
6649 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
6650 to match the format in which the data was printed.
6651
6652 @item $_exitcode
6653 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
6654 The variable @code{$_exitcode} is automatically set to the exit code when
6655 the program being debugged terminates.
6656 @end table
6657
6658 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
6659 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
6660 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
6661
6662 @node Registers
6663 @section Registers
6664
6665 @cindex registers
6666 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
6667 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
6668 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
6669 your machine.
6670
6671 @table @code
6672 @kindex info registers
6673 @item info registers
6674 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
6675 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
6676
6677 @kindex info all-registers
6678 @cindex floating point registers
6679 @item info all-registers
6680 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
6681 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
6682
6683 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
6684 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
6685 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
6686 the selected stack frame. @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
6687 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
6688 @end table
6689
6690 @cindex stack pointer register
6691 @cindex program counter register
6692 @cindex process status register
6693 @cindex frame pointer register
6694 @cindex standard registers
6695 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
6696 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
6697 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
6698 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
6699 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
6700 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
6701 register that contains the processor status. For example,
6702 you could print the program counter in hex with
6703
6704 @smallexample
6705 p/x $pc
6706 @end smallexample
6707
6708 @noindent
6709 or print the instruction to be executed next with
6710
6711 @smallexample
6712 x/i $pc
6713 @end smallexample
6714
6715 @noindent
6716 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
6717 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
6718 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
6719 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
6720 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
6721 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
6722 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with
6723
6724 @smallexample
6725 set $sp += 4
6726 @end smallexample
6727
6728 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
6729 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
6730 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
6731 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
6732 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
6733 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
6734 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
6735
6736 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
6737 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
6738 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
6739 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
6740 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
6741 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
6742 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
6743
6744 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
6745 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
6746 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
6747 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
6748 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
6749 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
6750 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
6751 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
6752 prints the data in both formats.
6753
6754 @cindex SSE registers (x86)
6755 @cindex MMX registers (x86)
6756 Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
6757 in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
6758 have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
6759 together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
6760 registers in @code{struct} notation:
6761
6762 @smallexample
6763 (@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
6764 $1 = @{
6765 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
6766 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
6767 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
6768 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
6769 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
6770 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
6771 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
6772 @}
6773 @end smallexample
6774
6775 @noindent
6776 To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
6777 view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
6778 value to a @code{struct} member:
6779
6780 @smallexample
6781 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
6782 @end smallexample
6783
6784 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
6785 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). This means that you get the
6786 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
6787 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
6788 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
6789 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
6790
6791 However, @value{GDBN} must deduce where registers are saved, from the machine
6792 code generated by your compiler. If some registers are not saved, or if
6793 @value{GDBN} is unable to locate the saved registers, the selected stack
6794 frame makes no difference.
6795
6796 @node Floating Point Hardware
6797 @section Floating Point Hardware
6798 @cindex floating point
6799
6800 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
6801 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
6802
6803 @table @code
6804 @kindex info float
6805 @item info float
6806 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
6807 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
6808 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
6809 the ARM and x86 machines.
6810 @end table
6811
6812 @node Vector Unit
6813 @section Vector Unit
6814 @cindex vector unit
6815
6816 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
6817 more information about the status of the vector unit.
6818
6819 @table @code
6820 @kindex info vector
6821 @item info vector
6822 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
6823 layout vary depending on the hardware.
6824 @end table
6825
6826 @node OS Information
6827 @section Operating System Auxiliary Information
6828 @cindex OS information
6829
6830 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
6831 you debug your program.
6832
6833 @cindex @code{ptrace} system call
6834 @cindex @code{struct user} contents
6835 When @value{GDBN} runs on a @dfn{Posix system} (such as GNU or Unix
6836 machines), it interfaces with the inferior via the @code{ptrace}
6837 system call. The operating system creates a special sata structure,
6838 called @code{struct user}, for this interface. You can use the
6839 command @code{info udot} to display the contents of this data
6840 structure.
6841
6842 @table @code
6843 @item info udot
6844 @kindex info udot
6845 Display the contents of the @code{struct user} maintained by the OS
6846 kernel for the program being debugged. @value{GDBN} displays the
6847 contents of @code{struct user} as a list of hex numbers, similar to
6848 the @code{examine} command.
6849 @end table
6850
6851 @cindex auxiliary vector
6852 @cindex vector, auxiliary
6853 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
6854 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
6855 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
6856 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
6857 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
6858 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
6859 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
6860 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
6861 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
6862 support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
6863 @ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
6864
6865 @table @code
6866 @kindex info auxv
6867 @item info auxv
6868 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
6869 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
6870 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
6871 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
6872 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
6873 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
6874 an unrecognized tag.
6875 @end table
6876
6877
6878 @node Memory Region Attributes
6879 @section Memory Region Attributes
6880 @cindex memory region attributes
6881
6882 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
6883 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
6884 attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
6885 accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
6886 target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
6887 fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
6888 user can override the fetched regions.
6889
6890 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
6891 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
6892 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
6893 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
6894 all memory.
6895
6896 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
6897 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
6898
6899 @table @code
6900 @kindex mem
6901 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
6902 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
6903 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
6904 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
6905 case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address.
6906 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
6907
6908 @item mem auto
6909 Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
6910 regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
6911
6912 @kindex delete mem
6913 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
6914 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
6915 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
6916
6917 @kindex disable mem
6918 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
6919 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
6920 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
6921 It may be enabled again later.
6922
6923 @kindex enable mem
6924 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
6925 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
6926
6927 @kindex info mem
6928 @item info mem
6929 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
6930 for each region:
6931
6932 @table @emph
6933 @item Memory Region Number
6934 @item Enabled or Disabled.
6935 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
6936 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
6937
6938 @item Lo Address
6939 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
6940
6941 @item Hi Address
6942 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
6943
6944 @item Attributes
6945 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
6946 @end table
6947 @end table
6948
6949
6950 @subsection Attributes
6951
6952 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
6953 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
6954 write accesses to a memory region.
6955
6956 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
6957 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
6958 etc.@: from accessing memory.
6959
6960 @table @code
6961 @item ro
6962 Memory is read only.
6963 @item wo
6964 Memory is write only.
6965 @item rw
6966 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
6967 @end table
6968
6969 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
6970 The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
6971 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
6972 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
6973 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
6974
6975 @table @code
6976 @item 8
6977 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
6978 @item 16
6979 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
6980 @item 32
6981 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
6982 @item 64
6983 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
6984 @end table
6985
6986 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
6987 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
6988 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
6989 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
6990 @c
6991 @c @table @code
6992 @c @item hwbreak
6993 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
6994 @c @item swbreak (default)
6995 @c @end table
6996
6997 @subsubsection Data Cache
6998 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
6999 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
7000 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
7001 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
7002 registers.
7003
7004 @table @code
7005 @item cache
7006 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
7007 @item nocache
7008 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
7009 @end table
7010
7011 @subsection Memory Access Checking
7012 @value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
7013 not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such
7014 regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
7015 better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour.
7016
7017 @table @code
7018 @kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
7019 @item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
7020 If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not
7021 explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
7022 to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one
7023 memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
7024 treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
7025 The default value is @code{on}.
7026 @kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
7027 @item show mem inaccessible-by-default
7028 Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
7029 @end table
7030
7031
7032 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
7033 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
7034 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
7035 @c
7036 @c @table @code
7037 @c @item verify
7038 @c @item noverify (default)
7039 @c @end table
7040
7041 @node Dump/Restore Files
7042 @section Copy Between Memory and a File
7043 @cindex dump/restore files
7044 @cindex append data to a file
7045 @cindex dump data to a file
7046 @cindex restore data from a file
7047
7048 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
7049 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
7050 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
7051 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
7052 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex, or
7053 Tektronix Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only append to binary
7054 files.
7055
7056 @table @code
7057
7058 @kindex dump
7059 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
7060 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
7061 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
7062 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
7063
7064 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
7065 @table @code
7066 @item binary
7067 Raw binary form.
7068 @item ihex
7069 Intel hex format.
7070 @item srec
7071 Motorola S-record format.
7072 @item tekhex
7073 Tektronix Hex format.
7074 @end table
7075
7076 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
7077 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
7078 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
7079 form.
7080
7081 @kindex append
7082 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
7083 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
7084 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
7085 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
7086 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
7087
7088 @kindex restore
7089 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
7090 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
7091 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
7092 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
7093 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
7094
7095 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
7096 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
7097 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
7098 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
7099 from that location.
7100
7101 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
7102 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
7103 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
7104 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
7105
7106 @end table
7107
7108 @node Core File Generation
7109 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
7110 @cindex dump core from inferior
7111
7112 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
7113 image of a running process and its process status (register values
7114 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
7115 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
7116 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
7117 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
7118 the post-mortem debugging mode.
7119
7120 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
7121 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
7122 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
7123
7124 @table @code
7125 @kindex gcore
7126 @kindex generate-core-file
7127 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
7128 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
7129 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
7130 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
7131 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
7132 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
7133
7134 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
7135 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, Unixware, and S390).
7136 @end table
7137
7138 @node Character Sets
7139 @section Character Sets
7140 @cindex character sets
7141 @cindex charset
7142 @cindex translating between character sets
7143 @cindex host character set
7144 @cindex target character set
7145
7146 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
7147 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
7148 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
7149 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
7150 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
7151 @dfn{target character set}.
7152
7153 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
7154 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
7155 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
7156 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
7157 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
7158 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
7159 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
7160 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
7161 character and string literals in expressions.
7162
7163 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
7164 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
7165 target-charset} command, described below.
7166
7167 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
7168 support:
7169
7170 @table @code
7171 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
7172 @kindex set target-charset
7173 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. We list the
7174 character set names @value{GDBN} recognizes below, but if you type
7175 @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} will
7176 list the target character sets it supports.
7177 @end table
7178
7179 @table @code
7180 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
7181 @kindex set host-charset
7182 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
7183
7184 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
7185 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
7186 @code{set host-charset} command.
7187
7188 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
7189 set. We list the character set names @value{GDBN} recognizes below, and
7190 indicate which can be host character sets, but if you type
7191 @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} will
7192 list the host character sets it supports.
7193
7194 @item set charset @var{charset}
7195 @kindex set charset
7196 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
7197 above, if you type @code{set charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
7198 @value{GDBN} will list the name of the character sets that can be used
7199 for both host and target.
7200
7201
7202 @item show charset
7203 @kindex show charset
7204 Show the names of the current host and target charsets.
7205
7206 @itemx show host-charset
7207 @kindex show host-charset
7208 Show the name of the current host charset.
7209
7210 @itemx show target-charset
7211 @kindex show target-charset
7212 Show the name of the current target charset.
7213
7214 @end table
7215
7216 @value{GDBN} currently includes support for the following character
7217 sets:
7218
7219 @table @code
7220
7221 @item ASCII
7222 @cindex ASCII character set
7223 Seven-bit U.S. @sc{ascii}. @value{GDBN} can use this as its host
7224 character set.
7225
7226 @item ISO-8859-1
7227 @cindex ISO 8859-1 character set
7228 @cindex ISO Latin 1 character set
7229 The ISO Latin 1 character set. This extends @sc{ascii} with accented
7230 characters needed for French, German, and Spanish. @value{GDBN} can use
7231 this as its host character set.
7232
7233 @item EBCDIC-US
7234 @itemx IBM1047
7235 @cindex EBCDIC character set
7236 @cindex IBM1047 character set
7237 Variants of the @sc{ebcdic} character set, used on some of IBM's
7238 mainframe operating systems. (@sc{gnu}/Linux on the S/390 uses U.S. @sc{ascii}.)
7239 @value{GDBN} cannot use these as its host character set.
7240
7241 @end table
7242
7243 Note that these are all single-byte character sets. More work inside
7244 @value{GDBN} is needed to support multi-byte or variable-width character
7245 encodings, like the UTF-8 and UCS-2 encodings of Unicode.
7246
7247 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
7248 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
7249 @file{charset-test.c}:
7250
7251 @smallexample
7252 #include <stdio.h>
7253
7254 char ascii_hello[]
7255 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
7256 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
7257 char ibm1047_hello[]
7258 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
7259 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
7260
7261 main ()
7262 @{
7263 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7264 @}
7265 @end smallexample
7266
7267 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
7268 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
7269 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
7270
7271 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
7272
7273 @smallexample
7274 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
7275 $ gdb -nw charset-test
7276 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
7277 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
7278 @dots{}
7279 (@value{GDBP})
7280 @end smallexample
7281
7282 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
7283 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
7284 strings:
7285
7286 @smallexample
7287 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
7288 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
7289 (@value{GDBP})
7290 @end smallexample
7291
7292 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
7293 initial character set:
7294 @smallexample
7295 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
7296 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
7297 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
7298 (@value{GDBP})
7299 @end smallexample
7300
7301 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
7302 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
7303 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
7304 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
7305 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
7306
7307 @smallexample
7308 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
7309 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
7310 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
7311 $2 = 72 'H'
7312 (@value{GDBP})
7313 @end smallexample
7314
7315 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
7316 literals you use in expressions:
7317
7318 @smallexample
7319 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
7320 $3 = 43 '+'
7321 (@value{GDBP})
7322 @end smallexample
7323
7324 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
7325 character.
7326
7327 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
7328 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
7329 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
7330
7331 @smallexample
7332 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
7333 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
7334 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
7335 $5 = 200 '\310'
7336 (@value{GDBP})
7337 @end smallexample
7338
7339 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
7340 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
7341
7342 @smallexample
7343 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
7344 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
7345 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
7346 @end smallexample
7347
7348 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
7349 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
7350 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
7351 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
7352 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
7353
7354 @smallexample
7355 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
7356 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
7357 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
7358 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
7359 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
7360 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
7361 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
7362 $7 = 72 '\110'
7363 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
7364 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
7365 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
7366 $9 = 200 'H'
7367 (@value{GDBP})
7368 @end smallexample
7369
7370 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
7371 string literals you use in expressions:
7372
7373 @smallexample
7374 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
7375 $10 = 78 '+'
7376 (@value{GDBP})
7377 @end smallexample
7378
7379 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
7380 character.
7381
7382 @node Caching Remote Data
7383 @section Caching Data of Remote Targets
7384 @cindex caching data of remote targets
7385
7386 @value{GDBN} can cache data exchanged between the debugger and a
7387 remote target (@pxref{Remote Debugging}). Such caching generally improves
7388 performance, because it reduces the overhead of the remote protocol by
7389 bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks. Unfortunately,
7390 @value{GDBN} does not currently know anything about volatile
7391 registers, and thus data caching will produce incorrect results when
7392 volatile registers are in use.
7393
7394 @table @code
7395 @kindex set remotecache
7396 @item set remotecache on
7397 @itemx set remotecache off
7398 Set caching state for remote targets. When @code{ON}, use data
7399 caching. By default, this option is @code{OFF}.
7400
7401 @kindex show remotecache
7402 @item show remotecache
7403 Show the current state of data caching for remote targets.
7404
7405 @kindex info dcache
7406 @item info dcache
7407 Print the information about the data cache performance. The
7408 information displayed includes: the dcache width and depth; and for
7409 each cache line, how many times it was referenced, and its data and
7410 state (dirty, bad, ok, etc.). This command is useful for debugging
7411 the data cache operation.
7412 @end table
7413
7414
7415 @node Macros
7416 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
7417
7418 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
7419 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
7420 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
7421 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
7422 where it was defined.
7423
7424 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
7425 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
7426 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
7427 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
7428
7429 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
7430 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
7431 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
7432 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
7433 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
7434 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
7435 see @ref{List}.
7436
7437 At the moment, @value{GDBN} does not support the @code{##}
7438 token-splicing operator, the @code{#} stringification operator, or
7439 variable-arity macros.
7440
7441 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
7442 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
7443 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
7444
7445 @table @code
7446
7447 @kindex macro expand
7448 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
7449 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
7450 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
7451 @item macro expand @var{expression}
7452 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
7453 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
7454 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
7455 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
7456 it can be any string of tokens.
7457
7458 @kindex macro exp1
7459 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
7460 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
7461 @cindex expand macro once
7462 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
7463 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
7464 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
7465 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
7466 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
7467 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
7468 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
7469 can be any string of tokens.
7470
7471 @kindex info macro
7472 @cindex macro definition, showing
7473 @cindex definition, showing a macro's
7474 @item info macro @var{macro}
7475 Show the definition of the macro named @var{macro}, and describe the
7476 source location where that definition was established.
7477
7478 @kindex macro define
7479 @cindex user-defined macros
7480 @cindex defining macros interactively
7481 @cindex macros, user-defined
7482 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
7483 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
7484 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Introduce a definition for a
7485 preprocessor macro named @var{macro}, invocations of which are replaced
7486 by the tokens given in @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this
7487 command defines an ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the
7488 second form defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments
7489 given in @var{arglist}.
7490
7491 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every expression
7492 evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the @command{macro
7493 undef} command, described below. The definition overrides all
7494 definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged, as
7495 well as any previous user-supplied definition.
7496
7497 @kindex macro undef
7498 @item macro undef @var{macro}
7499 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Remove any user-supplied
7500 definition for the macro named @var{macro}. This command only affects
7501 definitions provided with the @command{macro define} command, described
7502 above; it cannot remove definitions present in the program being
7503 debugged.
7504
7505 @kindex macro list
7506 @item macro list
7507 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} List all the macros
7508 defined using the @code{macro define} command.
7509 @end table
7510
7511 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
7512 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
7513 show our source files:
7514
7515 @smallexample
7516 $ cat sample.c
7517 #include <stdio.h>
7518 #include "sample.h"
7519
7520 #define M 42
7521 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
7522
7523 main ()
7524 @{
7525 #define N 28
7526 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7527 #undef N
7528 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
7529 #define N 1729
7530 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
7531 @}
7532 $ cat sample.h
7533 #define Q <
7534 $
7535 @end smallexample
7536
7537 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler, @value{NGCC}.
7538 We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3} flags to ensure the
7539 compiler includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
7540 information.
7541
7542 @smallexample
7543 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
7544 $
7545 @end smallexample
7546
7547 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
7548
7549 @smallexample
7550 $ gdb -nw sample
7551 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
7552 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
7553 GDB is free software, @dots{}
7554 (@value{GDBP})
7555 @end smallexample
7556
7557 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
7558 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
7559 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
7560
7561 @smallexample
7562 (@value{GDBP}) list main
7563 3
7564 4 #define M 42
7565 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
7566 6
7567 7 main ()
7568 8 @{
7569 9 #define N 28
7570 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7571 11 #undef N
7572 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
7573 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
7574 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
7575 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
7576 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
7577 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
7578 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
7579 #define Q <
7580 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
7581 expands to: (42 + 1)
7582 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
7583 expands to: once (M + 1)
7584 (@value{GDBP})
7585 @end smallexample
7586
7587 In the example above, note that @command{macro expand-once} expands only
7588 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
7589 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
7590 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
7591
7592 Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in
7593 force at the source line of the current stack frame:
7594
7595 @smallexample
7596 (@value{GDBP}) break main
7597 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
7598 (@value{GDBP}) run
7599 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
7600
7601 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
7602 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7603 (@value{GDBP})
7604 @end smallexample
7605
7606 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
7607
7608 @smallexample
7609 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
7610 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
7611 #define N 28
7612 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
7613 expands to: 28 < 42
7614 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
7615 $1 = 1
7616 (@value{GDBP})
7617 @end smallexample
7618
7619 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
7620 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
7621 thereof) in force at each point:
7622
7623 @smallexample
7624 (@value{GDBP}) next
7625 Hello, world!
7626 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
7627 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
7628 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
7629 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
7630 (@value{GDBP}) next
7631 We're so creative.
7632 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
7633 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
7634 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
7635 #define N 1729
7636 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
7637 expands to: 1729 < 42
7638 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
7639 $2 = 0
7640 (@value{GDBP})
7641 @end smallexample
7642
7643
7644 @node Tracepoints
7645 @chapter Tracepoints
7646 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
7647 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
7648
7649 @cindex tracepoints
7650 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
7651 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
7652 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
7653 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
7654 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
7655 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
7656 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
7657
7658 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
7659 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
7660 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
7661 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
7662 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
7663 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
7664 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
7665 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
7666 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
7667 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
7668 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
7669
7670 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
7671 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
7672 how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
7673 remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
7674 support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
7675 packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
7676 Packets}.
7677
7678 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
7679
7680 @menu
7681 * Set Tracepoints::
7682 * Analyze Collected Data::
7683 * Tracepoint Variables::
7684 @end menu
7685
7686 @node Set Tracepoints
7687 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
7688
7689 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
7690 tracepoints can be set. Like a breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), a
7691 tracepoint has a number assigned to it by @value{GDBN}. Like with
7692 breakpoints, tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from
7693 one. Many of the commands associated with tracepoints take the
7694 tracepoint number as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to
7695 work on.
7696
7697 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
7698 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
7699 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
7700 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
7701 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
7702 tracepoint was hit.
7703
7704 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
7705 conditions and actions.
7706
7707 @menu
7708 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
7709 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
7710 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
7711 * Tracepoint Actions::
7712 * Listing Tracepoints::
7713 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments::
7714 @end menu
7715
7716 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
7717 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
7718
7719 @table @code
7720 @cindex set tracepoint
7721 @kindex trace
7722 @item trace
7723 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
7724 Its argument can be a source line, a function name, or an address in
7725 the target program. @xref{Set Breaks}. The @code{trace} command
7726 defines a tracepoint, which is a point in the target program where the
7727 debugger will briefly stop, collect some data, and then allow the
7728 program to continue. Setting a tracepoint or changing its commands
7729 doesn't take effect until the next @code{tstart} command; thus, you
7730 cannot change the tracepoint attributes once a trace experiment is
7731 running.
7732
7733 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
7734
7735 @smallexample
7736 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
7737
7738 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
7739
7740 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
7741
7742 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
7743
7744 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
7745 @end smallexample
7746
7747 @noindent
7748 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
7749
7750 @vindex $tpnum
7751 @cindex last tracepoint number
7752 @cindex recent tracepoint number
7753 @cindex tracepoint number
7754 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
7755 of the most recently set tracepoint.
7756
7757 @kindex delete tracepoint
7758 @cindex tracepoint deletion
7759 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7760 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
7761 default is to delete all tracepoints.
7762
7763 Examples:
7764
7765 @smallexample
7766 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
7767
7768 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
7769 @end smallexample
7770
7771 @noindent
7772 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
7773 @end table
7774
7775 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
7776 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
7777
7778 @table @code
7779 @kindex disable tracepoint
7780 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7781 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
7782 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
7783 the next trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
7784 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
7785
7786 @kindex enable tracepoint
7787 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7788 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. The enabled
7789 tracepoints will become effective the next time a trace experiment is
7790 run.
7791 @end table
7792
7793 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
7794 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
7795
7796 @table @code
7797 @kindex passcount
7798 @cindex tracepoint pass count
7799 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
7800 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
7801 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
7802 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
7803 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
7804 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
7805 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
7806 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
7807 user.
7808
7809 Examples:
7810
7811 @smallexample
7812 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
7813 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
7814
7815 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
7816 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
7817 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
7818 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
7819 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
7820 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
7821 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
7822 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
7823 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
7824 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
7825 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
7826 @end smallexample
7827 @end table
7828
7829 @node Tracepoint Actions
7830 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
7831
7832 @table @code
7833 @kindex actions
7834 @cindex tracepoint actions
7835 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7836 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
7837 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
7838 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
7839 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
7840 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
7841 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
7842 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
7843 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect} and
7844 @code{while-stepping}.
7845
7846 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
7847 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
7848 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
7849
7850 @smallexample
7851 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
7852
7853 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
7854
7855 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
7856 @end smallexample
7857
7858 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
7859 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
7860 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
7861 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
7862 followed by the list of things to be collected while stepping. The
7863 @code{while-stepping} command is terminated by its own separate
7864 @code{end} command. Lastly, the action list is terminated by an
7865 @code{end} command.
7866
7867 @smallexample
7868 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
7869 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
7870 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
7871 > collect bar,baz
7872 > collect $regs
7873 > while-stepping 12
7874 > collect $fp, $sp
7875 > end
7876 end
7877 @end smallexample
7878
7879 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
7880 @item collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
7881 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
7882 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
7883 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
7884 special arguments are supported:
7885
7886 @table @code
7887 @item $regs
7888 collect all registers
7889
7890 @item $args
7891 collect all function arguments
7892
7893 @item $locals
7894 collect all local variables.
7895 @end table
7896
7897 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
7898 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
7899 arguments separated by commas: the effect is the same.
7900
7901 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
7902 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
7903
7904 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
7905 @item while-stepping @var{n}
7906 Perform @var{n} single-step traces after the tracepoint, collecting
7907 new data at each step. The @code{while-stepping} command is
7908 followed by the list of what to collect while stepping (followed by
7909 its own @code{end} command):
7910
7911 @smallexample
7912 > while-stepping 12
7913 > collect $regs, myglobal
7914 > end
7915 >
7916 @end smallexample
7917
7918 @noindent
7919 You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
7920 @code{stepping}.
7921 @end table
7922
7923 @node Listing Tracepoints
7924 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
7925
7926 @table @code
7927 @kindex info tracepoints
7928 @kindex info tp
7929 @cindex information about tracepoints
7930 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7931 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't specify
7932 a tracepoint number, displays information about all the tracepoints
7933 defined so far. For each tracepoint, the following information is
7934 shown:
7935
7936 @itemize @bullet
7937 @item
7938 its number
7939 @item
7940 whether it is enabled or disabled
7941 @item
7942 its address
7943 @item
7944 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
7945 @item
7946 its step count as given by the @code{while-stepping @var{n}} command
7947 @item
7948 where in the source files is the tracepoint set
7949 @item
7950 its action list as given by the @code{actions} command
7951 @end itemize
7952
7953 @smallexample
7954 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
7955 Num Enb Address PassC StepC What
7956 1 y 0x002117c4 0 0 <gdb_asm>
7957 2 y 0x0020dc64 0 0 in g_test at g_test.c:1375
7958 3 y 0x0020b1f4 0 0 in get_data at ../foo.c:41
7959 (@value{GDBP})
7960 @end smallexample
7961
7962 @noindent
7963 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
7964 @end table
7965
7966 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
7967 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
7968
7969 @table @code
7970 @kindex tstart
7971 @cindex start a new trace experiment
7972 @cindex collected data discarded
7973 @item tstart
7974 This command takes no arguments. It starts the trace experiment, and
7975 begins collecting data. This has the side effect of discarding all
7976 the data collected in the trace buffer during the previous trace
7977 experiment.
7978
7979 @kindex tstop
7980 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
7981 @item tstop
7982 This command takes no arguments. It ends the trace experiment, and
7983 stops collecting data.
7984
7985 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
7986 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
7987 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
7988
7989 @kindex tstatus
7990 @cindex status of trace data collection
7991 @cindex trace experiment, status of
7992 @item tstatus
7993 This command displays the status of the current trace data
7994 collection.
7995 @end table
7996
7997 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
7998
7999 @smallexample
8000 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
8001 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
8002 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
8003 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
8004 > while-stepping 11
8005 > collect $regs
8006 > end
8007 > end
8008 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
8009 [time passes @dots{}]
8010 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
8011 @end smallexample
8012
8013
8014 @node Analyze Collected Data
8015 @section Using the Collected Data
8016
8017 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
8018 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
8019 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
8020 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
8021 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
8022 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
8023 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
8024 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
8025 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
8026 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
8027 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
8028 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
8029 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
8030 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
8031 the buffer will fail.
8032
8033 @menu
8034 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
8035 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
8036 * save-tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
8037 @end menu
8038
8039 @node tfind
8040 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
8041
8042 @kindex tfind
8043 @cindex select trace snapshot
8044 @cindex find trace snapshot
8045 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
8046 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
8047 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
8048 snapshot is selected.
8049
8050 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
8051
8052 @table @code
8053 @item tfind start
8054 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
8055 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
8056
8057 @item tfind none
8058 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
8059
8060 @item tfind end
8061 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
8062
8063 @item tfind
8064 No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
8065
8066 @item tfind -
8067 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
8068 retracing earlier steps.
8069
8070 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
8071 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
8072 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
8073 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
8074 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
8075
8076 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
8077 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
8078 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
8079 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
8080 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
8081
8082 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
8083 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
8084 addresses.
8085
8086 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
8087 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
8088 @var{addr2}. @c FIXME: Is the range inclusive or exclusive?
8089
8090 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
8091 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
8092 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
8093 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
8094 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
8095 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
8096 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
8097 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
8098 @end table
8099
8100 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
8101 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
8102 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
8103 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
8104 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
8105 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
8106 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
8107 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
8108 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
8109 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
8110 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
8111 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
8112 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
8113 tracepoint as the current one.
8114
8115 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
8116 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
8117 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
8118 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
8119 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
8120
8121 @smallexample
8122 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
8123 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
8124 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
8125 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
8126 > tfind
8127 > end
8128
8129 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
8130 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
8131 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
8132 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
8133 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
8134 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
8135 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
8136 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
8137 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
8138 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
8139 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
8140 @end smallexample
8141
8142 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
8143 the buffer:
8144
8145 @smallexample
8146 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
8147 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
8148 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
8149 > tfind line
8150 > end
8151
8152 Frame 0, X = 1
8153 Frame 7, X = 2
8154 Frame 13, X = 255
8155 @end smallexample
8156
8157 @node tdump
8158 @subsection @code{tdump}
8159 @kindex tdump
8160 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
8161 @cindex tracepoint data, display
8162
8163 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
8164 the current trace snapshot.
8165
8166 @smallexample
8167 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
8168 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
8169 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
8170 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
8171 > end
8172
8173 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
8174
8175 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
8176 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
8177 at gdb_test.c:444
8178 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
8179
8180 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
8181 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
8182 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
8183 d1 0x18 24
8184 d2 0x80 128
8185 d3 0x33 51
8186 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
8187 d5 0x22 34
8188 d6 0xe0 224
8189 d7 0x380035 3670069
8190 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
8191 a1 0x3000668 50333288
8192 a2 0x100 256
8193 a3 0x322000 3284992
8194 a4 0x3000698 50333336
8195 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
8196 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
8197 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
8198 ps 0x0 0
8199 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
8200 fpcontrol 0x0 0
8201 fpstatus 0x0 0
8202 fpiaddr 0x0 0
8203 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
8204 p1 = (void *) 0x11
8205 p2 = (void *) 0x22
8206 p3 = (void *) 0x33
8207 p4 = (void *) 0x44
8208 p5 = (void *) 0x55
8209 p6 = (void *) 0x66
8210 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
8211
8212 (@value{GDBP})
8213 @end smallexample
8214
8215 @node save-tracepoints
8216 @subsection @code{save-tracepoints @var{filename}}
8217 @kindex save-tracepoints
8218 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
8219
8220 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
8221 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
8222 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
8223 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
8224 Files}).
8225
8226 @node Tracepoint Variables
8227 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
8228 @cindex tracepoint variables
8229 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
8230
8231 @table @code
8232 @vindex $trace_frame
8233 @item (int) $trace_frame
8234 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
8235 snapshot is selected.
8236
8237 @vindex $tracepoint
8238 @item (int) $tracepoint
8239 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
8240
8241 @vindex $trace_line
8242 @item (int) $trace_line
8243 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
8244
8245 @vindex $trace_file
8246 @item (char []) $trace_file
8247 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
8248
8249 @vindex $trace_func
8250 @item (char []) $trace_func
8251 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
8252 @end table
8253
8254 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
8255 use @code{output} instead.
8256
8257 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
8258 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
8259 data.
8260
8261 @smallexample
8262 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
8263
8264 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
8265 > output $trace_file
8266 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
8267 > tfind
8268 > end
8269 @end smallexample
8270
8271 @node Overlays
8272 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
8273 @cindex overlays
8274
8275 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
8276 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
8277 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
8278 use overlays.
8279
8280 @menu
8281 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
8282 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
8283 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
8284 mapped by asking the inferior.
8285 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
8286 @end menu
8287
8288 @node How Overlays Work
8289 @section How Overlays Work
8290 @cindex mapped overlays
8291 @cindex unmapped overlays
8292 @cindex load address, overlay's
8293 @cindex mapped address
8294 @cindex overlay area
8295
8296 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
8297 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
8298 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
8299 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
8300 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
8301
8302 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
8303 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
8304 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
8305 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
8306 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
8307 largest overlay as well.
8308
8309 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
8310 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
8311 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
8312 there.
8313
8314 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
8315 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
8316 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
8317
8318 @smallexample
8319 @group
8320 Data Instruction Larger
8321 Address Space Address Space Address Space
8322 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
8323 | | | | | |
8324 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
8325 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
8326 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
8327 | and heap | | | | | |
8328 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
8329 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
8330 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
8331 | | | | | |
8332 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
8333 address | | | | | |
8334 | overlay | <-' | | |
8335 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
8336 | | <---. | | load address
8337 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
8338 | | | |
8339 +-----------+ | |
8340 +-----------+
8341 | |
8342 +-----------+
8343
8344 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
8345 @end group
8346 @end smallexample
8347
8348 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
8349 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
8350 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
8351 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
8352 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
8353 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
8354 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
8355 program and the overlay area.
8356
8357 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
8358 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
8359 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
8360 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
8361 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
8362 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
8363 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
8364
8365 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
8366 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
8367 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
8368
8369 @itemize @bullet
8370
8371 @item
8372 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
8373 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
8374 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
8375 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
8376
8377 @item
8378 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
8379 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
8380 your program's performance.
8381
8382 @item
8383 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
8384 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
8385 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
8386 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
8387 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
8388 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
8389 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
8390
8391 @item
8392 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
8393 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
8394 instruction and data spaces.
8395
8396 @end itemize
8397
8398 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
8399 improved in many ways:
8400
8401 @itemize @bullet
8402
8403 @item
8404 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
8405 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
8406 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
8407 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
8408 area in the usual way.
8409
8410 @item
8411 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
8412 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
8413
8414 @item
8415 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
8416 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
8417 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
8418 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
8419 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
8420 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
8421 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
8422
8423 @end itemize
8424
8425
8426 @node Overlay Commands
8427 @section Overlay Commands
8428
8429 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
8430 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
8431 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
8432 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
8433 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
8434 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
8435
8436 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
8437 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
8438
8439 @table @code
8440 @item overlay off
8441 @kindex overlay
8442 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
8443 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
8444 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
8445 overlay support is disabled.
8446
8447 @item overlay manual
8448 @cindex manual overlay debugging
8449 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
8450 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
8451 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
8452 commands described below.
8453
8454 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
8455 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
8456 @cindex map an overlay
8457 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
8458 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
8459 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
8460 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
8461 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
8462 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
8463
8464 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
8465 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
8466 @cindex unmap an overlay
8467 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
8468 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
8469 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
8470 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
8471
8472 @item overlay auto
8473 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
8474 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
8475 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
8476 Overlay Debugging}.
8477
8478 @item overlay load-target
8479 @itemx overlay load
8480 @cindex reloading the overlay table
8481 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
8482 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
8483 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
8484 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
8485 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
8486
8487 @item overlay list-overlays
8488 @itemx overlay list
8489 @cindex listing mapped overlays
8490 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
8491 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
8492
8493 @end table
8494
8495 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
8496 of the function the address falls in:
8497
8498 @smallexample
8499 (@value{GDBP}) print main
8500 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
8501 @end smallexample
8502 @noindent
8503 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
8504 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
8505 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
8506 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
8507
8508 @smallexample
8509 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
8510 No sections are mapped.
8511 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
8512 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
8513 @end smallexample
8514 @noindent
8515 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
8516 name normally:
8517
8518 @smallexample
8519 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
8520 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
8521 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
8522 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
8523 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
8524 @end smallexample
8525
8526 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
8527 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
8528 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
8529 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
8530 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
8531
8532 @itemize @bullet
8533 @item
8534 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
8535 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
8536 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
8537 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
8538 @item
8539 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
8540 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
8541 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
8542 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
8543 breakpoints properly.
8544 @end itemize
8545
8546
8547 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
8548 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
8549 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
8550
8551 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
8552 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
8553 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
8554 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
8555 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
8556 current state of the overlays.
8557
8558 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
8559 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
8560
8561 @table @asis
8562
8563 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
8564 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
8565
8566 @smallexample
8567 struct
8568 @{
8569 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
8570 unsigned long vma;
8571
8572 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
8573 unsigned long size;
8574
8575 /* The overlay's load address. */
8576 unsigned long lma;
8577
8578 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
8579 zero otherwise. */
8580 unsigned long mapped;
8581 @}
8582 @end smallexample
8583
8584 @item @code{_novlys}:
8585 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
8586 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
8587
8588 @end table
8589
8590 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
8591 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
8592 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
8593 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
8594 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
8595 currently mapped.
8596
8597 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
8598 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
8599 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
8600 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
8601 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
8602 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
8603 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
8604 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
8605 are not being executed.
8606
8607 @node Overlay Sample Program
8608 @section Overlay Sample Program
8609 @cindex overlay example program
8610
8611 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
8612 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
8613 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
8614 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
8615 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
8616 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
8617 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
8618
8619 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
8620 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
8621 suite. The program consists of the following files from
8622 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
8623
8624 @table @file
8625 @item overlays.c
8626 The main program file.
8627 @item ovlymgr.c
8628 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
8629 @item foo.c
8630 @itemx bar.c
8631 @itemx baz.c
8632 @itemx grbx.c
8633 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
8634 @item d10v.ld
8635 @itemx m32r.ld
8636 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
8637 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
8638 @end table
8639
8640 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
8641 cross-compiler like this:
8642
8643 @smallexample
8644 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
8645 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
8646 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
8647 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
8648 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
8649 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
8650 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
8651 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
8652 @end smallexample
8653
8654 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
8655 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
8656 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
8657
8658
8659 @node Languages
8660 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
8661 @cindex languages
8662
8663 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
8664 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
8665 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
8666 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
8667 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
8668 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
8669
8670 @cindex working language
8671 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
8672 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
8673 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
8674 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
8675 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
8676 language}.
8677
8678 @menu
8679 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
8680 * Show:: Displaying the language
8681 * Checks:: Type and range checks
8682 * Supported Languages:: Supported languages
8683 * Unsupported Languages:: Unsupported languages
8684 @end menu
8685
8686 @node Setting
8687 @section Switching Between Source Languages
8688
8689 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
8690 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
8691 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
8692 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
8693 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
8694 are printed, etc.
8695
8696 In addition to the working language, every source file that
8697 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
8698 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
8699 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
8700 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
8701 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
8702 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
8703 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
8704 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
8705 Displaying the Language}.
8706
8707 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
8708 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
8709 another language. In that case, make the
8710 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
8711 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
8712 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
8713
8714 @menu
8715 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
8716 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
8717 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
8718 @end menu
8719
8720 @node Filenames
8721 @subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages
8722
8723 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
8724 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
8725
8726 @table @file
8727 @item .ada
8728 @itemx .ads
8729 @itemx .adb
8730 @itemx .a
8731 Ada source file.
8732
8733 @item .c
8734 C source file
8735
8736 @item .C
8737 @itemx .cc
8738 @itemx .cp
8739 @itemx .cpp
8740 @itemx .cxx
8741 @itemx .c++
8742 C@t{++} source file
8743
8744 @item .m
8745 Objective-C source file
8746
8747 @item .f
8748 @itemx .F
8749 Fortran source file
8750
8751 @item .mod
8752 Modula-2 source file
8753
8754 @item .s
8755 @itemx .S
8756 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
8757 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
8758 @end table
8759
8760 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
8761 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}.
8762
8763 @node Manually
8764 @subsection Setting the Working Language
8765
8766 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
8767 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
8768 your program.
8769
8770 @kindex set language
8771 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
8772 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
8773 a language, such as
8774 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
8775 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
8776
8777 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
8778 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
8779 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
8780 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
8781 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
8782 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
8783 command such as:
8784
8785 @smallexample
8786 print a = b + c
8787 @end smallexample
8788
8789 @noindent
8790 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
8791 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
8792 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
8793 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
8794
8795 @node Automatically
8796 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language
8797
8798 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
8799 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
8800 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
8801 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
8802 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
8803 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
8804 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
8805 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
8806 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
8807
8808 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
8809 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
8810 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
8811 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
8812 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
8813
8814 @node Show
8815 @section Displaying the Language
8816
8817 The following commands help you find out which language is the
8818 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
8819
8820 @table @code
8821 @item show language
8822 @kindex show language
8823 Display the current working language. This is the
8824 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
8825 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
8826
8827 @item info frame
8828 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
8829 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
8830 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
8831 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other
8832 information listed here.
8833
8834 @item info source
8835 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
8836 Display the source language of this source file.
8837 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
8838 information listed here.
8839 @end table
8840
8841 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
8842 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
8843 with a language explicitly:
8844
8845 @table @code
8846 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
8847 @kindex set extension-language
8848 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
8849 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
8850
8851 @item info extensions
8852 @kindex info extensions
8853 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
8854 @end table
8855
8856 @node Checks
8857 @section Type and Range Checking
8858
8859 @quotation
8860 @emph{Warning:} In this release, the @value{GDBN} commands for type and range
8861 checking are included, but they do not yet have any effect. This
8862 section documents the intended facilities.
8863 @end quotation
8864 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range code added
8865
8866 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
8867 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
8868 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators, and making
8869 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
8870 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
8871 by eliminating type mismatches, and providing active checks for range
8872 errors when your program is running.
8873
8874 @value{GDBN} can check for conditions like the above if you wish.
8875 Although @value{GDBN} does not check the statements in your program,
8876 it can check expressions entered directly into @value{GDBN} for
8877 evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example. As with the
8878 working language, @value{GDBN} can also decide whether or not to check
8879 automatically based on your program's source language.
8880 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default
8881 settings of supported languages.
8882
8883 @menu
8884 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
8885 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
8886 @end menu
8887
8888 @cindex type checking
8889 @cindex checks, type
8890 @node Type Checking
8891 @subsection An Overview of Type Checking
8892
8893 Some languages, such as Modula-2, are strongly typed, meaning that the
8894 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
8895 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
8896 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
8897
8898 @smallexample
8899 1 + 2 @result{} 3
8900 @exdent but
8901 @error{} 1 + 2.3
8902 @end smallexample
8903
8904 The second example fails because the @code{CARDINAL} 1 is not
8905 type-compatible with the @code{REAL} 2.3.
8906
8907 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell the
8908 @value{GDBN} type checker to skip checking;
8909 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
8910 or to only issue warnings when type mismatches occur,
8911 but evaluate the expression anyway. When you choose the last of
8912 these, @value{GDBN} evaluates expressions like the second example above, but
8913 also issues a warning.
8914
8915 Even if you turn type checking off, there may be other reasons
8916 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
8917 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
8918 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
8919 with the language in use, and usually arise from expressions, such as
8920 the one described above, which make little sense to evaluate anyway.
8921
8922 Each language defines to what degree it is strict about type. For
8923 instance, both Modula-2 and C require the arguments to arithmetical
8924 operators to be numbers. In C, enumerated types and pointers can be
8925 represented as numbers, so that they are valid arguments to mathematical
8926 operators. @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for further
8927 details on specific languages.
8928
8929 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the type checker:
8930
8931 @kindex set check type
8932 @kindex show check type
8933 @table @code
8934 @item set check type auto
8935 Set type checking on or off based on the current working language.
8936 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
8937 each language.
8938
8939 @item set check type on
8940 @itemx set check type off
8941 Set type checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
8942 current working language. Issue a warning if the setting does not
8943 match the language default. If any type mismatches occur in
8944 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
8945 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
8946
8947 @item set check type warn
8948 Cause the type checker to issue warnings, but to always attempt to
8949 evaluate the expression. Evaluating the expression may still
8950 be impossible for other reasons. For example, @value{GDBN} cannot add
8951 numbers and structures.
8952
8953 @item show type
8954 Show the current setting of the type checker, and whether or not @value{GDBN}
8955 is setting it automatically.
8956 @end table
8957
8958 @cindex range checking
8959 @cindex checks, range
8960 @node Range Checking
8961 @subsection An Overview of Range Checking
8962
8963 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
8964 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
8965 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
8966 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
8967 not exceed the bounds of the array.
8968
8969 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
8970 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
8971 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
8972 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
8973
8974 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
8975 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
8976 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
8977 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
8978 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
8979 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
8980
8981 @smallexample
8982 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
8983 @end smallexample
8984
8985 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
8986 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported Languages, ,
8987 Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages.
8988
8989 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
8990
8991 @kindex set check range
8992 @kindex show check range
8993 @table @code
8994 @item set check range auto
8995 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
8996 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
8997 each language.
8998
8999 @item set check range on
9000 @itemx set check range off
9001 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
9002 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
9003 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
9004 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
9005
9006 @item set check range warn
9007 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
9008 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
9009 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
9010 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
9011 systems).
9012
9013 @item show range
9014 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
9015 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
9016 @end table
9017
9018 @node Supported Languages
9019 @section Supported Languages
9020
9021 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, Objective-C, Fortran, Java, Pascal,
9022 assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
9023 @c This is false ...
9024 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
9025 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
9026 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
9027 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
9028 language.
9029
9030 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
9031 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
9032 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
9033 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
9034 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
9035 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
9036 language reference or tutorial.
9037
9038 @menu
9039 * C:: C and C@t{++}
9040 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
9041 * Fortran:: Fortran
9042 * Pascal:: Pascal
9043 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
9044 * Ada:: Ada
9045 @end menu
9046
9047 @node C
9048 @subsection C and C@t{++}
9049
9050 @cindex C and C@t{++}
9051 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
9052
9053 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
9054 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
9055 together.
9056
9057 @cindex C@t{++}
9058 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
9059 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
9060 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
9061 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
9062 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
9063 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
9064 compiler (@code{aCC}).
9065
9066 For best results when using @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, use the DWARF 2 debugging
9067 format; if it doesn't work on your system, try the stabs+ debugging
9068 format. You can select those formats explicitly with the @code{g++}
9069 command-line options @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-gstabs+}.
9070 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC,
9071 gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}.
9072
9073 @menu
9074 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
9075 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
9076 * C Plus Plus Expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
9077 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
9078 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
9079 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
9080 * Debugging C Plus Plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
9081 @end menu
9082
9083 @node C Operators
9084 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators
9085
9086 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
9087
9088 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
9089 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
9090 often defined on groups of types.
9091
9092 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
9093
9094 @itemize @bullet
9095
9096 @item
9097 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
9098 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
9099
9100 @item
9101 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
9102 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
9103
9104 @item
9105 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
9106
9107 @item
9108 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
9109
9110 @end itemize
9111
9112 @noindent
9113 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
9114 in order of increasing precedence:
9115
9116 @table @code
9117 @item ,
9118 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
9119 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
9120 expression being the last expression evaluated.
9121
9122 @item =
9123 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
9124 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
9125
9126 @item @var{op}=
9127 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
9128 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
9129 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.
9130 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
9131 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
9132
9133 @item ?:
9134 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
9135 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. @var{a} should be of an
9136 integral type.
9137
9138 @item ||
9139 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
9140
9141 @item &&
9142 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
9143
9144 @item |
9145 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
9146
9147 @item ^
9148 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
9149
9150 @item &
9151 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
9152
9153 @item ==@r{, }!=
9154 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
9155 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
9156
9157 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
9158 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
9159 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
9160 and non-zero for true.
9161
9162 @item <<@r{, }>>
9163 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
9164
9165 @item @@
9166 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
9167
9168 @item +@r{, }-
9169 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
9170 pointer types.
9171
9172 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
9173 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
9174 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
9175 integral types.
9176
9177 @item ++@r{, }--
9178 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
9179 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
9180 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
9181 operation takes place.
9182
9183 @item *
9184 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
9185 @code{++}.
9186
9187 @item &
9188 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
9189
9190 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
9191 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
9192 (or, if you prefer, simply @samp{&&@var{ref}}) to examine the address
9193 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
9194 stored.
9195
9196 @item -
9197 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
9198 precedence as @code{++}.
9199
9200 @item !
9201 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
9202 @code{++}.
9203
9204 @item ~
9205 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
9206 @code{++}.
9207
9208
9209 @item .@r{, }->
9210 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
9211 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
9212 pointer based on the stored type information.
9213 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
9214
9215 @item .*@r{, }->*
9216 Dereferences of pointers to members.
9217
9218 @item []
9219 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
9220 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
9221
9222 @item ()
9223 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
9224
9225 @item ::
9226 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
9227 and @code{class} types.
9228
9229 @item ::
9230 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
9231 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
9232 above.
9233 @end table
9234
9235 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
9236 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
9237 predefined meaning.
9238
9239 @node C Constants
9240 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants
9241
9242 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
9243
9244 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
9245 following ways:
9246
9247 @itemize @bullet
9248 @item
9249 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
9250 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
9251 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
9252 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
9253 @code{long} value.
9254
9255 @item
9256 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
9257 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
9258 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
9259 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
9260 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
9261 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
9262 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
9263 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
9264 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
9265 constant.
9266
9267 @item
9268 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
9269 integral equivalents.
9270
9271 @item
9272 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
9273 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
9274 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
9275 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
9276 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
9277 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
9278 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
9279 @samp{\n} for newline.
9280
9281 @item
9282 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
9283 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
9284 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
9285 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
9286 characters.
9287
9288 @item
9289 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
9290 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
9291
9292 @item
9293 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
9294 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
9295 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
9296 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
9297 @end itemize
9298
9299 @node C Plus Plus Expressions
9300 @subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions
9301
9302 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
9303 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
9304
9305 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
9306 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
9307 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
9308 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
9309 @quotation
9310 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use the
9311 proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently, @value{GDBN}
9312 works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled with
9313 @value{NGCC} 2.95.3 or with @value{NGCC} 3.1 or newer, using the options
9314 @option{-gdwarf-2} or @option{-gstabs+}. DWARF 2 is preferred over
9315 stabs+. Most configurations of @value{NGCC} emit either DWARF 2 or
9316 stabs+ as their default debug format, so you usually don't need to
9317 specify a debug format explicitly. Other compilers and/or debug formats
9318 are likely to work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug
9319 C@t{++} code.
9320 @end quotation
9321
9322 @enumerate
9323
9324 @cindex member functions
9325 @item
9326 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
9327
9328 @smallexample
9329 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
9330 @end smallexample
9331
9332 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
9333 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
9334 @item
9335 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
9336 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
9337 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
9338 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}.
9339
9340 @cindex call overloaded functions
9341 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
9342 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
9343 @item
9344 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
9345 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
9346 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
9347 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
9348 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
9349 default arguments.
9350
9351 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
9352 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
9353 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
9354 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
9355 number of function arguments.
9356
9357 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
9358 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus,
9359 ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
9360
9361 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
9362 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
9363 @smallexample
9364 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
9365 @end smallexample
9366
9367 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
9368 see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}.
9369
9370 @cindex reference declarations
9371 @item
9372 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
9373 them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
9374 dereferenced.
9375
9376 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
9377 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
9378 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
9379 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
9380 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
9381
9382 @item
9383 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
9384 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
9385 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
9386 necessary, for example in an expression like
9387 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
9388 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
9389 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}).
9390 @end enumerate
9391
9392 In addition, when used with HP's C@t{++} compiler, @value{GDBN} supports
9393 calling virtual functions correctly, printing out virtual bases of
9394 objects, calling functions in a base subobject, casting objects, and
9395 invoking user-defined operators.
9396
9397 @node C Defaults
9398 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults
9399
9400 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
9401
9402 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set type and range checking automatically, they
9403 both default to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
9404 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
9405 selects the working language.
9406
9407 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
9408 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
9409 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
9410 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
9411 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language},
9412 for further details.
9413
9414 @c Type checking is (a) primarily motivated by Modula-2, and (b)
9415 @c unimplemented. If (b) changes, it might make sense to let this node
9416 @c appear even if Mod-2 does not, but meanwhile ignore it. roland 16jul93.
9417
9418 @node C Checks
9419 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks
9420
9421 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
9422
9423 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, type checking
9424 is not used. However, if you turn type checking on, @value{GDBN}
9425 considers two variables type equivalent if:
9426
9427 @itemize @bullet
9428 @item
9429 The two variables are structured and have the same structure, union, or
9430 enumerated tag.
9431
9432 @item
9433 The two variables have the same type name, or types that have been
9434 declared equivalent through @code{typedef}.
9435
9436 @ignore
9437 @c leaving this out because neither J Gilmore nor R Pesch understand it.
9438 @c FIXME--beers?
9439 @item
9440 The two @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} variables are
9441 declared in the same declaration. (Note: this may not be true for all C
9442 compilers.)
9443 @end ignore
9444 @end itemize
9445
9446 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
9447 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
9448 that is not itself an array.
9449
9450 @node Debugging C
9451 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
9452
9453 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
9454 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
9455 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
9456 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
9457
9458 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
9459 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
9460 ,Expressions}.
9461
9462 @node Debugging C Plus Plus
9463 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}
9464
9465 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
9466
9467 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
9468 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
9469
9470 @table @code
9471 @cindex break in overloaded functions
9472 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
9473 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
9474 @value{GDBN} breakpoint menus help you specify which function definition
9475 you want. @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint Menus}.
9476
9477 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
9478 @item rbreak @var{regex}
9479 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
9480 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
9481 classes.
9482 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
9483
9484 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
9485 @item catch throw
9486 @itemx catch catch
9487 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
9488 Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
9489
9490 @cindex inheritance
9491 @item ptype @var{typename}
9492 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
9493 @var{typename}.
9494 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
9495
9496 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
9497 @item set print demangle
9498 @itemx show print demangle
9499 @itemx set print asm-demangle
9500 @itemx show print asm-demangle
9501 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
9502 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
9503 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
9504
9505 @item set print object
9506 @itemx show print object
9507 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
9508 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
9509
9510 @item set print vtbl
9511 @itemx show print vtbl
9512 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
9513 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
9514 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
9515 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
9516
9517 @kindex set overload-resolution
9518 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
9519 @item set overload-resolution on
9520 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
9521 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
9522 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
9523 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus
9524 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details).
9525 If it cannot find a match, it emits a message.
9526
9527 @item set overload-resolution off
9528 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
9529 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
9530 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
9531 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
9532 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
9533 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
9534 argument types.
9535
9536 @kindex show overload-resolution
9537 @item show overload-resolution
9538 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
9539
9540 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
9541 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
9542 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
9543 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
9544 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
9545 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
9546 @xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this.
9547 @end table
9548
9549 @node Objective-C
9550 @subsection Objective-C
9551
9552 @cindex Objective-C
9553 This section provides information about some commands and command
9554 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
9555 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
9556 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
9557
9558 @menu
9559 * Method Names in Commands::
9560 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
9561 @end menu
9562
9563 @node Method Names in Commands
9564 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
9565
9566 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
9567 names as line specifications:
9568
9569 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
9570 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
9571 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
9572 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
9573 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
9574 @itemize
9575 @item @code{clear}
9576 @item @code{break}
9577 @item @code{info line}
9578 @item @code{jump}
9579 @item @code{list}
9580 @end itemize
9581
9582 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
9583
9584 @smallexample
9585 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
9586 @end smallexample
9587
9588 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
9589 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
9590 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
9591 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
9592 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
9593 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
9594 debugged, enter:
9595
9596 @smallexample
9597 break -[Fruit create]
9598 @end smallexample
9599
9600 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
9601 enter:
9602
9603 @smallexample
9604 list +[NSText initialize]
9605 @end smallexample
9606
9607 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
9608 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
9609 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
9610 is also possible to specify just a method name:
9611
9612 @smallexample
9613 break create
9614 @end smallexample
9615
9616 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
9617 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
9618 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
9619 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
9620 none apply.
9621
9622 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
9623 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
9624
9625 @smallexample
9626 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
9627 @end smallexample
9628
9629 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
9630 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
9631 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
9632 @kindex print-object
9633 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
9634
9635 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
9636
9637 @smallexample
9638 print -[@var{object} hash]
9639 @end smallexample
9640
9641 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
9642 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
9643 @noindent
9644 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
9645 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
9646 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
9647 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
9648 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
9649 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
9650
9651 @node Fortran
9652 @subsection Fortran
9653 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
9654
9655 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
9656 currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
9657
9658 @cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
9659 Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
9660 among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
9661 functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
9662 will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
9663 underscore.
9664
9665 @menu
9666 * Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
9667 * Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
9668 * Special Fortran Commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
9669 @end menu
9670
9671 @node Fortran Operators
9672 @subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions
9673
9674 @cindex Fortran operators and expressions
9675
9676 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
9677 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
9678 arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
9679
9680 @table @code
9681 @item **
9682 The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
9683 of the second one.
9684
9685 @item :
9686 The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
9687 represent a section of array.
9688 @end table
9689
9690 @node Fortran Defaults
9691 @subsubsection Fortran Defaults
9692
9693 @cindex Fortran Defaults
9694
9695 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
9696 default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
9697 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
9698 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
9699
9700 @node Special Fortran Commands
9701 @subsubsection Special Fortran Commands
9702
9703 @cindex Special Fortran commands
9704
9705 @value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features,
9706 such as displaying common blocks.
9707
9708 @table @code
9709 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
9710 @kindex info common
9711 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
9712 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
9713 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
9714 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are
9715 printed.
9716 @end table
9717
9718 @node Pascal
9719 @subsection Pascal
9720
9721 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
9722 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
9723 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
9724 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
9725 syntax.
9726
9727 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
9728 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
9729 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
9730
9731 @node Modula-2
9732 @subsection Modula-2
9733
9734 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
9735
9736 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
9737 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
9738 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
9739 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
9740 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
9741 table.
9742
9743 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
9744 @menu
9745 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
9746 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
9747 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
9748 * M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
9749 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
9750 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
9751 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
9752 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
9753 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
9754 @end menu
9755
9756 @node M2 Operators
9757 @subsubsection Operators
9758 @cindex Modula-2 operators
9759
9760 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
9761 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
9762 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
9763 following definitions hold:
9764
9765 @itemize @bullet
9766
9767 @item
9768 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
9769 their subranges.
9770
9771 @item
9772 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
9773
9774 @item
9775 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
9776
9777 @item
9778 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
9779 @var{type}}.
9780
9781 @item
9782 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
9783
9784 @item
9785 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
9786
9787 @item
9788 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
9789 @end itemize
9790
9791 @noindent
9792 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
9793 increasing precedence:
9794
9795 @table @code
9796 @item ,
9797 Function argument or array index separator.
9798
9799 @item :=
9800 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
9801 @var{value}.
9802
9803 @item <@r{, }>
9804 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
9805 types.
9806
9807 @item <=@r{, }>=
9808 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
9809 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
9810 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
9811
9812 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
9813 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
9814 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
9815 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
9816 comment character.
9817
9818 @item IN
9819 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
9820 Same precedence as @code{<}.
9821
9822 @item OR
9823 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
9824
9825 @item AND@r{, }&
9826 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
9827
9828 @item @@
9829 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
9830
9831 @item +@r{, }-
9832 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
9833 and difference on set types.
9834
9835 @item *
9836 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
9837 on set types.
9838
9839 @item /
9840 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
9841 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
9842
9843 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
9844 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
9845 precedence as @code{*}.
9846
9847 @item -
9848 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
9849
9850 @item ^
9851 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
9852
9853 @item NOT
9854 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
9855 @code{^}.
9856
9857 @item .
9858 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
9859 precedence as @code{^}.
9860
9861 @item []
9862 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
9863
9864 @item ()
9865 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
9866 as @code{^}.
9867
9868 @item ::@r{, }.
9869 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
9870 @end table
9871
9872 @quotation
9873 @emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
9874 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
9875 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
9876 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
9877 @end quotation
9878
9879
9880 @node Built-In Func/Proc
9881 @subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures
9882 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
9883
9884 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
9885 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
9886
9887 @table @var
9888
9889 @item a
9890 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
9891
9892 @item c
9893 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
9894
9895 @item i
9896 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
9897
9898 @item m
9899 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
9900 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
9901 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
9902
9903 @item n
9904 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
9905
9906 @item r
9907 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
9908
9909 @item t
9910 represents a type.
9911
9912 @item v
9913 represents a variable.
9914
9915 @item x
9916 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
9917 explanation of the function for details.
9918 @end table
9919
9920 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
9921
9922 @table @code
9923 @item ABS(@var{n})
9924 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
9925
9926 @item CAP(@var{c})
9927 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
9928 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
9929
9930 @item CHR(@var{i})
9931 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
9932
9933 @item DEC(@var{v})
9934 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
9935
9936 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
9937 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
9938 new value.
9939
9940 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
9941 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
9942 set.
9943
9944 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
9945 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
9946
9947 @item HIGH(@var{a})
9948 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
9949
9950 @item INC(@var{v})
9951 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
9952
9953 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
9954 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
9955 new value.
9956
9957 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
9958 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
9959 there. Returns the new set.
9960
9961 @item MAX(@var{t})
9962 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
9963
9964 @item MIN(@var{t})
9965 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
9966
9967 @item ODD(@var{i})
9968 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
9969
9970 @item ORD(@var{x})
9971 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
9972 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting the
9973 @sc{ascii} character set). @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include
9974 integral, character and enumerated types.
9975
9976 @item SIZE(@var{x})
9977 Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
9978
9979 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
9980 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
9981
9982 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
9983 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
9984 @end table
9985
9986 @quotation
9987 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
9988 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
9989 an error.
9990 @end quotation
9991
9992 @cindex Modula-2 constants
9993 @node M2 Constants
9994 @subsubsection Constants
9995
9996 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
9997 ways:
9998
9999 @itemize @bullet
10000
10001 @item
10002 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
10003 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
10004 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
10005 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
10006
10007 @item
10008 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
10009 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
10010 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
10011 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
10012 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
10013 digits.
10014
10015 @item
10016 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
10017 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
10018 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
10019 followed by a @samp{C}.
10020
10021 @item
10022 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
10023 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
10024 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
10025 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
10026 sequences.
10027
10028 @item
10029 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
10030
10031 @item
10032 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
10033 @code{FALSE}.
10034
10035 @item
10036 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
10037
10038 @item
10039 Set constants are not yet supported.
10040 @end itemize
10041
10042 @node M2 Types
10043 @subsubsection Modula-2 Types
10044 @cindex Modula-2 types
10045
10046 Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
10047 syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
10048 types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
10049 print the contents of variables declared using these type.
10050 This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
10051 sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
10052
10053 The first example contains the following section of code:
10054
10055 @smallexample
10056 VAR
10057 s: SET OF CHAR ;
10058 r: [20..40] ;
10059 @end smallexample
10060
10061 @noindent
10062 and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
10063 @code{r} and @code{s}.
10064
10065 @smallexample
10066 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10067 @{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
10068 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10069 SET OF CHAR
10070 (@value{GDBP}) print r
10071 21
10072 (@value{GDBP}) ptype r
10073 [20..40]
10074 @end smallexample
10075
10076 @noindent
10077 Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
10078
10079 @smallexample
10080 VAR
10081 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
10082 @end smallexample
10083
10084 @noindent
10085 then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
10086
10087 @smallexample
10088 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10089 type = SET ['A'..'Z']
10090 @end smallexample
10091
10092 @noindent
10093 Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
10094 expressions using the debugger.
10095
10096 The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
10097 and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
10098
10099 @smallexample
10100 VAR
10101 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
10102 @end smallexample
10103
10104 @smallexample
10105 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10106 ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
10107 @end smallexample
10108
10109 Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
10110 is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
10111 arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
10112 above. Unbounded arrays are also not yet recognized in @value{GDBN}.
10113
10114 Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
10115
10116 @smallexample
10117 TYPE
10118 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
10119 t = [blue..yellow] ;
10120 VAR
10121 s: t ;
10122 BEGIN
10123 s := blue ;
10124 @end smallexample
10125
10126 @noindent
10127 The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
10128 and value of a variable.
10129
10130 @smallexample
10131 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10132 $1 = blue
10133 (@value{GDBP}) ptype t
10134 type = [blue..yellow]
10135 @end smallexample
10136
10137 @noindent
10138 In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
10139 displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
10140 their @code{C} counterparts.
10141
10142 @smallexample
10143 VAR
10144 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
10145 BEGIN
10146 s[1] := 1 ;
10147 @end smallexample
10148
10149 @smallexample
10150 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10151 $1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
10152 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10153 type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
10154 @end smallexample
10155
10156 The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
10157 pointer types as shown in this example:
10158
10159 @smallexample
10160 VAR
10161 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
10162 BEGIN
10163 NEW(s) ;
10164 s^[1] := 1 ;
10165 @end smallexample
10166
10167 @noindent
10168 and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
10169
10170 @smallexample
10171 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10172 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
10173 @end smallexample
10174
10175 @value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
10176 Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
10177 types:
10178
10179 @smallexample
10180 TYPE
10181 foo = RECORD
10182 f1: CARDINAL ;
10183 f2: CHAR ;
10184 f3: myarray ;
10185 END ;
10186
10187 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
10188 myrange = [-2..2] ;
10189 VAR
10190 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
10191 @end smallexample
10192
10193 @noindent
10194 and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
10195 below.
10196
10197 @smallexample
10198 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10199 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
10200 f1 : CARDINAL;
10201 f2 : CHAR;
10202 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
10203 END
10204 @end smallexample
10205
10206 @node M2 Defaults
10207 @subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults
10208 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
10209
10210 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
10211 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
10212 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
10213 selected the working language.
10214
10215 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
10216 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
10217 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN}
10218 Infer the Source Language}, for further details.
10219
10220 @node Deviations
10221 @subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2
10222 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
10223
10224 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
10225 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
10226
10227 @itemize @bullet
10228 @item
10229 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
10230 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
10231 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
10232 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
10233 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
10234 returned a pointer.)
10235
10236 @item
10237 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
10238 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
10239 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
10240 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
10241
10242 @item
10243 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
10244 argument.
10245
10246 @item
10247 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
10248 @end itemize
10249
10250 @node M2 Checks
10251 @subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks
10252 @cindex Modula-2 checks
10253
10254 @quotation
10255 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
10256 range checking.
10257 @end quotation
10258 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
10259
10260 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
10261
10262 @itemize @bullet
10263 @item
10264 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
10265 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
10266
10267 @item
10268 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
10269 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
10270 @end itemize
10271
10272 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
10273 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
10274
10275 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
10276 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
10277
10278 @node M2 Scope
10279 @subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.}
10280 @cindex scope
10281 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
10282 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
10283 @ifinfo
10284 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
10285 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
10286 @end ifinfo
10287 @iftex
10288 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
10289 @end iftex
10290
10291 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
10292 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
10293 similar syntax:
10294
10295 @smallexample
10296
10297 @var{module} . @var{id}
10298 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
10299 @end smallexample
10300
10301 @noindent
10302 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
10303 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
10304 identifier within your program, except another module.
10305
10306 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
10307 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
10308 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
10309 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
10310
10311 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
10312 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
10313 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
10314 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
10315 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
10316 @var{module}.
10317
10318 @node GDB/M2
10319 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
10320
10321 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
10322 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
10323 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
10324 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
10325 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
10326 analogue in Modula-2.
10327
10328 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
10329 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
10330 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
10331 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
10332 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
10333 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
10334
10335 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
10336 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
10337 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
10338
10339 @node Ada
10340 @subsection Ada
10341 @cindex Ada
10342
10343 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
10344 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
10345 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
10346 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
10347 to be difficult.
10348
10349
10350 @cindex expressions in Ada
10351 @menu
10352 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
10353 and semantics supported by Ada mode
10354 in @value{GDBN}.
10355 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
10356 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
10357 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
10358 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
10359 @end menu
10360
10361 @node Ada Mode Intro
10362 @subsubsection Introduction
10363 @cindex Ada mode, general
10364
10365 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
10366 syntax, with some extensions.
10367 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
10368
10369 @itemize @bullet
10370 @item
10371 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
10372 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
10373 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
10374 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
10375
10376 @item
10377 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
10378 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
10379
10380 @item
10381 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
10382 @end itemize
10383
10384 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if there were
10385 implicit @code{with} and @code{use} clauses in effect for all user-written
10386 packages, making it unnecessary to fully qualify most names with
10387 their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes ambiguity,
10388 @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
10389
10390 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
10391 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
10392 was translated from an Ada source file.
10393
10394 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
10395 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
10396 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
10397 middle (to allow based literals).
10398
10399 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
10400 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
10401 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
10402 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
10403 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
10404 functions to procedures elsewhere.
10405
10406 @node Omissions from Ada
10407 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
10408 @cindex Ada, omissions from
10409
10410 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
10411
10412 @itemize @bullet
10413 @item
10414 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
10415
10416 @itemize @minus
10417 @item
10418 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
10419 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
10420
10421 @item
10422 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
10423
10424 @item
10425 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
10426
10427 @item
10428 @t{'Tag}.
10429
10430 @item
10431 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
10432 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
10433
10434 @item
10435 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
10436 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
10437
10438 @item
10439 @t{'Address}.
10440 @end itemize
10441
10442 @item
10443 The names in
10444 @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
10445 concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
10446 not currently available.
10447
10448 @item
10449 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
10450 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
10451 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
10452 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
10453 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
10454 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
10455 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
10456 indeterminate values.
10457
10458 @item
10459 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
10460 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
10461 are not implemented.
10462
10463 @item
10464 @cindex array aggregates (Ada)
10465 @cindex record aggregates (Ada)
10466 @cindex aggregates (Ada)
10467 There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
10468 permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
10469
10470 @smallexample
10471 set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
10472 set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
10473 set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
10474 set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
10475 set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
10476 set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
10477 @end smallexample
10478
10479 Changing a
10480 discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
10481 undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
10482 However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
10483 them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
10484 aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
10485 declared to have a type such as:
10486
10487 @smallexample
10488 type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
10489 Id : Integer;
10490 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
10491 end record;
10492 @end smallexample
10493
10494 you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
10495 assignments:
10496
10497 @smallexample
10498 set A_Rec.Len := 4
10499 set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
10500 @end smallexample
10501
10502 As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
10503 rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
10504 components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
10505 component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
10506 original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
10507 indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
10508 redundant component associations, although which component values are
10509 assigned in such cases is not defined.
10510
10511 @item
10512 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
10513
10514 @item
10515 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
10516 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in
10517 which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much
10518 looser in its rules for allowing type matches. As a result, some
10519 function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose
10520 the proper resolution.
10521
10522 @item
10523 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
10524
10525 @item
10526 Entry calls are not implemented.
10527
10528 @item
10529 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
10530 formats are not supported.
10531
10532 @item
10533 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
10534 @end itemize
10535
10536 @node Additions to Ada
10537 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
10538 @cindex Ada, deviations from
10539
10540 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
10541 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
10542
10543 @itemize @bullet
10544 @item
10545 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically
10546 a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer,
10547 then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the
10548 @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array. In
10549 Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is
10550 in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in
10551 Ada. However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in
10552 which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
10553
10554 @item
10555 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that
10556 appears in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name,
10557 you must typically surround it in single quotes.
10558
10559 @item
10560 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
10561 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
10562
10563 @item
10564 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
10565 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
10566 @end itemize
10567
10568 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright
10569 additions specific to Ada:
10570
10571 @itemize @bullet
10572 @item
10573 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
10574 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
10575
10576 @smallexample
10577 set x := y + 3
10578 print A(tmp := y + 1)
10579 @end smallexample
10580
10581 @item
10582 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
10583 the value of its right-hand operand.
10584 This allows, for example,
10585 complex conditional breaks:
10586
10587 @smallexample
10588 break f
10589 condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
10590 @end smallexample
10591
10592 @item
10593 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
10594 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
10595 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
10596 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
10597 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
10598 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
10599 in strings. For example,
10600 @smallexample
10601 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
10602 @end smallexample
10603 @noindent
10604 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF})
10605 after each period.
10606
10607 @item
10608 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
10609 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
10610 to write
10611
10612 @smallexample
10613 print 'max(x, y)
10614 @end smallexample
10615
10616 @item
10617 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
10618 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
10619 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound
10620 of 3 might print as
10621
10622 @smallexample
10623 (3 => 10, 17, 1)
10624 @end smallexample
10625
10626 @noindent
10627 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
10628 clause.
10629
10630 @item
10631 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
10632 multi-character subsequence of
10633 their names (an exact match gets preference).
10634 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
10635 in place of @t{a'length}.
10636
10637 @item
10638 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
10639 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
10640 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
10641 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
10642 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
10643 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
10644 For example,
10645 @smallexample
10646 @value{GDBP} print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
10647 @end smallexample
10648
10649 @item
10650 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
10651 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
10652 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
10653 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
10654 object.
10655
10656 @end itemize
10657
10658 @node Stopping Before Main Program
10659 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
10660
10661 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
10662 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
10663 before reaching the main procedure.
10664 As defined in the Ada Reference
10665 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
10666 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
10667 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
10668 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
10669
10670 @node Ada Glitches
10671 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
10672 @cindex Ada, problems
10673
10674 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
10675 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
10676 @value{GDBN},
10677 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
10678 and the GNU Ada compiler.
10679
10680 @itemize @bullet
10681 @item
10682 Currently, the debugger
10683 has insufficient information to determine whether certain pointers represent
10684 pointers to objects or the objects themselves.
10685 Thus, the user may have to tack an extra @code{.all} after an expression
10686 to get it printed properly.
10687
10688 @item
10689 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
10690 storage are invisible to the debugger.
10691
10692 @item
10693 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
10694 argument lists are treated as positional).
10695
10696 @item
10697 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
10698
10699 @item
10700 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
10701 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
10702 the host machine.
10703
10704 @item
10705 The type of the @t{'Address} attribute may not be @code{System.Address}.
10706
10707 @item
10708 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
10709 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
10710 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
10711 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
10712 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
10713 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
10714 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
10715 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
10716 you can usually resolve the confusion
10717 by qualifying the problematic names with package
10718 @code{Standard} explicitly.
10719 @end itemize
10720
10721 @node Unsupported Languages
10722 @section Unsupported Languages
10723
10724 @cindex unsupported languages
10725 @cindex minimal language
10726 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
10727 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
10728 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
10729 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
10730 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
10731 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
10732
10733 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
10734 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
10735 language.
10736
10737 @node Symbols
10738 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
10739
10740 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
10741 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
10742 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
10743 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
10744 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
10745 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the
10746 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
10747
10748 @cindex symbol names
10749 @cindex names of symbols
10750 @cindex quoting names
10751 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
10752 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
10753 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
10754 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}). File names
10755 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
10756 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
10757 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
10758 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
10759
10760 @smallexample
10761 p 'foo.c'::x
10762 @end smallexample
10763
10764 @noindent
10765 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
10766
10767 @table @code
10768 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
10769 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
10770 @kindex set case-sensitive
10771 @item set case-sensitive on
10772 @itemx set case-sensitive off
10773 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
10774 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
10775 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
10776 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
10777 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
10778 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
10779 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
10780 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
10781 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
10782 case-insensitive matches.
10783
10784 @kindex show case-sensitive
10785 @item show case-sensitive
10786 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
10787 lookups.
10788
10789 @kindex info address
10790 @cindex address of a symbol
10791 @item info address @var{symbol}
10792 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
10793 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
10794 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
10795 is always stored.
10796
10797 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
10798 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
10799 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
10800
10801 @kindex info symbol
10802 @cindex symbol from address
10803 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
10804 @item info symbol @var{addr}
10805 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
10806 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
10807 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
10808
10809 @smallexample
10810 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
10811 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
10812 @end smallexample
10813
10814 @noindent
10815 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
10816 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
10817
10818 @kindex whatis
10819 @item whatis [@var{arg}]
10820 Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression or
10821 a data type. With no argument, print the data type of @code{$}, the
10822 last value in the value history. If @var{arg} is an expression, it is
10823 not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
10824 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place. If
10825 @var{arg} is a type name, it may be the name of a type or typedef, or
10826 for C code it may have the form @samp{class @var{class-name}},
10827 @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union @var{union-tag}} or
10828 @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
10829 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
10830
10831 @kindex ptype
10832 @item ptype [@var{arg}]
10833 @code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
10834 detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
10835 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
10836
10837 For example, for this variable declaration:
10838
10839 @smallexample
10840 struct complex @{double real; double imag;@} v;
10841 @end smallexample
10842
10843 @noindent
10844 the two commands give this output:
10845
10846 @smallexample
10847 @group
10848 (@value{GDBP}) whatis v
10849 type = struct complex
10850 (@value{GDBP}) ptype v
10851 type = struct complex @{
10852 double real;
10853 double imag;
10854 @}
10855 @end group
10856 @end smallexample
10857
10858 @noindent
10859 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
10860 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
10861
10862 @cindex incomplete type
10863 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
10864 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
10865 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
10866 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
10867 given these declarations:
10868
10869 @smallexample
10870 struct foo;
10871 struct foo *fooptr;
10872 @end smallexample
10873
10874 @noindent
10875 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
10876
10877 @smallexample
10878 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
10879 $1 = <incomplete type>
10880 @end smallexample
10881
10882 @noindent
10883 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
10884 completely specified.
10885
10886 @kindex info types
10887 @item info types @var{regexp}
10888 @itemx info types
10889 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
10890 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
10891 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
10892 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
10893 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
10894 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
10895 name is @code{value}.
10896
10897 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
10898 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
10899 lists all source files where a type is defined.
10900
10901 @kindex info scope
10902 @cindex local variables
10903 @item info scope @var{location}
10904 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
10905 accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
10906 an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
10907 to the scope defined by that location. For example:
10908
10909 @smallexample
10910 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
10911 Scope for command_line_handler:
10912 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
10913 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
10914 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
10915 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
10916 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
10917 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
10918 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
10919 @end smallexample
10920
10921 @noindent
10922 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
10923 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
10924 collect}.
10925
10926 @kindex info source
10927 @item info source
10928 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
10929 the function containing the current point of execution:
10930 @itemize @bullet
10931 @item
10932 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
10933 @item
10934 the directory it was compiled in,
10935 @item
10936 its length, in lines,
10937 @item
10938 which programming language it is written in,
10939 @item
10940 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
10941 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
10942 @item
10943 whether the debugging information includes information about
10944 preprocessor macros.
10945 @end itemize
10946
10947
10948 @kindex info sources
10949 @item info sources
10950 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
10951 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
10952 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
10953
10954 @kindex info functions
10955 @item info functions
10956 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
10957
10958 @item info functions @var{regexp}
10959 Print the names and data types of all defined functions
10960 whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
10961 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
10962 include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
10963 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
10964 that conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
10965 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
10966
10967 @kindex info variables
10968 @item info variables
10969 Print the names and data types of all variables that are declared
10970 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
10971
10972 @item info variables @var{regexp}
10973 Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
10974 variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
10975 @var{regexp}.
10976
10977 @kindex info classes
10978 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
10979 @item info classes
10980 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
10981 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
10982 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
10983 expression.
10984
10985 @kindex info selectors
10986 @item info selectors
10987 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
10988 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
10989 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
10990 expression.
10991
10992 @ignore
10993 This was never implemented.
10994 @kindex info methods
10995 @item info methods
10996 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
10997 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
10998 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
10999 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
11000 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
11001 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
11002 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
11003 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
11004 @end ignore
11005
11006 @cindex reloading symbols
11007 Some systems allow individual object files that make up your program to
11008 be replaced without stopping and restarting your program. For example,
11009 in VxWorks you can simply recompile a defective object file and keep on
11010 running. If you are running on one of these systems, you can allow
11011 @value{GDBN} to reload the symbols for automatically relinked modules:
11012
11013 @table @code
11014 @kindex set symbol-reloading
11015 @item set symbol-reloading on
11016 Replace symbol definitions for the corresponding source file when an
11017 object file with a particular name is seen again.
11018
11019 @item set symbol-reloading off
11020 Do not replace symbol definitions when encountering object files of the
11021 same name more than once. This is the default state; if you are not
11022 running on a system that permits automatic relinking of modules, you
11023 should leave @code{symbol-reloading} off, since otherwise @value{GDBN}
11024 may discard symbols when linking large programs, that may contain
11025 several modules (from different directories or libraries) with the same
11026 name.
11027
11028 @kindex show symbol-reloading
11029 @item show symbol-reloading
11030 Show the current @code{on} or @code{off} setting.
11031 @end table
11032
11033 @cindex opaque data types
11034 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
11035 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
11036 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
11037 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
11038 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
11039 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
11040 another source file. The default is on.
11041
11042 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
11043 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
11044
11045 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
11046 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
11047 is printed as follows:
11048 @smallexample
11049 @{<no data fields>@}
11050 @end smallexample
11051
11052 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
11053 @item show opaque-type-resolution
11054 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
11055
11056 @kindex maint print symbols
11057 @cindex symbol dump
11058 @kindex maint print psymbols
11059 @cindex partial symbol dump
11060 @item maint print symbols @var{filename}
11061 @itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
11062 @itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
11063 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
11064 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
11065 symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
11066 symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
11067 collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
11068 only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
11069 command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
11070 use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
11071 symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
11072 files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
11073 @samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
11074 required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
11075 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how
11076 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
11077
11078 @kindex maint info symtabs
11079 @kindex maint info psymtabs
11080 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
11081 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
11082 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
11083 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
11084 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
11085 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
11086
11087 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
11088 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
11089 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
11090 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
11091 structure in more detail. For example:
11092
11093 @smallexample
11094 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
11095 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
11096 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
11097 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
11098 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
11099 readin no
11100 fullname (null)
11101 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
11102 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
11103 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
11104 dependencies (none)
11105 @}
11106 @}
11107 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
11108 (@value{GDBP})
11109 @end smallexample
11110 @noindent
11111 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
11112 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
11113 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
11114 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
11115 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
11116
11117 @smallexample
11118 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
11119 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
11120 line 1574.
11121 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
11122 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
11123 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
11124 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
11125 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
11126 dirname (null)
11127 fullname (null)
11128 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
11129 debugformat DWARF 2
11130 @}
11131 @}
11132 (@value{GDBP})
11133 @end smallexample
11134 @end table
11135
11136
11137 @node Altering
11138 @chapter Altering Execution
11139
11140 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
11141 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
11142 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
11143 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
11144 program.
11145
11146 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
11147 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
11148 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
11149
11150 @menu
11151 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
11152 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
11153 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
11154 * Returning:: Returning from a function
11155 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
11156 * Patching:: Patching your program
11157 @end menu
11158
11159 @node Assignment
11160 @section Assignment to Variables
11161
11162 @cindex assignment
11163 @cindex setting variables
11164 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
11165 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
11166
11167 @smallexample
11168 print x=4
11169 @end smallexample
11170
11171 @noindent
11172 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
11173 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
11174 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
11175 information on operators in supported languages.
11176
11177 @kindex set variable
11178 @cindex variables, setting
11179 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
11180 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
11181 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
11182 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
11183 ,Value History}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
11184
11185 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
11186 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
11187 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
11188 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
11189 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
11190 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
11191 command @code{set width}:
11192
11193 @smallexample
11194 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
11195 type = double
11196 (@value{GDBP}) p width
11197 $4 = 13
11198 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
11199 Invalid syntax in expression.
11200 @end smallexample
11201
11202 @noindent
11203 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
11204 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
11205
11206 @smallexample
11207 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
11208 @end smallexample
11209
11210 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
11211 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
11212 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
11213 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
11214 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
11215 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
11216
11217 @smallexample
11218 @group
11219 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
11220 type = double
11221 (@value{GDBP}) p g
11222 $1 = 1
11223 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
11224 (@value{GDBP}) p g
11225 $2 = 1
11226 (@value{GDBP}) r
11227 The program being debugged has been started already.
11228 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
11229 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
11230 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
11231 Invalid bfd target.
11232 (@value{GDBP}) show g
11233 The current BFD target is "=4".
11234 @end group
11235 @end smallexample
11236
11237 @noindent
11238 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
11239 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
11240 @code{g}, use
11241
11242 @smallexample
11243 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
11244 @end smallexample
11245
11246 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
11247 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
11248 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
11249 same length or shorter.
11250 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
11251 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
11252
11253 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
11254 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
11255 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
11256 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
11257 and representation in memory), and
11258
11259 @smallexample
11260 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
11261 @end smallexample
11262
11263 @noindent
11264 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
11265
11266 @node Jumping
11267 @section Continuing at a Different Address
11268
11269 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
11270 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
11271 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
11272
11273 @table @code
11274 @kindex jump
11275 @item jump @var{linespec}
11276 Resume execution at line @var{linespec}. Execution stops again
11277 immediately if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{List, ,Printing
11278 Source Lines}, for a description of the different forms of
11279 @var{linespec}. It is common practice to use the @code{tbreak} command
11280 in conjunction with @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
11281 Breakpoints}.
11282
11283 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
11284 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
11285 register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
11286 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
11287 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
11288 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
11289 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
11290 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
11291 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
11292
11293 @item jump *@var{address}
11294 Resume execution at the instruction at address @var{address}.
11295 @end table
11296
11297 @c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
11298 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
11299 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
11300 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
11301 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
11302 example,
11303
11304 @smallexample
11305 set $pc = 0x485
11306 @end smallexample
11307
11308 @noindent
11309 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
11310 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
11311 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}.
11312
11313 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
11314 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
11315 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
11316 detail.
11317
11318 @c @group
11319 @node Signaling
11320 @section Giving your Program a Signal
11321 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
11322
11323 @table @code
11324 @kindex signal
11325 @item signal @var{signal}
11326 Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
11327 signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
11328 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
11329 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
11330
11331 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
11332 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
11333 a signal and would ordinary see the signal when resumed with the
11334 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
11335 signal.
11336
11337 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
11338 after executing the command.
11339 @end table
11340 @c @end group
11341
11342 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
11343 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
11344 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
11345 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
11346 passes the signal directly to your program.
11347
11348
11349 @node Returning
11350 @section Returning from a Function
11351
11352 @table @code
11353 @cindex returning from a function
11354 @kindex return
11355 @item return
11356 @itemx return @var{expression}
11357 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
11358 command. If you give an
11359 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
11360 value.
11361 @end table
11362
11363 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
11364 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
11365 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
11366 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
11367
11368 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
11369 Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
11370 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
11371 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
11372 of functions.
11373
11374 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
11375 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
11376 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
11377 and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the
11378 selected stack frame returns naturally.
11379
11380 @node Calling
11381 @section Calling Program Functions
11382
11383 @table @code
11384 @cindex calling functions
11385 @cindex inferior functions, calling
11386 @item print @var{expr}
11387 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value.
11388 @var{expr} may include calls to functions in the program being
11389 debugged.
11390
11391 @kindex call
11392 @item call @var{expr}
11393 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
11394 returned values.
11395
11396 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
11397 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
11398 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
11399 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
11400 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
11401 value history.
11402 @end table
11403
11404 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
11405 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
11406 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
11407 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
11408
11409 @table @code
11410 @item set unwindonsignal
11411 @kindex set unwindonsignal
11412 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
11413 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
11414 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
11415 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
11416 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
11417 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
11418 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
11419 received.
11420
11421 @item show unwindonsignal
11422 @kindex show unwindonsignal
11423 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
11424 @value{GDBN}.
11425 @end table
11426
11427 @cindex weak alias functions
11428 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is actually a @dfn{weak alias}
11429 for another function. In such case, @value{GDBN} might not pick up
11430 the type information, including the types of the function arguments,
11431 which causes @value{GDBN} to call the inferior function incorrectly.
11432 As a result, the called function will function erroneously and may
11433 even crash. A solution to that is to use the name of the aliased
11434 function instead.
11435
11436 @node Patching
11437 @section Patching Programs
11438
11439 @cindex patching binaries
11440 @cindex writing into executables
11441 @cindex writing into corefiles
11442
11443 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
11444 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
11445 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
11446 patching your program's binary.
11447
11448 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
11449 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
11450 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
11451 repairs.
11452
11453 @table @code
11454 @kindex set write
11455 @item set write on
11456 @itemx set write off
11457 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
11458 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @samp{set write
11459 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
11460
11461 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
11462 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
11463 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
11464
11465 @item show write
11466 @kindex show write
11467 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
11468 as well as reading.
11469 @end table
11470
11471 @node GDB Files
11472 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
11473
11474 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
11475 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
11476 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
11477 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
11478
11479 @menu
11480 * Files:: Commands to specify files
11481 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
11482 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
11483 @end menu
11484
11485 @node Files
11486 @section Commands to Specify Files
11487
11488 @cindex symbol table
11489 @cindex core dump file
11490
11491 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
11492 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
11493 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
11494 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
11495
11496 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
11497 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
11498 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
11499 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver}
11500 Program}). In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify
11501 new files are useful.
11502
11503 @table @code
11504 @cindex executable file
11505 @kindex file
11506 @item file @var{filename}
11507 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
11508 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
11509 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
11510 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
11511 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
11512 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
11513 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
11514 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
11515
11516 @cindex unlinked object files
11517 @cindex patching object files
11518 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
11519 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
11520 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
11521 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
11522 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
11523 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
11524 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
11525 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
11526
11527 @item file
11528 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
11529 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
11530
11531 @kindex exec-file
11532 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
11533 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
11534 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
11535 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
11536 discard information on the executable file.
11537
11538 @kindex symbol-file
11539 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
11540 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
11541 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
11542 table and program to run from the same file.
11543
11544 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
11545 program's symbol table.
11546
11547 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
11548 some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
11549 contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
11550 which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
11551 @value{GDBN}.
11552
11553 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
11554 executing it once.
11555
11556 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
11557 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
11558 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
11559 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
11560 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
11561 using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for
11562 optimized code.
11563
11564 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
11565 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
11566 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
11567 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
11568 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
11569
11570 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
11571 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
11572 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
11573 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
11574 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
11575 Warnings and Messages}.)
11576
11577 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
11578 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
11579 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
11580 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
11581 in stabs format.
11582
11583 @kindex readnow
11584 @cindex reading symbols immediately
11585 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
11586 @item symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
11587 @itemx file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
11588 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
11589 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
11590 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
11591 entire symbol table available.
11592
11593 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
11594 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
11595 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
11596 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
11597 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
11598 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
11599 @c files.
11600
11601 @kindex core-file
11602 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
11603 @itemx core
11604 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
11605 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
11606 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
11607 executable file itself for other parts.
11608
11609 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
11610 to be used.
11611
11612 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
11613 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
11614 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
11615 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
11616 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}).
11617
11618 @kindex add-symbol-file
11619 @cindex dynamic linking
11620 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
11621 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
11622 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{-s}@var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
11623 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
11624 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
11625 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
11626 into the program that is running. @var{address} should be the memory
11627 address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
11628 this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
11629 of @samp{@r{-s}@var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
11630 section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
11631 @var{address} as an expression.
11632
11633 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
11634 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
11635 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
11636 thus read keeps adding to the old. To discard all old symbol data
11637 instead, use the @code{symbol-file} command without any arguments.
11638
11639 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
11640 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
11641 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
11642 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
11643 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
11644 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
11645 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
11646 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
11647 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
11648
11649 @itemize @bullet
11650 @item
11651 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
11652 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
11653 @item
11654 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
11655 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
11656 @item
11657 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
11658 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
11659 @end itemize
11660
11661 @noindent
11662 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
11663 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
11664 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
11665 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
11666 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
11667 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
11668 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
11669 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
11670 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
11671 way.
11672
11673 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
11674
11675 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
11676 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
11677 @cindex load symbols from memory
11678 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
11679 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
11680 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
11681 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
11682 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
11683 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
11684 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
11685 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
11686 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
11687
11688 @kindex add-shared-symbol-files
11689 @kindex assf
11690 @item add-shared-symbol-files @var{library-file}
11691 @itemx assf @var{library-file}
11692 The @code{add-shared-symbol-files} command can currently be used only
11693 in the Cygwin build of @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows OS, where it is an
11694 alias for the @code{dll-symbols} command (@pxref{Cygwin Native}).
11695 @value{GDBN} automatically looks for shared libraries, however if
11696 @value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can invoke
11697 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}. It takes one argument: the shared
11698 library's file name. @code{assf} is a shorthand alias for
11699 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}.
11700
11701 @kindex section
11702 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
11703 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
11704 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
11705 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
11706 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
11707 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
11708 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
11709 their addresses.
11710
11711 @kindex info files
11712 @kindex info target
11713 @item info files
11714 @itemx info target
11715 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
11716 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
11717 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
11718 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
11719 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
11720 current ones.
11721
11722 @kindex maint info sections
11723 @item maint info sections
11724 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
11725 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
11726 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
11727 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
11728 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
11729 may be arbitrarily combined):
11730
11731 @table @code
11732 @item ALLOBJ
11733 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
11734 @item @var{sections}
11735 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
11736 @item @var{section-flags}
11737 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
11738 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
11739 @table @code
11740 @item ALLOC
11741 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
11742 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
11743 @item LOAD
11744 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
11745 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
11746 @item RELOC
11747 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
11748 @item READONLY
11749 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
11750 @item CODE
11751 Section contains executable code only.
11752 @item DATA
11753 Section contains data only (no executable code).
11754 @item ROM
11755 Section will reside in ROM.
11756 @item CONSTRUCTOR
11757 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
11758 @item HAS_CONTENTS
11759 Section is not empty.
11760 @item NEVER_LOAD
11761 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
11762 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
11763 A notification to the linker that the section contains
11764 COFF shared library information.
11765 @item IS_COMMON
11766 Section contains common symbols.
11767 @end table
11768 @end table
11769 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
11770 @cindex read-only sections
11771 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
11772 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
11773 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
11774 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
11775 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
11776 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
11777 enhancement to debugging performance.
11778
11779 The default is off.
11780
11781 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
11782 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
11783 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
11784 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
11785
11786 @item show trust-readonly-sections
11787 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
11788 @end table
11789
11790 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
11791 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
11792 name and remembers it that way.
11793
11794 @cindex shared libraries
11795 @value{GDBN} supports GNU/Linux, MS-Windows, HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix,
11796 and IBM RS/6000 AIX shared libraries.
11797
11798 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
11799 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
11800 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
11801 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
11802 debugging a core file).
11803
11804 On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
11805 automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
11806
11807 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
11808 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
11809 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
11810
11811 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
11812 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
11813 particularly large or there are many of them.
11814
11815 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
11816 commands:
11817
11818 @table @code
11819 @kindex set auto-solib-add
11820 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
11821 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
11822 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
11823 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
11824 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
11825 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
11826 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
11827
11828 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
11829 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
11830 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
11831 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
11832 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
11833 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
11834 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
11835 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches
11836 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
11837
11838 @kindex show auto-solib-add
11839 @item show auto-solib-add
11840 Display the current autoloading mode.
11841 @end table
11842
11843 @cindex load shared library
11844 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
11845 command:
11846
11847 @table @code
11848 @kindex info sharedlibrary
11849 @kindex info share
11850 @item info share
11851 @itemx info sharedlibrary
11852 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded.
11853
11854 @kindex sharedlibrary
11855 @kindex share
11856 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
11857 @itemx share @var{regex}
11858 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
11859 Unix regular expression.
11860 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
11861 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
11862 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
11863 loaded.
11864
11865 @item nosharedlibrary
11866 @kindex nosharedlibrary
11867 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
11868 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
11869 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
11870 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
11871 discarded.
11872 @end table
11873
11874 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
11875 when any of shared library events happen. Use the @code{set
11876 stop-on-solib-events} command for this:
11877
11878 @table @code
11879 @item set stop-on-solib-events
11880 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
11881 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
11882 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
11883 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
11884 shared library.
11885
11886 @item show stop-on-solib-events
11887 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
11888 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
11889 library events happen.
11890 @end table
11891
11892 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
11893 configurations. A copy of the target's libraries need to be present on the
11894 host system; they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
11895 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
11896 not.
11897
11898 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
11899 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
11900 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
11901 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
11902 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
11903
11904 @table @code
11905 @cindex prefix for shared library file names
11906 @cindex system root, alternate
11907 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
11908 @kindex set sysroot
11909 @item set sysroot @var{path}
11910 Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any
11911 absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many
11912 runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the
11913 target program's memory. If you use @code{set sysroot} to find shared
11914 libraries, they need to be laid out in the same way that they are on
11915 the target, with e.g.@: a @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy
11916 under @var{path}.
11917
11918 The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set
11919 sysroot}.
11920
11921 @cindex default system root
11922 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
11923 You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
11924 @samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside
11925 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
11926 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated
11927 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
11928 location.
11929
11930 @kindex show sysroot
11931 @item show sysroot
11932 Display the current shared library prefix.
11933
11934 @kindex set solib-search-path
11935 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
11936 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
11937 directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path}
11938 is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the
11939 path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to
11940 use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set
11941 @samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from
11942 finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting
11943 it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading
11944 of shared library symbols.
11945
11946 @kindex show solib-search-path
11947 @item show solib-search-path
11948 Display the current shared library search path.
11949 @end table
11950
11951
11952 @node Separate Debug Files
11953 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
11954 @cindex separate debugging information files
11955 @cindex debugging information in separate files
11956 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
11957 @cindex debugging information directory, global
11958 @cindex global debugging information directory
11959 @cindex build ID, and separate debugging files
11960 @cindex @file{.build-id} directory
11961
11962 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
11963 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
11964 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
11965 Since debugging information can be very large---sometimes larger
11966 than the executable code itself---some systems distribute debugging
11967 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
11968 install only when they need to debug a problem.
11969
11970 @value{GDBN} supports two ways of specifying the separate debug info
11971 file:
11972
11973 @itemize @bullet
11974 @item
11975 The executable contains a @dfn{debug link} that specifies the name of
11976 the separate debug info file. The separate debug file's name is
11977 usually @file{@var{executable}.debug}, where @var{executable} is the
11978 name of the corresponding executable file without leading directories
11979 (e.g., @file{ls.debug} for @file{/usr/bin/ls}). In addition, the
11980 debug link specifies a CRC32 checksum for the debug file, which
11981 @value{GDBN} uses to validate that the executable and the debug file
11982 came from the same build.
11983
11984 @item
11985 The executable contains a @dfn{build ID}, a unique bit string that is
11986 also present in the corresponding debug info file. (This is supported
11987 only on some operating systems, notably those which use the ELF format
11988 for binary files and the @sc{gnu} Binutils.) For more details about
11989 this feature, see the description of the @option{--build-id}
11990 command-line option in @ref{Options, , Command Line Options, ld.info,
11991 The GNU Linker}. The debug info file's name is not specified
11992 explicitly by the build ID, but can be computed from the build ID, see
11993 below.
11994 @end itemize
11995
11996 Depending on the way the debug info file is specified, @value{GDBN}
11997 uses two different methods of looking for the debug file:
11998
11999 @itemize @bullet
12000 @item
12001 For the ``debug link'' method, @value{GDBN} looks up the named file in
12002 the directory of the executable file, then in a subdirectory of that
12003 directory named @file{.debug}, and finally under the global debug
12004 directory, in a subdirectory whose name is identical to the leading
12005 directories of the executable's absolute file name.
12006
12007 @item
12008 For the ``build ID'' method, @value{GDBN} looks in the
12009 @file{.build-id} subdirectory of the global debug directory for a file
12010 named @file{@var{nn}/@var{nnnnnnnn}.debug}, where @var{nn} are the
12011 first 2 hex characters of the build ID bit string, and @var{nnnnnnnn}
12012 are the rest of the bit string. (Real build ID strings are 32 or more
12013 hex characters, not 10.)
12014 @end itemize
12015
12016 So, for example, suppose you ask @value{GDBN} to debug
12017 @file{/usr/bin/ls}, which has a debug link that specifies the
12018 file @file{ls.debug}, and a build ID whose value in hex is
12019 @code{abcdef1234}. If the global debug directory is
12020 @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look for the following
12021 debug information files, in the indicated order:
12022
12023 @itemize @minus
12024 @item
12025 @file{/usr/lib/debug/.build-id/ab/cdef1234.debug}
12026 @item
12027 @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug}
12028 @item
12029 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}
12030 @item
12031 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
12032 @end itemize
12033
12034 You can set the global debugging info directory's name, and view the
12035 name @value{GDBN} is currently using.
12036
12037 @table @code
12038
12039 @kindex set debug-file-directory
12040 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directory}
12041 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
12042 information files to @var{directory}.
12043
12044 @kindex show debug-file-directory
12045 @item show debug-file-directory
12046 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
12047 information files.
12048
12049 @end table
12050
12051 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
12052 @cindex debug link sections
12053 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
12054 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
12055
12056 @itemize
12057 @item
12058 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
12059 a zero byte,
12060 @item
12061 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
12062 boundary within the section, and
12063 @item
12064 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
12065 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
12066 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
12067 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
12068 @end itemize
12069
12070 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
12071 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
12072 described above.
12073
12074 @cindex @code{.note.gnu.build-id} sections
12075 @cindex build ID sections
12076 The build ID is a special section in the executable file (and in other
12077 ELF binary files that @value{GDBN} may consider). This section is
12078 often named @code{.note.gnu.build-id}, but that name is not mandatory.
12079 It contains unique identification for the built files---the ID remains
12080 the same across multiple builds of the same build tree. The default
12081 algorithm SHA1 produces 160 bits (40 hexadecimal characters) of the
12082 content for the build ID string. The same section with an identical
12083 value is present in the original built binary with symbols, in its
12084 stripped variant, and in the separate debugging information file.
12085
12086 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
12087 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
12088 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
12089 should have the same names, addresses, and sizes as the original file,
12090 but they need not contain any data---much like a @code{.bss} section
12091 in an ordinary executable.
12092
12093 The @sc{gnu} binary utilities (Binutils) package includes the
12094 @samp{objcopy} utility that can produce
12095 the separated executable / debugging information file pairs using the
12096 following commands:
12097
12098 @smallexample
12099 @kbd{objcopy --only-keep-debug foo foo.debug}
12100 @kbd{strip -g foo}
12101 @end smallexample
12102
12103 @noindent
12104 These commands remove the debugging
12105 information from the executable file @file{foo} and place it in the file
12106 @file{foo.debug}. You can use the first, second or both methods to link the
12107 two files:
12108
12109 @itemize @bullet
12110 @item
12111 The debug link method needs the following additional command to also leave
12112 behind a debug link in @file{foo}:
12113
12114 @smallexample
12115 @kbd{objcopy --add-gnu-debuglink=foo.debug foo}
12116 @end smallexample
12117
12118 Ulrich Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53, contains
12119 a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command @kbd{strip foo -f
12120 foo.debug} has the same functionality as the two @code{objcopy} commands and
12121 the @code{ln -s} command above, together.
12122
12123 @item
12124 Build ID gets embedded into the main executable using @code{ld --build-id} or
12125 the @value{NGCC} counterpart @code{gcc -Wl,--build-id}. Build ID support plus
12126 compatibility fixes for debug files separation are present in @sc{gnu} binary
12127 utilities (Binutils) package since version 2.18.
12128 @end itemize
12129
12130 @noindent
12131
12132 Since there are many different ways to compute CRC's for the debug
12133 link (different polynomials, reversals, byte ordering, etc.), the
12134 simplest way to describe the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink}
12135 sections is to give the complete code for a function that computes it:
12136
12137 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
12138 @smallexample
12139 unsigned long
12140 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
12141 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
12142 @{
12143 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
12144 @{
12145 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
12146 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
12147 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
12148 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
12149 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
12150 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
12151 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
12152 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
12153 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
12154 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
12155 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
12156 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
12157 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
12158 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
12159 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
12160 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
12161 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
12162 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
12163 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
12164 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
12165 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
12166 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
12167 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
12168 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
12169 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
12170 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
12171 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
12172 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
12173 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
12174 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
12175 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
12176 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
12177 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
12178 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
12179 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
12180 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
12181 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
12182 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
12183 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
12184 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
12185 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
12186 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
12187 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
12188 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
12189 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
12190 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
12191 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
12192 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
12193 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
12194 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
12195 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
12196 0x2d02ef8d
12197 @};
12198 unsigned char *end;
12199
12200 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
12201 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
12202 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
12203 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
12204 @}
12205 @end smallexample
12206
12207 @noindent
12208 This computation does not apply to the ``build ID'' method.
12209
12210
12211 @node Symbol Errors
12212 @section Errors Reading Symbol Files
12213
12214 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
12215 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
12216 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
12217 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
12218 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
12219 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
12220 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
12221 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
12222 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
12223 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
12224 Messages}).
12225
12226 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
12227
12228 @table @code
12229 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
12230
12231 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
12232 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
12233 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
12234 in its outer scope blocks.
12235
12236 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
12237 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
12238 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
12239 function.
12240
12241 @item block at @var{address} out of order
12242
12243 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
12244 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
12245 do so.
12246
12247 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
12248 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
12249 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
12250 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
12251 Messages}.)
12252
12253 @item bad block start address patched
12254
12255 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
12256 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
12257 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
12258
12259 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
12260 starting on the previous source line.
12261
12262 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
12263
12264 @cindex foo
12265 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
12266 larger than the size of the string table.
12267
12268 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
12269 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
12270 with this name.
12271
12272 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
12273
12274 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
12275 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
12276 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
12277
12278 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
12279 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
12280 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
12281 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
12282 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
12283 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
12284
12285 @item stub type has NULL name
12286
12287 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
12288
12289 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
12290 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
12291 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
12292 it.
12293
12294 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
12295
12296 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
12297
12298 @end table
12299
12300 @node Targets
12301 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
12302
12303 @cindex debugging target
12304 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
12305
12306 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
12307 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
12308 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
12309 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
12310 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
12311 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
12312 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
12313 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}).
12314
12315 @cindex target architecture
12316 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
12317 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
12318 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
12319 command.
12320
12321 @table @code
12322 @kindex set architecture
12323 @kindex show architecture
12324 @item set architecture @var{arch}
12325 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
12326 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
12327 supported architectures.
12328
12329 @item show architecture
12330 Show the current target architecture.
12331
12332 @item set processor
12333 @itemx processor
12334 @kindex set processor
12335 @kindex show processor
12336 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
12337 and @code{show architecture}.
12338 @end table
12339
12340 @menu
12341 * Active Targets:: Active targets
12342 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
12343 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
12344 @end menu
12345
12346 @node Active Targets
12347 @section Active Targets
12348
12349 @cindex stacking targets
12350 @cindex active targets
12351 @cindex multiple targets
12352
12353 There are three classes of targets: processes, core files, and
12354 executable files. @value{GDBN} can work concurrently on up to three
12355 active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for example)
12356 start a process and inspect its activity without abandoning your work on
12357 a core file.
12358
12359 For example, if you execute @samp{gdb a.out}, then the executable file
12360 @code{a.out} is the only active target. If you designate a core file as
12361 well---presumably from a prior run that crashed and coredumped---then
12362 @value{GDBN} has two active targets and uses them in tandem, looking
12363 first in the corefile target, then in the executable file, to satisfy
12364 requests for memory addresses. (Typically, these two classes of target
12365 are complementary, since core files contain only a program's
12366 read-write memory---variables and so on---plus machine status, while
12367 executable files contain only the program text and initialized data.)
12368
12369 When you type @code{run}, your executable file becomes an active process
12370 target as well. When a process target is active, all @value{GDBN}
12371 commands requesting memory addresses refer to that target; addresses in
12372 an active core file or executable file target are obscured while the
12373 process target is active.
12374
12375 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new
12376 core file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify
12377 Files}). To specify as a target a process that is already running, use
12378 the @code{attach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running
12379 Process}).
12380
12381 @node Target Commands
12382 @section Commands for Managing Targets
12383
12384 @table @code
12385 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
12386 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
12387 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
12388 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
12389 protocol of the target machine.
12390
12391 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
12392 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
12393 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
12394
12395 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
12396 after executing the command.
12397
12398 @kindex help target
12399 @item help target
12400 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
12401 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
12402 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
12403
12404 @item help target @var{name}
12405 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
12406 select it.
12407
12408 @kindex set gnutarget
12409 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
12410 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
12411 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
12412 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
12413 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
12414 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
12415
12416 @quotation
12417 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
12418 you must know the actual BFD name.
12419 @end quotation
12420
12421 @noindent
12422 @xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}.
12423
12424 @kindex show gnutarget
12425 @item show gnutarget
12426 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
12427 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
12428 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
12429 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BDF target is "auto"}.
12430 @end table
12431
12432 @cindex common targets
12433 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
12434 configuration):
12435
12436 @table @code
12437 @kindex target
12438 @item target exec @var{program}
12439 @cindex executable file target
12440 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
12441 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
12442
12443 @item target core @var{filename}
12444 @cindex core dump file target
12445 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
12446 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
12447
12448 @item target remote @var{medium}
12449 @cindex remote target
12450 A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
12451 connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
12452 protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
12453
12454 For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
12455 machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
12456
12457 @smallexample
12458 target remote /dev/ttya
12459 @end smallexample
12460
12461 @code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
12462 useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
12463 system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
12464 clobbered by the download.
12465
12466 @item target sim
12467 @cindex built-in simulator target
12468 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
12469 In general,
12470 @smallexample
12471 target sim
12472 load
12473 run
12474 @end smallexample
12475 @noindent
12476 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
12477 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
12478 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
12479 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
12480 Processors}.
12481
12482 @end table
12483
12484 Some configurations may include these targets as well:
12485
12486 @table @code
12487
12488 @item target nrom @var{dev}
12489 @cindex NetROM ROM emulator target
12490 NetROM ROM emulator. This target only supports downloading.
12491
12492 @end table
12493
12494 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
12495 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
12496
12497 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
12498 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
12499 various aspects of this process.
12500
12501 @table @code
12502
12503 @item set hash
12504 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
12505 @cindex hash mark while downloading
12506 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
12507 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
12508 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
12509 monitor.
12510
12511 @item show hash
12512 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
12513 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
12514
12515 @item set debug monitor
12516 @kindex set debug monitor
12517 @cindex display remote monitor communications
12518 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
12519 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
12520
12521 @item show debug monitor
12522 @kindex show debug monitor
12523 Show the current status of displaying communications between
12524 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
12525 @end table
12526
12527 @table @code
12528
12529 @kindex load @var{filename}
12530 @item load @var{filename}
12531 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
12532 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
12533 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
12534 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
12535 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
12536 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
12537
12538 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
12539 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
12540 target is @dots{}}''
12541
12542 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
12543 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
12544 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
12545 specifies a fixed address.
12546 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
12547
12548 Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
12549 load programs into flash memory.
12550
12551 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
12552 @end table
12553
12554 @node Byte Order
12555 @section Choosing Target Byte Order
12556
12557 @cindex choosing target byte order
12558 @cindex target byte order
12559
12560 Some types of processors, such as the MIPS, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
12561 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
12562 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
12563 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
12564 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
12565 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
12566
12567 @table @code
12568 @kindex set endian
12569 @item set endian big
12570 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
12571
12572 @item set endian little
12573 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
12574
12575 @item set endian auto
12576 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
12577 executable.
12578
12579 @item show endian
12580 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
12581
12582 @end table
12583
12584 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
12585 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
12586 target system.
12587
12588
12589 @node Remote Debugging
12590 @chapter Debugging Remote Programs
12591 @cindex remote debugging
12592
12593 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
12594 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
12595 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
12596 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
12597 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
12598
12599 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
12600 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
12601 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
12602 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
12603 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
12604 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
12605
12606 Other remote targets may be available in your
12607 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
12608
12609 @menu
12610 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
12611 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
12612 * Remote Configuration:: Remote configuration
12613 * Remote Stub:: Implementing a remote stub
12614 @end menu
12615
12616 @node Connecting
12617 @section Connecting to a Remote Target
12618
12619 On the @value{GDBN} host machine, you will need an unstripped copy of
12620 your program, since @value{GDBN} needs symbol and debugging information.
12621 Start up @value{GDBN} as usual, using the name of the local copy of your
12622 program as the first argument.
12623
12624 @cindex @code{target remote}
12625 @value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, or
12626 over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
12627 each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
12628 program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
12629 @code{target remote} command establishes a connection to the target.
12630 Its arguments indicate which medium to use:
12631
12632 @table @code
12633
12634 @item target remote @var{serial-device}
12635 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
12636 Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
12637 to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
12638
12639 @smallexample
12640 target remote /dev/ttyb
12641 @end smallexample
12642
12643 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
12644 @w{@samp{--baud}} option, or use the @code{set remotebaud} command
12645 (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remotebaud}) before the
12646 @code{target} command.
12647
12648 @item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
12649 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
12650 @cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
12651 Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
12652 The @var{host} may be either a host name or a numeric @acronym{IP}
12653 address; @var{port} must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be
12654 the target machine itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or
12655 it might be a terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the
12656 target.
12657
12658 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
12659 @code{manyfarms}:
12660
12661 @smallexample
12662 target remote manyfarms:2828
12663 @end smallexample
12664
12665 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
12666 debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
12667 same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
12668 port 1234 on your local machine:
12669
12670 @smallexample
12671 target remote :1234
12672 @end smallexample
12673 @noindent
12674
12675 Note that the colon is still required here.
12676
12677 @item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
12678 @cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
12679 Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
12680 connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
12681
12682 @smallexample
12683 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
12684 @end smallexample
12685
12686 When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
12687 keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
12688 can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
12689 cause havoc with your debugging session.
12690
12691 @item target remote | @var{command}
12692 @cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
12693 Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
12694 pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
12695 by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
12696 protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
12697 standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
12698 that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
12699 using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
12700
12701 If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
12702 @value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
12703 program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
12704
12705 @end table
12706
12707 Once the connection has been established, you can use all the usual
12708 commands to examine and change data and to step and continue the
12709 remote program.
12710
12711 @cindex interrupting remote programs
12712 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
12713 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
12714 interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
12715 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
12716 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
12717 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
12718
12719 @smallexample
12720 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
12721 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
12722 @end smallexample
12723
12724 If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
12725 (If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
12726 remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
12727 goes back to waiting.
12728
12729 @table @code
12730 @kindex detach (remote)
12731 @item detach
12732 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
12733 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
12734 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
12735 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
12736 command, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to another target.
12737
12738 @kindex disconnect
12739 @item disconnect
12740 The @code{disconnect} command behaves like @code{detach}, except that
12741 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
12742 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
12743 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
12744 another target.
12745
12746 @cindex send command to remote monitor
12747 @cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
12748 @cindex add new commands for external monitor
12749 @kindex monitor
12750 @item monitor @var{cmd}
12751 This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
12752 remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
12753 sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
12754 can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
12755 and implement.
12756 @end table
12757
12758 @node Server
12759 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program
12760
12761 @kindex gdbserver
12762 @cindex remote connection without stubs
12763 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
12764 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
12765 @code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
12766
12767 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
12768 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
12769 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
12770 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
12771 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
12772 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
12773 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
12774 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
12775 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
12776 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
12777 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
12778 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
12779 choice for debugging.
12780
12781 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
12782 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
12783 protocol.
12784
12785 @table @emph
12786 @item On the target machine,
12787 you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
12788 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
12789 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
12790 system does all the symbol handling.
12791
12792 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
12793 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
12794 syntax is:
12795
12796 @smallexample
12797 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
12798 @end smallexample
12799
12800 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line) or a TCP
12801 hostname and portnumber. For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
12802 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
12803 @file{/dev/com1}:
12804
12805 @smallexample
12806 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
12807 @end smallexample
12808
12809 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
12810 with it.
12811
12812 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
12813
12814 @smallexample
12815 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
12816 @end smallexample
12817
12818 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
12819 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
12820 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
12821 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
12822 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
12823 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
12824 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
12825 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
12826 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
12827 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
12828 @code{target remote} command.
12829
12830 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
12831 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
12832
12833 @smallexample
12834 target> gdbserver @var{comm} --attach @var{pid}
12835 @end smallexample
12836
12837 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't necessary
12838 to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
12839
12840 @pindex pidof
12841 @cindex attach to a program by name
12842 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
12843 @code{pidof} utility:
12844
12845 @smallexample
12846 target> gdbserver @var{comm} --attach `pidof @var{program}`
12847 @end smallexample
12848
12849 In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program}
12850 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
12851 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
12852
12853 @item On the host machine,
12854 first make sure you have the necessary symbol files. Load symbols for
12855 your application using the @code{file} command before you connect. Use
12856 @code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN}
12857 was compiled with the correct sysroot using @code{--with-system-root}).
12858
12859 The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable
12860 and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host
12861 system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system
12862 are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
12863 during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing
12864 files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded
12865 programs.
12866
12867 Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
12868 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
12869 the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
12870 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
12871 @samp{Connection refused}. You don't need to use the @code{load}
12872 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{gdbserver}, since the program is
12873 already on the target.
12874
12875 @end table
12876
12877 @subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver}
12878 @cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver}
12879
12880 During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the
12881 @code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}.
12882 Here are the available commands; they are only of interest when
12883 debugging @value{GDBN} or @code{gdbserver}.
12884
12885 @table @code
12886 @item monitor help
12887 List the available monitor commands.
12888
12889 @item monitor set debug 0
12890 @itemx monitor set debug 1
12891 Disable or enable general debugging messages.
12892
12893 @item monitor set remote-debug 0
12894 @itemx monitor set remote-debug 1
12895 Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote
12896 protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}).
12897
12898 @end table
12899
12900 @node Remote Configuration
12901 @section Remote Configuration
12902
12903 @kindex set remote
12904 @kindex show remote
12905 This section documents the configuration options available when
12906 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
12907 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
12908 system-call-allowed}.
12909
12910 @table @code
12911 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
12912 @cindex address size for remote targets
12913 @cindex bits in remote address
12914 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
12915 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
12916 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
12917 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
12918
12919 @item show remoteaddresssize
12920 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
12921
12922 @item set remotebaud @var{n}
12923 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
12924 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
12925 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
12926 remote targets.
12927
12928 @item show remotebaud
12929 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
12930
12931 @item set remotebreak
12932 @cindex interrupt remote programs
12933 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
12934 @anchor{set remotebreak}
12935 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
12936 when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
12937 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
12938 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
12939 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
12940
12941 @item show remotebreak
12942 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
12943 interrupt the remote program.
12944
12945 @item set remoteflow on
12946 @itemx set remoteflow off
12947 @kindex set remoteflow
12948 Enable or disable hardware flow control (@code{RTS}/@code{CTS})
12949 on the serial port used to communicate to the remote target.
12950
12951 @item show remoteflow
12952 @kindex show remoteflow
12953 Show the current setting of hardware flow control.
12954
12955 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
12956 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
12957 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
12958 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
12959 @code{ascii}.
12960
12961 @item show remotelogbase
12962 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
12963 protocol.
12964
12965 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
12966 @cindex record serial communications on file
12967 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
12968 default is not to record at all.
12969
12970 @item show remotelogfile.
12971 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
12972 serial communications.
12973
12974 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
12975 @cindex timeout for serial communications
12976 @cindex remote timeout
12977 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
12978 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
12979
12980 @item show remotetimeout
12981 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
12982 responses.
12983
12984 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
12985 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
12986 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
12987 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
12988 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
12989 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
12990 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or
12991 watchpoints. A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited.
12992 @end table
12993
12994 @cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
12995 The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
12996 your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
12997 can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
12998 packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
12999 packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
13000 or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
13001 all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
13002 see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
13003
13004 During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
13005 If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
13006 in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
13007 @value{GDBN} developers.
13008
13009 For each packet @var{name}, the command to enable or disable the
13010 packet is @code{set remote @var{name}-packet}. The available settings
13011 are:
13012
13013 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.32 0.25
13014 @item Command Name
13015 @tab Remote Packet
13016 @tab Related Features
13017
13018 @item @code{fetch-register}
13019 @tab @code{p}
13020 @tab @code{info registers}
13021
13022 @item @code{set-register}
13023 @tab @code{P}
13024 @tab @code{set}
13025
13026 @item @code{binary-download}
13027 @tab @code{X}
13028 @tab @code{load}, @code{set}
13029
13030 @item @code{read-aux-vector}
13031 @tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
13032 @tab @code{info auxv}
13033
13034 @item @code{symbol-lookup}
13035 @tab @code{qSymbol}
13036 @tab Detecting multiple threads
13037
13038 @item @code{verbose-resume}
13039 @tab @code{vCont}
13040 @tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
13041
13042 @item @code{software-breakpoint}
13043 @tab @code{Z0}
13044 @tab @code{break}
13045
13046 @item @code{hardware-breakpoint}
13047 @tab @code{Z1}
13048 @tab @code{hbreak}
13049
13050 @item @code{write-watchpoint}
13051 @tab @code{Z2}
13052 @tab @code{watch}
13053
13054 @item @code{read-watchpoint}
13055 @tab @code{Z3}
13056 @tab @code{rwatch}
13057
13058 @item @code{access-watchpoint}
13059 @tab @code{Z4}
13060 @tab @code{awatch}
13061
13062 @item @code{target-features}
13063 @tab @code{qXfer:features:read}
13064 @tab @code{set architecture}
13065
13066 @item @code{library-info}
13067 @tab @code{qXfer:libraries:read}
13068 @tab @code{info sharedlibrary}
13069
13070 @item @code{memory-map}
13071 @tab @code{qXfer:memory-map:read}
13072 @tab @code{info mem}
13073
13074 @item @code{read-spu-object}
13075 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:read}
13076 @tab @code{info spu}
13077
13078 @item @code{write-spu-object}
13079 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:write}
13080 @tab @code{info spu}
13081
13082 @item @code{get-thread-local-@*storage-address}
13083 @tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
13084 @tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
13085
13086 @item @code{supported-packets}
13087 @tab @code{qSupported}
13088 @tab Remote communications parameters
13089
13090 @item @code{pass-signals}
13091 @tab @code{QPassSignals}
13092 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
13093
13094 @end multitable
13095
13096 @node Remote Stub
13097 @section Implementing a Remote Stub
13098
13099 @cindex debugging stub, example
13100 @cindex remote stub, example
13101 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
13102 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
13103 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
13104 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
13105 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
13106 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
13107 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
13108 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
13109
13110 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
13111 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
13112 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
13113 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
13114 program, you need:
13115
13116 @enumerate
13117 @item
13118 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
13119 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
13120 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
13121
13122 @item
13123 A C subroutine library to support your program's
13124 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
13125
13126 @item
13127 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
13128 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
13129 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
13130 documentation.
13131 @end enumerate
13132
13133 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
13134 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
13135 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
13136
13137 @table @emph
13138 @item On the host,
13139 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
13140 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
13141 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
13142
13143 @item On the target,
13144 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
13145 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
13146 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
13147
13148 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
13149 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
13150 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details.
13151 @end table
13152
13153 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
13154 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
13155 @sc{sparc} boards.
13156
13157 @cindex remote serial stub list
13158 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
13159
13160 @table @code
13161
13162 @item i386-stub.c
13163 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
13164 @cindex Intel
13165 @cindex i386
13166 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
13167
13168 @item m68k-stub.c
13169 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
13170 @cindex Motorola 680x0
13171 @cindex m680x0
13172 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
13173
13174 @item sh-stub.c
13175 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
13176 @cindex Renesas
13177 @cindex SH
13178 For Renesas SH architectures.
13179
13180 @item sparc-stub.c
13181 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
13182 @cindex Sparc
13183 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
13184
13185 @item sparcl-stub.c
13186 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
13187 @cindex Fujitsu
13188 @cindex SparcLite
13189 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
13190
13191 @end table
13192
13193 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
13194 recently added stubs.
13195
13196 @menu
13197 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
13198 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
13199 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
13200 @end menu
13201
13202 @node Stub Contents
13203 @subsection What the Stub Can Do for You
13204
13205 @cindex remote serial stub
13206 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
13207 subroutines:
13208
13209 @table @code
13210 @item set_debug_traps
13211 @findex set_debug_traps
13212 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
13213 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
13214 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly near the
13215 beginning of your program.
13216
13217 @item handle_exception
13218 @findex handle_exception
13219 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
13220 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
13221 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
13222 run when a trap is triggered.
13223
13224 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
13225 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
13226 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
13227 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
13228 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
13229 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
13230 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
13231 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
13232 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
13233 machine.
13234
13235 @item breakpoint
13236 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
13237 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
13238 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
13239 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
13240 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
13241 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
13242 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
13243 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
13244 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
13245 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
13246 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
13247
13248 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
13249 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
13250 start of your debugging session.
13251 @end table
13252
13253 @node Bootstrapping
13254 @subsection What You Must Do for the Stub
13255
13256 @cindex remote stub, support routines
13257 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
13258 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
13259 debugging target machine.
13260
13261 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
13262 serial port.
13263
13264 @table @code
13265 @item int getDebugChar()
13266 @findex getDebugChar
13267 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
13268 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
13269 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
13270
13271 @item void putDebugChar(int)
13272 @findex putDebugChar
13273 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
13274 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
13275 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
13276 @end table
13277
13278 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
13279 @cindex interrupting remote targets
13280 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
13281 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
13282 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
13283 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
13284 remote system to stop.
13285
13286 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
13287 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
13288 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
13289 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
13290
13291 Other routines you need to supply are:
13292
13293 @table @code
13294 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
13295 @findex exceptionHandler
13296 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
13297 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
13298 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
13299 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
13300 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
13301 @var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed;
13302 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
13303 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
13304 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
13305 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
13306 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
13307 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
13308 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
13309
13310 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
13311 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
13312 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
13313 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
13314 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
13315
13316 @item void flush_i_cache()
13317 @findex flush_i_cache
13318 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
13319 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
13320 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
13321
13322 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
13323 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
13324 @end table
13325
13326 @noindent
13327 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
13328
13329 @table @code
13330 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
13331 @findex memset
13332 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
13333 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
13334 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
13335 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
13336 @end table
13337
13338 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
13339 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
13340 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
13341 subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code.
13342
13343
13344 @node Debug Session
13345 @subsection Putting it All Together
13346
13347 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
13348 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
13349 steps.
13350
13351 @enumerate
13352 @item
13353 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
13354 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}):
13355 @display
13356 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
13357 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
13358 @end display
13359
13360 @item
13361 Insert these lines near the top of your program:
13362
13363 @smallexample
13364 set_debug_traps();
13365 breakpoint();
13366 @end smallexample
13367
13368 @item
13369 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
13370 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
13371
13372 @smallexample
13373 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
13374 @end smallexample
13375
13376 @noindent
13377 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
13378 function in your program, that function is called when
13379 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
13380 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
13381 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
13382
13383 @item
13384 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
13385 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
13386
13387 @item
13388 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
13389 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
13390
13391 @item
13392 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
13393 @c document that. FIXME.
13394 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
13395 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
13396
13397 @item
13398 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
13399 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
13400
13401 @end enumerate
13402
13403 @node Configurations
13404 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
13405
13406 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
13407 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
13408 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
13409
13410 There are three major categories of configurations: native
13411 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
13412 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
13413 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
13414 are quite different from each other.
13415
13416 @menu
13417 * Native::
13418 * Embedded OS::
13419 * Embedded Processors::
13420 * Architectures::
13421 @end menu
13422
13423 @node Native
13424 @section Native
13425
13426 This section describes details specific to particular native
13427 configurations.
13428
13429 @menu
13430 * HP-UX:: HP-UX
13431 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
13432 * SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
13433 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
13434 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
13435 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
13436 * Neutrino:: Features specific to QNX Neutrino
13437 @end menu
13438
13439 @node HP-UX
13440 @subsection HP-UX
13441
13442 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
13443 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
13444 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
13445
13446
13447 @node BSD libkvm Interface
13448 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
13449
13450 @cindex libkvm
13451 @cindex kernel memory image
13452 @cindex kernel crash dump
13453
13454 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
13455 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
13456 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
13457 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
13458 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
13459 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
13460 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
13461 @code{kvm} target:
13462
13463 @smallexample
13464 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
13465 @end smallexample
13466
13467 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
13468 argument:
13469
13470 @smallexample
13471 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
13472 @end smallexample
13473
13474 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
13475 available:
13476
13477 @table @code
13478 @kindex kvm
13479 @item kvm pcb
13480 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
13481
13482 @item kvm proc
13483 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
13484 modern FreeBSD systems.
13485 @end table
13486
13487 @node SVR4 Process Information
13488 @subsection SVR4 Process Information
13489 @cindex /proc
13490 @cindex examine process image
13491 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
13492
13493 Many versions of SVR4 and compatible systems provide a facility called
13494 @samp{/proc} that can be used to examine the image of a running
13495 process using file-system subroutines. If @value{GDBN} is configured
13496 for an operating system with this facility, the command @code{info
13497 proc} is available to report information about the process running
13498 your program, or about any process running on your system. @code{info
13499 proc} works only on SVR4 systems that include the @code{procfs} code.
13500 This includes, as of this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, OSF/1 (Digital
13501 Unix), Solaris, Irix, and Unixware, but not HP-UX, for example.
13502
13503 @table @code
13504 @kindex info proc
13505 @cindex process ID
13506 @item info proc
13507 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
13508 Summarize available information about any running process. If a
13509 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
13510 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
13511 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
13512 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
13513 executable file's absolute file name.
13514
13515 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
13516 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
13517 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
13518 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
13519 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
13520 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
13521
13522 @item info proc mappings
13523 @cindex memory address space mappings
13524 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in the program, with
13525 information on whether the process has read, write, or execute access
13526 rights to each range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, each memory range
13527 includes the object file which is mapped to that range, instead of the
13528 memory access rights to that range.
13529
13530 @item info proc stat
13531 @itemx info proc status
13532 @cindex process detailed status information
13533 These subcommands are specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. They show
13534 the process-related information, including the user ID and group ID;
13535 how many threads are there in the process; its virtual memory usage;
13536 the signals that are pending, blocked, and ignored; its TTY; its
13537 consumption of system and user time; its stack size; its @samp{nice}
13538 value; etc. For more information, see the @samp{proc} man page
13539 (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
13540
13541 @item info proc all
13542 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
13543 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
13544
13545 @ignore
13546 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
13547 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
13548 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
13549 @kindex info proc times
13550 @item info proc times
13551 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
13552 its children.
13553
13554 @kindex info proc id
13555 @item info proc id
13556 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
13557 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
13558 @end ignore
13559
13560 @item set procfs-trace
13561 @kindex set procfs-trace
13562 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
13563 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
13564
13565 @item show procfs-trace
13566 @kindex show procfs-trace
13567 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
13568
13569 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
13570 @kindex set procfs-file
13571 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
13572 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
13573 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
13574 standard output.
13575
13576 @item show procfs-file
13577 @kindex show procfs-file
13578 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
13579
13580 @item proc-trace-entry
13581 @itemx proc-trace-exit
13582 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
13583 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
13584 @kindex proc-trace-entry
13585 @kindex proc-trace-exit
13586 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
13587 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
13588 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
13589 from the @code{syscall} interface.
13590
13591 @item info pidlist
13592 @kindex info pidlist
13593 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
13594 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
13595 processes and all the threads within each process.
13596
13597 @item info meminfo
13598 @kindex info meminfo
13599 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
13600 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
13601 @end table
13602
13603 @node DJGPP Native
13604 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
13605 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
13606 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
13607 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
13608
13609 @cindex DPMI
13610 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
13611 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
13612 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
13613 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
13614
13615 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
13616 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
13617 subsection describes those commands.
13618
13619 @table @code
13620 @kindex info dos
13621 @item info dos
13622 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
13623 information about the target system and important OS structures.
13624
13625 @kindex sysinfo
13626 @cindex MS-DOS system info
13627 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
13628 @item info dos sysinfo
13629 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
13630 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
13631 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
13632
13633 @cindex GDT
13634 @cindex LDT
13635 @cindex IDT
13636 @cindex segment descriptor tables
13637 @cindex descriptor tables display
13638 @item info dos gdt
13639 @itemx info dos ldt
13640 @itemx info dos idt
13641 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
13642 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
13643 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
13644 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
13645 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
13646 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
13647 rights.
13648
13649 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
13650 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
13651 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
13652 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
13653 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
13654
13655 @cindex garbled pointers
13656 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
13657 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
13658 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
13659 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
13660 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
13661 debugged program's data segment:
13662
13663 @smallexample
13664 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
13665 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
13666 @end smallexample
13667
13668 @noindent
13669 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
13670 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
13671
13672 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
13673 @item info dos pde
13674 @itemx info dos pte
13675 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
13676 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
13677 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
13678 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
13679 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
13680 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
13681 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
13682 that is currently in use.
13683
13684 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
13685 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
13686 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
13687 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
13688 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
13689 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
13690 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
13691
13692 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
13693 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
13694 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
13695 controller.
13696
13697 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
13698
13699 @cindex physical address from linear address
13700 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
13701 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
13702 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
13703 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
13704 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
13705 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
13706 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
13707
13708 @smallexample
13709 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
13710 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
13711 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
13712 @end smallexample
13713
13714 @noindent
13715 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
13716 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
13717 attributes of that page.
13718
13719 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
13720 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
13721 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
13722 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
13723 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
13724 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
13725
13726 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
13727 transfer buffer:
13728
13729 @smallexample
13730 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
13731 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
13732 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
13733 @end smallexample
13734
13735 @noindent
13736 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
13737 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
13738 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
13739 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
13740 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
13741
13742 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
13743 @end table
13744
13745 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
13746 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
13747 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
13748 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
13749
13750 @table @code
13751 @kindex set com1base
13752 @kindex set com1irq
13753 @kindex set com2base
13754 @kindex set com2irq
13755 @kindex set com3base
13756 @kindex set com3irq
13757 @kindex set com4base
13758 @kindex set com4irq
13759 @item set com1base @var{addr}
13760 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
13761 port.
13762
13763 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
13764 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
13765 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
13766
13767 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
13768 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
13769 other 3 COM ports.
13770
13771 @kindex show com1base
13772 @kindex show com1irq
13773 @kindex show com2base
13774 @kindex show com2irq
13775 @kindex show com3base
13776 @kindex show com3irq
13777 @kindex show com4base
13778 @kindex show com4irq
13779 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
13780 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
13781 lines used by the COM ports.
13782
13783 @item info serial
13784 @kindex info serial
13785 @cindex DOS serial port status
13786 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
13787 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
13788 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
13789 counts of various errors encountered so far.
13790 @end table
13791
13792
13793 @node Cygwin Native
13794 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables
13795 @cindex MS Windows debugging
13796 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
13797 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
13798
13799 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
13800 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information. There are various
13801 additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in this section.
13802 Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is described in
13803 @ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}.
13804
13805 @table @code
13806 @kindex info w32
13807 @item info w32
13808 This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print
13809 information about the target system and important OS structures.
13810
13811 @item info w32 selector
13812 This command displays information returned by
13813 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
13814 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
13815 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
13816 Without argument, this command displays information
13817 about the six segment registers.
13818
13819 @kindex info dll
13820 @item info dll
13821 This is a Cygwin-specific alias of @code{info shared}.
13822
13823 @kindex dll-symbols
13824 @item dll-symbols
13825 This command loads symbols from a dll similarly to
13826 add-sym command but without the need to specify a base address.
13827
13828 @kindex set cygwin-exceptions
13829 @cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
13830 @cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
13831 @item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
13832 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
13833 happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
13834 @value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
13835 exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
13836 ``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
13837 Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
13838 @value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
13839
13840 @kindex show cygwin-exceptions
13841 @item show cygwin-exceptions
13842 Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
13843 inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
13844
13845 @kindex set new-console
13846 @item set new-console @var{mode}
13847 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
13848 be started in a new console on next start.
13849 If @var{mode} is @code{off}i, the debuggee will
13850 be started in the same console as the debugger.
13851
13852 @kindex show new-console
13853 @item show new-console
13854 Displays whether a new console is used
13855 when the debuggee is started.
13856
13857 @kindex set new-group
13858 @item set new-group @var{mode}
13859 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
13860 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
13861 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
13862 @samp{Ctrl-C}.
13863
13864 @kindex show new-group
13865 @item show new-group
13866 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
13867
13868 @kindex set debugevents
13869 @item set debugevents
13870 This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
13871 to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
13872 signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
13873 unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
13874 Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
13875
13876 @kindex set debugexec
13877 @item set debugexec
13878 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
13879 (such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
13880
13881 @kindex set debugexceptions
13882 @item set debugexceptions
13883 This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
13884 debuggee seen by the debugger.
13885
13886 @kindex set debugmemory
13887 @item set debugmemory
13888 This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
13889 and writes by the debugger.
13890
13891 @kindex set shell
13892 @item set shell
13893 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
13894 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
13895
13896 @kindex show shell
13897 @item show shell
13898 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
13899
13900 @end table
13901
13902 @menu
13903 * Non-debug DLL Symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
13904 @end menu
13905
13906 @node Non-debug DLL Symbols
13907 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols
13908 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
13909 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
13910
13911 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
13912 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
13913 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
13914 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
13915 information contained in the DLL's export table. This section
13916 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
13917 ``minimal symbols''.
13918
13919 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
13920 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
13921 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
13922 program run once to completion. It is also possible to force
13923 @value{GDBN} to load a particular DLL before starting the executable ---
13924 see the shared library information in @ref{Files}, or the
13925 @code{dll-symbols} command in @ref{Cygwin Native}. Currently,
13926 explicitly loading symbols from a DLL with no debugging information will
13927 cause the symbol names to be duplicated in @value{GDBN}'s lookup table,
13928 which may adversely affect symbol lookup performance.
13929
13930 @subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes
13931
13932 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
13933 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
13934 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
13935 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
13936 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
13937 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
13938 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
13939 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
13940 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
13941
13942 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
13943 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
13944 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
13945 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
13946 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols}
13947 (@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
13948
13949 @smallexample
13950 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
13951 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
13952
13953 Non-debugging symbols:
13954 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
13955 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
13956 @end smallexample
13957
13958 @smallexample
13959 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
13960 All functions matching regular expression "!":
13961
13962 Non-debugging symbols:
13963 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
13964 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
13965 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
13966 [etc...]
13967 @end smallexample
13968
13969 @subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols
13970
13971 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
13972 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
13973 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
13974 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
13975 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
13976 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
13977 a function within a DLL without a running program.
13978
13979 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
13980 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
13981 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
13982 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
13983 problem:
13984
13985 @smallexample
13986 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
13987 $1 = 268572168
13988 @end smallexample
13989
13990 @smallexample
13991 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
13992 0x10021610: "\230y\""
13993 @end smallexample
13994
13995 And two possible solutions:
13996
13997 @smallexample
13998 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
13999 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
14000 @end smallexample
14001
14002 @smallexample
14003 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
14004 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
14005 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
14006 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
14007 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
14008 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
14009 @end smallexample
14010
14011 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
14012 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
14013 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
14014 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
14015 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
14016
14017 @smallexample
14018 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
14019 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
14020 @end smallexample
14021
14022 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
14023 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
14024 safe.
14025
14026 @node Hurd Native
14027 @subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems
14028 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
14029
14030 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
14031 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
14032
14033 @table @code
14034 @item set signals
14035 @itemx set sigs
14036 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
14037 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
14038 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
14039 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
14040 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
14041 @code{signals}.
14042
14043 @item show signals
14044 @itemx show sigs
14045 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
14046 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
14047 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
14048
14049 @item set signal-thread
14050 @itemx set sigthread
14051 @kindex set signal-thread
14052 @kindex set sigthread
14053 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
14054 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
14055 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
14056 signal-thread}.
14057
14058 @item show signal-thread
14059 @itemx show sigthread
14060 @kindex show signal-thread
14061 @kindex show sigthread
14062 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
14063 delivered a signal.
14064
14065 @item set stopped
14066 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
14067 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
14068 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
14069 continued by delivering a signal to it.
14070
14071 @item show stopped
14072 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
14073 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
14074 stopped.
14075
14076 @item set exceptions
14077 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
14078 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
14079 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
14080 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
14081 trapping on.
14082
14083 @item show exceptions
14084 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
14085 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
14086
14087 @item set task pause
14088 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
14089 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
14090 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
14091 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
14092 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
14093 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
14094 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
14095 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
14096 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
14097
14098 @item show task pause
14099 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
14100 Show the current state of task suspension.
14101
14102 @item set task detach-suspend-count
14103 @cindex task suspend count
14104 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14105 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
14106 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
14107
14108 @item show task detach-suspend-count
14109 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
14110
14111 @item set task exception-port
14112 @itemx set task excp
14113 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14114 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
14115 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
14116 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
14117
14118 @item set noninvasive
14119 @cindex noninvasive task options
14120 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
14121 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
14122 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
14123 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
14124
14125 @item info send-rights
14126 @itemx info receive-rights
14127 @itemx info port-rights
14128 @itemx info port-sets
14129 @itemx info dead-names
14130 @itemx info ports
14131 @itemx info psets
14132 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14133 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14134 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14135 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14136 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14137 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
14138 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
14139 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
14140 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
14141
14142 @item set thread pause
14143 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
14144 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14145 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
14146 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
14147 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
14148 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
14149 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
14150 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
14151 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
14152 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
14153 only the current thread.
14154
14155 @item show thread pause
14156 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
14157 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
14158
14159 @item set thread run
14160 This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
14161
14162 @item show thread run
14163 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
14164
14165 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
14166 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14167 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14168 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
14169 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
14170 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
14171 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
14172
14173 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
14174 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
14175 detaching.
14176
14177 @item set thread exception-port
14178 @itemx set thread excp
14179 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
14180 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
14181 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
14182
14183 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
14184 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
14185 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
14186 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
14187
14188 @item set thread default
14189 @itemx show thread default
14190 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14191 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
14192 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
14193 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
14194 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
14195 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
14196 the non-default commands.
14197 @end table
14198
14199
14200 @node Neutrino
14201 @subsection QNX Neutrino
14202 @cindex QNX Neutrino
14203
14204 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the QNX
14205 Neutrino target:
14206
14207 @table @code
14208 @item set debug nto-debug
14209 @kindex set debug nto-debug
14210 When set to on, enables debugging messages specific to the QNX
14211 Neutrino support.
14212
14213 @item show debug nto-debug
14214 @kindex show debug nto-debug
14215 Show the current state of QNX Neutrino messages.
14216 @end table
14217
14218
14219 @node Embedded OS
14220 @section Embedded Operating Systems
14221
14222 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
14223 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
14224 architectures.
14225
14226 @menu
14227 * VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
14228 @end menu
14229
14230 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
14231 various real-time operating systems.
14232
14233 @node VxWorks
14234 @subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
14235
14236 @cindex VxWorks
14237
14238 @table @code
14239
14240 @kindex target vxworks
14241 @item target vxworks @var{machinename}
14242 A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename}
14243 is the target system's machine name or IP address.
14244
14245 @end table
14246
14247 On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
14248 current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
14249
14250 @value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
14251 VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from
14252 the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
14253 both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program
14254 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be
14255 installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
14256 @value{GDBN} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
14257
14258 @table @code
14259 @item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
14260 @kindex vxworks-timeout
14261 All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
14262 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
14263 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if
14264 your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
14265 of a thin network line.
14266 @end table
14267
14268 The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
14269 this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
14270 procedures.
14271
14272 @findex INCLUDE_RDB
14273 To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
14274 to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
14275 library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
14276 VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
14277 kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
14278 source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more
14279 information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
14280 manual.
14281 @c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
14282
14283 Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
14284 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
14285 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or
14286 @code{vxgdb}, depending on your installation).
14287
14288 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
14289
14290 @smallexample
14291 (vxgdb)
14292 @end smallexample
14293
14294 @menu
14295 * VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks
14296 * VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download
14297 * VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks
14298 @end menu
14299
14300 @node VxWorks Connection
14301 @subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
14302
14303 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
14304 network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
14305
14306 @smallexample
14307 (vxgdb) target vxworks tt
14308 @end smallexample
14309
14310 @need 750
14311 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
14312
14313 @smallexample
14314 Attaching remote machine across net...
14315 Connected to tt.
14316 @end smallexample
14317
14318 @need 1000
14319 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
14320 loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates
14321 these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
14322 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}); if it fails
14323 to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
14324
14325 @smallexample
14326 prog.o: No such file or directory.
14327 @end smallexample
14328
14329 When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
14330 the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
14331 command again.
14332
14333 @node VxWorks Download
14334 @subsubsection VxWorks Download
14335
14336 @cindex download to VxWorks
14337 If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
14338 object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
14339 @code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
14340 incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
14341 command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
14342 to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
14343 table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
14344 the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same
14345 filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
14346 Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
14347 to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
14348 the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program
14349 @file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
14350 and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this
14351 program, type this on VxWorks:
14352
14353 @smallexample
14354 -> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
14355 @end smallexample
14356
14357 @noindent
14358 Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
14359
14360 @smallexample
14361 (vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
14362 (vxgdb) load prog.o
14363 @end smallexample
14364
14365 @value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
14366
14367 @smallexample
14368 Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
14369 @end smallexample
14370
14371 You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
14372 after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that
14373 this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
14374 auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
14375 history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
14376 debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
14377 table.)
14378
14379 @node VxWorks Attach
14380 @subsubsection Running Tasks
14381
14382 @cindex running VxWorks tasks
14383 You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
14384 follows:
14385
14386 @smallexample
14387 (vxgdb) attach @var{task}
14388 @end smallexample
14389
14390 @noindent
14391 where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running
14392 or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at
14393 the time of attachment.
14394
14395 @node Embedded Processors
14396 @section Embedded Processors
14397
14398 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
14399 configurations.
14400
14401 @cindex send command to simulator
14402 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
14403 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
14404
14405 @table @code
14406 @item sim @var{command}
14407 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
14408 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
14409 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
14410 acceptable commands.
14411 @end table
14412
14413
14414 @menu
14415 * ARM:: ARM RDI
14416 * M32R/D:: Renesas M32R/D
14417 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
14418 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
14419 * OpenRISC 1000:: OpenRisc 1000
14420 * PA:: HP PA Embedded
14421 * PowerPC:: PowerPC
14422 * Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
14423 * Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
14424 * Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
14425 * AVR:: Atmel AVR
14426 * CRIS:: CRIS
14427 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
14428 @end menu
14429
14430 @node ARM
14431 @subsection ARM
14432 @cindex ARM RDI
14433
14434 @table @code
14435 @kindex target rdi
14436 @item target rdi @var{dev}
14437 ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
14438 use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
14439 monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
14440
14441 @kindex target rdp
14442 @item target rdp @var{dev}
14443 ARM Demon monitor.
14444
14445 @end table
14446
14447 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
14448
14449 @table @code
14450 @item set arm disassembler
14451 @kindex set arm
14452 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
14453 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
14454
14455 @item show arm disassembler
14456 @kindex show arm
14457 Show the current disassembly style.
14458
14459 @item set arm apcs32
14460 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
14461 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
14462
14463 @item show arm apcs32
14464 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
14465
14466 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
14467 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
14468 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
14469
14470 @table @code
14471 @item auto
14472 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
14473 @item softfpa
14474 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
14475 processors.
14476 @item fpa
14477 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
14478 @item softvfp
14479 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
14480 @item vfp
14481 VFP co-processor.
14482 @end table
14483
14484 @item show arm fpu
14485 Show the current type of the FPU.
14486
14487 @item set arm abi
14488 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
14489
14490 @item show arm abi
14491 Show the currently used ABI.
14492
14493 @item set debug arm
14494 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
14495 target support subsystem.
14496
14497 @item show debug arm
14498 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
14499 @end table
14500
14501 The following commands are available when an ARM target is debugged
14502 using the RDI interface:
14503
14504 @table @code
14505 @item rdilogfile @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
14506 @kindex rdilogfile
14507 @cindex ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) logging
14508 Set the filename for the ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) packet log.
14509 With an argument, sets the log file to the specified @var{file}. With
14510 no argument, show the current log file name. The default log file is
14511 @file{rdi.log}.
14512
14513 @item rdilogenable @r{[}@var{arg}@r{]}
14514 @kindex rdilogenable
14515 Control logging of ADP packets. With an argument of 1 or @code{"yes"}
14516 enables logging, with an argument 0 or @code{"no"} disables it. With
14517 no arguments displays the current setting. When logging is enabled,
14518 ADP packets exchanged between @value{GDBN} and the RDI target device
14519 are logged to a file.
14520
14521 @item set rdiromatzero
14522 @kindex set rdiromatzero
14523 @cindex ROM at zero address, RDI
14524 Tell @value{GDBN} whether the target has ROM at address 0. If on,
14525 vector catching is disabled, so that zero address can be used. If off
14526 (the default), vector catching is enabled. For this command to take
14527 effect, it needs to be invoked prior to the @code{target rdi} command.
14528
14529 @item show rdiromatzero
14530 @kindex show rdiromatzero
14531 Show the current setting of ROM at zero address.
14532
14533 @item set rdiheartbeat
14534 @kindex set rdiheartbeat
14535 @cindex RDI heartbeat
14536 Enable or disable RDI heartbeat packets. It is not recommended to
14537 turn on this option, since it confuses ARM and EPI JTAG interface, as
14538 well as the Angel monitor.
14539
14540 @item show rdiheartbeat
14541 @kindex show rdiheartbeat
14542 Show the setting of RDI heartbeat packets.
14543 @end table
14544
14545
14546 @node M32R/D
14547 @subsection Renesas M32R/D and M32R/SDI
14548
14549 @table @code
14550 @kindex target m32r
14551 @item target m32r @var{dev}
14552 Renesas M32R/D ROM monitor.
14553
14554 @kindex target m32rsdi
14555 @item target m32rsdi @var{dev}
14556 Renesas M32R SDI server, connected via parallel port to the board.
14557 @end table
14558
14559 The following @value{GDBN} commands are specific to the M32R monitor:
14560
14561 @table @code
14562 @item set download-path @var{path}
14563 @kindex set download-path
14564 @cindex find downloadable @sc{srec} files (M32R)
14565 Set the default path for finding downloadable @sc{srec} files.
14566
14567 @item show download-path
14568 @kindex show download-path
14569 Show the default path for downloadable @sc{srec} files.
14570
14571 @item set board-address @var{addr}
14572 @kindex set board-address
14573 @cindex M32-EVA target board address
14574 Set the IP address for the M32R-EVA target board.
14575
14576 @item show board-address
14577 @kindex show board-address
14578 Show the current IP address of the target board.
14579
14580 @item set server-address @var{addr}
14581 @kindex set server-address
14582 @cindex download server address (M32R)
14583 Set the IP address for the download server, which is the @value{GDBN}'s
14584 host machine.
14585
14586 @item show server-address
14587 @kindex show server-address
14588 Display the IP address of the download server.
14589
14590 @item upload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
14591 @kindex upload@r{, M32R}
14592 Upload the specified @sc{srec} @var{file} via the monitor's Ethernet
14593 upload capability. If no @var{file} argument is given, the current
14594 executable file is uploaded.
14595
14596 @item tload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
14597 @kindex tload@r{, M32R}
14598 Test the @code{upload} command.
14599 @end table
14600
14601 The following commands are available for M32R/SDI:
14602
14603 @table @code
14604 @item sdireset
14605 @kindex sdireset
14606 @cindex reset SDI connection, M32R
14607 This command resets the SDI connection.
14608
14609 @item sdistatus
14610 @kindex sdistatus
14611 This command shows the SDI connection status.
14612
14613 @item debug_chaos
14614 @kindex debug_chaos
14615 @cindex M32R/Chaos debugging
14616 Instructs the remote that M32R/Chaos debugging is to be used.
14617
14618 @item use_debug_dma
14619 @kindex use_debug_dma
14620 Instructs the remote to use the DEBUG_DMA method of accessing memory.
14621
14622 @item use_mon_code
14623 @kindex use_mon_code
14624 Instructs the remote to use the MON_CODE method of accessing memory.
14625
14626 @item use_ib_break
14627 @kindex use_ib_break
14628 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by IB break.
14629
14630 @item use_dbt_break
14631 @kindex use_dbt_break
14632 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by DBT.
14633 @end table
14634
14635 @node M68K
14636 @subsection M68k
14637
14638 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and a
14639 target command for the following ROM monitor.
14640
14641 @table @code
14642
14643 @kindex target dbug
14644 @item target dbug @var{dev}
14645 dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
14646
14647 @end table
14648
14649 @node MIPS Embedded
14650 @subsection MIPS Embedded
14651
14652 @cindex MIPS boards
14653 @value{GDBN} can use the MIPS remote debugging protocol to talk to a
14654 MIPS board attached to a serial line. This is available when
14655 you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.
14656
14657 @need 1000
14658 Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
14659
14660 @table @code
14661 @item target mips @var{port}
14662 @kindex target mips @var{port}
14663 To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
14664 name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
14665 command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
14666 the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
14667 been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
14668 download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
14669
14670 For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
14671 port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
14672 debugger:
14673
14674 @smallexample
14675 host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
14676 @value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
14677 (@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
14678 (@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
14679 (@value{GDBP}) run
14680 @end smallexample
14681
14682 @item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
14683 On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
14684 connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
14685 concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
14686 @samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
14687
14688 @item target pmon @var{port}
14689 @kindex target pmon @var{port}
14690 PMON ROM monitor.
14691
14692 @item target ddb @var{port}
14693 @kindex target ddb @var{port}
14694 NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
14695
14696 @item target lsi @var{port}
14697 @kindex target lsi @var{port}
14698 LSI variant of PMON.
14699
14700 @kindex target r3900
14701 @item target r3900 @var{dev}
14702 Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
14703
14704 @kindex target array
14705 @item target array @var{dev}
14706 Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
14707
14708 @end table
14709
14710
14711 @noindent
14712 @value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for MIPS targets:
14713
14714 @table @code
14715 @item set mipsfpu double
14716 @itemx set mipsfpu single
14717 @itemx set mipsfpu none
14718 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
14719 @itemx show mipsfpu
14720 @kindex set mipsfpu
14721 @kindex show mipsfpu
14722 @cindex MIPS remote floating point
14723 @cindex floating point, MIPS remote
14724 If your target board does not support the MIPS floating point
14725 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
14726 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
14727 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
14728 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
14729 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
14730 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
14731 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
14732 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
14733 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
14734 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
14735
14736 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
14737 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
14738 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
14739
14740 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
14741 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
14742
14743 @item set timeout @var{seconds}
14744 @itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
14745 @itemx show timeout
14746 @itemx show retransmit-timeout
14747 @cindex @code{timeout}, MIPS protocol
14748 @cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, MIPS protocol
14749 @kindex set timeout
14750 @kindex show timeout
14751 @kindex set retransmit-timeout
14752 @kindex show retransmit-timeout
14753 You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the MIPS
14754 remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
14755 default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
14756 waiting for an acknowledgement of a packet with the @code{set
14757 retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
14758 You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
14759 retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
14760 @value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.)
14761
14762 The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
14763 is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
14764 forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
14765 to run before stopping.
14766
14767 @item set syn-garbage-limit @var{num}
14768 @kindex set syn-garbage-limit@r{, MIPS remote}
14769 @cindex synchronize with remote MIPS target
14770 Limit the maximum number of characters @value{GDBN} should ignore when
14771 it tries to synchronize with the remote target. The default is 10
14772 characters. Setting the limit to -1 means there's no limit.
14773
14774 @item show syn-garbage-limit
14775 @kindex show syn-garbage-limit@r{, MIPS remote}
14776 Show the current limit on the number of characters to ignore when
14777 trying to synchronize with the remote system.
14778
14779 @item set monitor-prompt @var{prompt}
14780 @kindex set monitor-prompt@r{, MIPS remote}
14781 @cindex remote monitor prompt
14782 Tell @value{GDBN} to expect the specified @var{prompt} string from the
14783 remote monitor. The default depends on the target:
14784 @table @asis
14785 @item pmon target
14786 @samp{PMON}
14787 @item ddb target
14788 @samp{NEC010}
14789 @item lsi target
14790 @samp{PMON>}
14791 @end table
14792
14793 @item show monitor-prompt
14794 @kindex show monitor-prompt@r{, MIPS remote}
14795 Show the current strings @value{GDBN} expects as the prompt from the
14796 remote monitor.
14797
14798 @item set monitor-warnings
14799 @kindex set monitor-warnings@r{, MIPS remote}
14800 Enable or disable monitor warnings about hardware breakpoints. This
14801 has effect only for the @code{lsi} target. When on, @value{GDBN} will
14802 display warning messages whose codes are returned by the @code{lsi}
14803 PMON monitor for breakpoint commands.
14804
14805 @item show monitor-warnings
14806 @kindex show monitor-warnings@r{, MIPS remote}
14807 Show the current setting of printing monitor warnings.
14808
14809 @item pmon @var{command}
14810 @kindex pmon@r{, MIPS remote}
14811 @cindex send PMON command
14812 This command allows sending an arbitrary @var{command} string to the
14813 monitor. The monitor must be in debug mode for this to work.
14814 @end table
14815
14816 @node OpenRISC 1000
14817 @subsection OpenRISC 1000
14818 @cindex OpenRISC 1000
14819
14820 @cindex or1k boards
14821 See OR1k Architecture document (@uref{www.opencores.org}) for more information
14822 about platform and commands.
14823
14824 @table @code
14825
14826 @kindex target jtag
14827 @item target jtag jtag://@var{host}:@var{port}
14828
14829 Connects to remote JTAG server.
14830 JTAG remote server can be either an or1ksim or JTAG server,
14831 connected via parallel port to the board.
14832
14833 Example: @code{target jtag jtag://localhost:9999}
14834
14835 @kindex or1ksim
14836 @item or1ksim @var{command}
14837 If connected to @code{or1ksim} OpenRISC 1000 Architectural
14838 Simulator, proprietary commands can be executed.
14839
14840 @kindex info or1k spr
14841 @item info or1k spr
14842 Displays spr groups.
14843
14844 @item info or1k spr @var{group}
14845 @itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno}
14846 Displays register names in selected group.
14847
14848 @item info or1k spr @var{group} @var{register}
14849 @itemx info or1k spr @var{register}
14850 @itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno}
14851 @itemx info or1k spr @var{registerno}
14852 Shows information about specified spr register.
14853
14854 @kindex spr
14855 @item spr @var{group} @var{register} @var{value}
14856 @itemx spr @var{register @var{value}}
14857 @itemx spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno @var{value}}
14858 @itemx spr @var{registerno @var{value}}
14859 Writes @var{value} to specified spr register.
14860 @end table
14861
14862 Some implementations of OpenRISC 1000 Architecture also have hardware trace.
14863 It is very similar to @value{GDBN} trace, except it does not interfere with normal
14864 program execution and is thus much faster. Hardware breakpoints/watchpoint
14865 triggers can be set using:
14866 @table @code
14867 @item $LEA/$LDATA
14868 Load effective address/data
14869 @item $SEA/$SDATA
14870 Store effective address/data
14871 @item $AEA/$ADATA
14872 Access effective address ($SEA or $LEA) or data ($SDATA/$LDATA)
14873 @item $FETCH
14874 Fetch data
14875 @end table
14876
14877 When triggered, it can capture low level data, like: @code{PC}, @code{LSEA},
14878 @code{LDATA}, @code{SDATA}, @code{READSPR}, @code{WRITESPR}, @code{INSTR}.
14879
14880 @code{htrace} commands:
14881 @cindex OpenRISC 1000 htrace
14882 @table @code
14883 @kindex hwatch
14884 @item hwatch @var{conditional}
14885 Set hardware watchpoint on combination of Load/Store Effective Address(es)
14886 or Data. For example:
14887
14888 @code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
14889
14890 @code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
14891
14892 @kindex htrace
14893 @item htrace info
14894 Display information about current HW trace configuration.
14895
14896 @item htrace trigger @var{conditional}
14897 Set starting criteria for HW trace.
14898
14899 @item htrace qualifier @var{conditional}
14900 Set acquisition qualifier for HW trace.
14901
14902 @item htrace stop @var{conditional}
14903 Set HW trace stopping criteria.
14904
14905 @item htrace record [@var{data}]*
14906 Selects the data to be recorded, when qualifier is met and HW trace was
14907 triggered.
14908
14909 @item htrace enable
14910 @itemx htrace disable
14911 Enables/disables the HW trace.
14912
14913 @item htrace rewind [@var{filename}]
14914 Clears currently recorded trace data.
14915
14916 If filename is specified, new trace file is made and any newly collected data
14917 will be written there.
14918
14919 @item htrace print [@var{start} [@var{len}]]
14920 Prints trace buffer, using current record configuration.
14921
14922 @item htrace mode continuous
14923 Set continuous trace mode.
14924
14925 @item htrace mode suspend
14926 Set suspend trace mode.
14927
14928 @end table
14929
14930 @node PowerPC
14931 @subsection PowerPC
14932
14933 @table @code
14934 @kindex target dink32
14935 @item target dink32 @var{dev}
14936 DINK32 ROM monitor.
14937
14938 @kindex target ppcbug
14939 @item target ppcbug @var{dev}
14940 @kindex target ppcbug1
14941 @item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
14942 PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
14943
14944 @kindex target sds
14945 @item target sds @var{dev}
14946 SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
14947 @end table
14948
14949 @cindex SDS protocol
14950 The following commands specific to the SDS protocol are supported
14951 by@value{GDBN}:
14952
14953 @table @code
14954 @item set sdstimeout @var{nsec}
14955 @kindex set sdstimeout
14956 Set the timeout for SDS protocol reads to be @var{nsec} seconds. The
14957 default is 2 seconds.
14958
14959 @item show sdstimeout
14960 @kindex show sdstimeout
14961 Show the current value of the SDS timeout.
14962
14963 @item sds @var{command}
14964 @kindex sds@r{, a command}
14965 Send the specified @var{command} string to the SDS monitor.
14966 @end table
14967
14968
14969 @node PA
14970 @subsection HP PA Embedded
14971
14972 @table @code
14973
14974 @kindex target op50n
14975 @item target op50n @var{dev}
14976 OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
14977
14978 @kindex target w89k
14979 @item target w89k @var{dev}
14980 W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
14981
14982 @end table
14983
14984 @node Sparclet
14985 @subsection Tsqware Sparclet
14986
14987 @cindex Sparclet
14988
14989 @value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
14990 Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
14991 @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
14992 both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
14993 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
14994
14995 @table @code
14996 @item remotetimeout @var{args}
14997 @kindex remotetimeout
14998 @value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
14999 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
15000 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
15001 @end table
15002
15003 @cindex compiling, on Sparclet
15004 When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
15005 information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
15006 load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
15007 @samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
15008
15009 @smallexample
15010 sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
15011 @end smallexample
15012
15013 You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
15014
15015 @smallexample
15016 sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
15017 @end smallexample
15018
15019 @cindex running, on Sparclet
15020 Once you have set
15021 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
15022 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
15023 (or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
15024
15025 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
15026
15027 @smallexample
15028 (gdbslet)
15029 @end smallexample
15030
15031 @menu
15032 * Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
15033 * Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
15034 * Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
15035 * Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
15036 @end menu
15037
15038 @node Sparclet File
15039 @subsubsection Setting File to Debug
15040
15041 The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
15042
15043 @smallexample
15044 (gdbslet) file prog
15045 @end smallexample
15046
15047 @need 1000
15048 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
15049 @value{GDBN} locates
15050 the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
15051 path.
15052 If the file was compiled with debug information (option @samp{-g}), source
15053 files will be searched as well.
15054 @value{GDBN} locates
15055 the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
15056 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}).
15057 If it fails
15058 to find a file, it displays a message such as:
15059
15060 @smallexample
15061 prog: No such file or directory.
15062 @end smallexample
15063
15064 When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
15065 the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
15066 @code{target} command again.
15067
15068 @node Sparclet Connection
15069 @subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
15070
15071 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
15072 To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
15073
15074 @smallexample
15075 (gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
15076 Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
15077 main () at ../prog.c:3
15078 @end smallexample
15079
15080 @need 750
15081 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
15082
15083 @smallexample
15084 Connected to ttya.
15085 @end smallexample
15086
15087 @node Sparclet Download
15088 @subsubsection Sparclet Download
15089
15090 @cindex download to Sparclet
15091 Once connected to the Sparclet target,
15092 you can use the @value{GDBN}
15093 @code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
15094 The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
15095 command.
15096 Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
15097 address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
15098 offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
15099 of each of the file's sections.
15100 For instance, if the program
15101 @file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
15102 and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
15103
15104 @smallexample
15105 (gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
15106 Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
15107 @end smallexample
15108
15109 If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
15110 to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
15111 to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
15112
15113 @node Sparclet Execution
15114 @subsubsection Running and Debugging
15115
15116 @cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
15117 You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
15118 commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
15119 manual for the list of commands.
15120
15121 @smallexample
15122 (gdbslet) b main
15123 Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
15124 (gdbslet) run
15125 Starting program: prog
15126 Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
15127 3 char *symarg = 0;
15128 (gdbslet) step
15129 4 char *execarg = "hello!";
15130 (gdbslet)
15131 @end smallexample
15132
15133 @node Sparclite
15134 @subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
15135
15136 @table @code
15137
15138 @kindex target sparclite
15139 @item target sparclite @var{dev}
15140 Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
15141 You must use an additional command to debug the program.
15142 For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
15143 remote protocol.
15144
15145 @end table
15146
15147 @node Z8000
15148 @subsection Zilog Z8000
15149
15150 @cindex Z8000
15151 @cindex simulator, Z8000
15152 @cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
15153
15154 When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
15155 a Z8000 simulator.
15156
15157 For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
15158 unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
15159 segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
15160 appropriate by inspecting the object code.
15161
15162 @table @code
15163 @item target sim @var{args}
15164 @kindex sim
15165 @kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
15166 Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
15167 options, specify them via @var{args}.
15168 @end table
15169
15170 @noindent
15171 After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
15172 CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
15173 @code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
15174 to run your program, and so on.
15175
15176 As well as making available all the usual machine registers
15177 (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
15178 additional items of information as specially named registers:
15179
15180 @table @code
15181
15182 @item cycles
15183 Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
15184
15185 @item insts
15186 Counts instructions run in the simulator.
15187
15188 @item time
15189 Execution time in 60ths of a second.
15190
15191 @end table
15192
15193 You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
15194 conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
15195 conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
15196 simulated clock ticks.
15197
15198 @node AVR
15199 @subsection Atmel AVR
15200 @cindex AVR
15201
15202 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
15203 following AVR-specific commands:
15204
15205 @table @code
15206 @item info io_registers
15207 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
15208 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
15209 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
15210 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
15211 @end table
15212
15213 @node CRIS
15214 @subsection CRIS
15215 @cindex CRIS
15216
15217 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
15218 following CRIS-specific commands:
15219
15220 @table @code
15221 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
15222 @cindex CRIS version
15223 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
15224 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
15225 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
15226
15227 @item show cris-version
15228 Show the current CRIS version.
15229
15230 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
15231 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
15232 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
15233 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
15234 @code{R59}.
15235
15236 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
15237 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
15238
15239 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
15240 @cindex CRIS mode
15241 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
15242 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
15243 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
15244
15245 @item show cris-mode
15246 Show the current CRIS mode.
15247 @end table
15248
15249 @node Super-H
15250 @subsection Renesas Super-H
15251 @cindex Super-H
15252
15253 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
15254 commands:
15255
15256 @table @code
15257 @item regs
15258 @kindex regs@r{, Super-H}
15259 Show the values of all Super-H registers.
15260 @end table
15261
15262
15263 @node Architectures
15264 @section Architectures
15265
15266 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
15267 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
15268
15269 @menu
15270 * i386::
15271 * A29K::
15272 * Alpha::
15273 * MIPS::
15274 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
15275 * SPU:: Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
15276 @end menu
15277
15278 @node i386
15279 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues
15280
15281 @table @code
15282 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
15283 @kindex set struct-convention
15284 @cindex struct return convention
15285 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
15286 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
15287 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
15288 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
15289 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
15290 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
15291 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
15292 be returned in a register.
15293
15294 @item show struct-convention
15295 @kindex show struct-convention
15296 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
15297 from functions.
15298 @end table
15299
15300 @node A29K
15301 @subsection A29K
15302
15303 @table @code
15304
15305 @kindex set rstack_high_address
15306 @cindex AMD 29K register stack
15307 @cindex register stack, AMD29K
15308 @item set rstack_high_address @var{address}
15309 On AMD 29000 family processors, registers are saved in a separate
15310 @dfn{register stack}. There is no way for @value{GDBN} to determine the
15311 extent of this stack. Normally, @value{GDBN} just assumes that the
15312 stack is ``large enough''. This may result in @value{GDBN} referencing
15313 memory locations that do not exist. If necessary, you can get around
15314 this problem by specifying the ending address of the register stack with
15315 the @code{set rstack_high_address} command. The argument should be an
15316 address, which you probably want to precede with @samp{0x} to specify in
15317 hexadecimal.
15318
15319 @kindex show rstack_high_address
15320 @item show rstack_high_address
15321 Display the current limit of the register stack, on AMD 29000 family
15322 processors.
15323
15324 @end table
15325
15326 @node Alpha
15327 @subsection Alpha
15328
15329 See the following section.
15330
15331 @node MIPS
15332 @subsection MIPS
15333
15334 @cindex stack on Alpha
15335 @cindex stack on MIPS
15336 @cindex Alpha stack
15337 @cindex MIPS stack
15338 Alpha- and MIPS-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
15339 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
15340 find the beginning of a function.
15341
15342 @cindex response time, MIPS debugging
15343 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
15344 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
15345 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
15346 commands:
15347
15348 @table @code
15349 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, MIPS)
15350 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
15351 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
15352 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
15353 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
15354 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
15355 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
15356 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
15357
15358 @item show heuristic-fence-post
15359 Display the current limit.
15360 @end table
15361
15362 @noindent
15363 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
15364 for debugging programs on Alpha or MIPS processors.
15365
15366 Several MIPS-specific commands are available when debugging MIPS
15367 programs:
15368
15369 @table @code
15370 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
15371 @kindex set mips abi
15372 @cindex set ABI for MIPS
15373 Tell @value{GDBN} which MIPS ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
15374 values of @var{arg} are:
15375
15376 @table @samp
15377 @item auto
15378 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
15379 default).
15380 @item o32
15381 @item o64
15382 @item n32
15383 @item n64
15384 @item eabi32
15385 @item eabi64
15386 @item auto
15387 @end table
15388
15389 @item show mips abi
15390 @kindex show mips abi
15391 Show the MIPS ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
15392
15393 @item set mipsfpu
15394 @itemx show mipsfpu
15395 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
15396
15397 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
15398 @kindex set mips mask-address
15399 @cindex MIPS addresses, masking
15400 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
15401 MIPS addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
15402 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
15403 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
15404
15405 @item show mips mask-address
15406 @kindex show mips mask-address
15407 Show whether the upper 32 bits of MIPS addresses are masked off or
15408 not.
15409
15410 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
15411 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
15412 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit MIPS targets that
15413 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old MIPS 64 target
15414 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
15415 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
15416
15417 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
15418 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
15419 Show the current setting of compatibility with older MIPS 64 targets.
15420
15421 @item set debug mips
15422 @kindex set debug mips
15423 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the MIPS-specific
15424 target code in @value{GDBN}.
15425
15426 @item show debug mips
15427 @kindex show debug mips
15428 Show the current setting of MIPS debugging messages.
15429 @end table
15430
15431
15432 @node HPPA
15433 @subsection HPPA
15434 @cindex HPPA support
15435
15436 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the
15437 following special commands:
15438
15439 @table @code
15440 @item set debug hppa
15441 @kindex set debug hppa
15442 This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging
15443 messages are to be displayed.
15444
15445 @item show debug hppa
15446 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
15447
15448 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
15449 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
15450 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
15451 given @var{address}.
15452
15453 @end table
15454
15455
15456 @node SPU
15457 @subsection Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
15458 @cindex Cell Broadband Engine
15459 @cindex SPU
15460
15461 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture,
15462 it provides the following special commands:
15463
15464 @table @code
15465 @item info spu event
15466 @kindex info spu
15467 Display SPU event facility status. Shows current event mask
15468 and pending event status.
15469
15470 @item info spu signal
15471 Display SPU signal notification facility status. Shows pending
15472 signal-control word and signal notification mode of both signal
15473 notification channels.
15474
15475 @item info spu mailbox
15476 Display SPU mailbox facility status. Shows all pending entries,
15477 in order of processing, in each of the SPU Write Outbound,
15478 SPU Write Outbound Interrupt, and SPU Read Inbound mailboxes.
15479
15480 @item info spu dma
15481 Display MFC DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
15482 DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
15483 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
15484
15485 @item info spu proxydma
15486 Display MFC Proxy-DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
15487 Proxy-DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
15488 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
15489
15490 @end table
15491
15492
15493 @node Controlling GDB
15494 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
15495
15496 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
15497 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
15498 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. Other settings are
15499 described here.
15500
15501 @menu
15502 * Prompt:: Prompt
15503 * Editing:: Command editing
15504 * Command History:: Command history
15505 * Screen Size:: Screen size
15506 * Numbers:: Numbers
15507 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
15508 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
15509 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
15510 @end menu
15511
15512 @node Prompt
15513 @section Prompt
15514
15515 @cindex prompt
15516
15517 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
15518 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
15519 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
15520 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
15521 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
15522 which one you are talking to.
15523
15524 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
15525 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
15526 or a prompt that does not.
15527
15528 @table @code
15529 @kindex set prompt
15530 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
15531 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
15532
15533 @kindex show prompt
15534 @item show prompt
15535 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
15536 @end table
15537
15538 @node Editing
15539 @section Command Editing
15540 @cindex readline
15541 @cindex command line editing
15542
15543 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
15544 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
15545 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
15546 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
15547 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
15548 debugging sessions.
15549
15550 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
15551 command @code{set}.
15552
15553 @table @code
15554 @kindex set editing
15555 @cindex editing
15556 @item set editing
15557 @itemx set editing on
15558 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
15559
15560 @item set editing off
15561 Disable command line editing.
15562
15563 @kindex show editing
15564 @item show editing
15565 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
15566 @end table
15567
15568 @xref{Command Line Editing}, for more details about the Readline
15569 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
15570 encouraged to read that chapter.
15571
15572 @node Command History
15573 @section Command History
15574 @cindex command history
15575
15576 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
15577 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
15578 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
15579 history facility.
15580
15581 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
15582 package, to provide the history facility. @xref{Using History
15583 Interactively}, for the detailed description of the History library.
15584
15585 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
15586 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }
15587 (@pxref{Server Prefix}). This
15588 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
15589 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
15590 pressed on a line by itself.
15591
15592 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
15593 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
15594 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
15595 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
15596
15597 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
15598 history.
15599
15600 @table @code
15601 @cindex history substitution
15602 @cindex history file
15603 @kindex set history filename
15604 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
15605 @item set history filename @var{fname}
15606 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
15607 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
15608 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
15609 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
15610 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
15611 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
15612 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
15613 is not set.
15614
15615 @cindex save command history
15616 @kindex set history save
15617 @item set history save
15618 @itemx set history save on
15619 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
15620 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
15621
15622 @item set history save off
15623 Stop recording command history in a file.
15624
15625 @cindex history size
15626 @kindex set history size
15627 @cindex @env{HISTSIZE}, environment variable
15628 @item set history size @var{size}
15629 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
15630 This defaults to the value of the environment variable
15631 @code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set.
15632 @end table
15633
15634 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
15635 @xref{Event Designators}, for more details.
15636
15637 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
15638 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
15639 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
15640 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
15641 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
15642 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
15643 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
15644 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
15645
15646 The commands to control history expansion are:
15647
15648 @table @code
15649 @item set history expansion on
15650 @itemx set history expansion
15651 @kindex set history expansion
15652 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
15653
15654 @item set history expansion off
15655 Disable history expansion.
15656
15657 @c @group
15658 @kindex show history
15659 @item show history
15660 @itemx show history filename
15661 @itemx show history save
15662 @itemx show history size
15663 @itemx show history expansion
15664 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
15665 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
15666 @c @end group
15667 @end table
15668
15669 @table @code
15670 @kindex show commands
15671 @cindex show last commands
15672 @cindex display command history
15673 @item show commands
15674 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
15675
15676 @item show commands @var{n}
15677 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
15678
15679 @item show commands +
15680 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
15681 @end table
15682
15683 @node Screen Size
15684 @section Screen Size
15685 @cindex size of screen
15686 @cindex pauses in output
15687
15688 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
15689 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
15690 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
15691 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
15692 to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
15693 determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
15694 printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
15695 rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
15696
15697 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
15698 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
15699 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
15700 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
15701 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
15702 width} commands:
15703
15704 @table @code
15705 @kindex set height
15706 @kindex set width
15707 @kindex show width
15708 @kindex show height
15709 @item set height @var{lpp}
15710 @itemx show height
15711 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
15712 @itemx show width
15713 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
15714 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
15715 commands display the current settings.
15716
15717 If you specify a height of zero lines, @value{GDBN} does not pause during
15718 output no matter how long the output is. This is useful if output is to a
15719 file or to an editor buffer.
15720
15721 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN}
15722 from wrapping its output.
15723
15724 @item set pagination on
15725 @itemx set pagination off
15726 @kindex set pagination
15727 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
15728 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height 0}.
15729
15730 @item show pagination
15731 @kindex show pagination
15732 Show the current pagination mode.
15733 @end table
15734
15735 @node Numbers
15736 @section Numbers
15737 @cindex number representation
15738 @cindex entering numbers
15739
15740 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
15741 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
15742 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
15743 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
15744 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
15745 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
15746 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
15747 both input and output with the commands described below.
15748
15749 @table @code
15750 @kindex set input-radix
15751 @item set input-radix @var{base}
15752 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
15753 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
15754 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
15755 example, any of
15756
15757 @smallexample
15758 set input-radix 012
15759 set input-radix 10.
15760 set input-radix 0xa
15761 @end smallexample
15762
15763 @noindent
15764 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
15765 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
15766 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
15767 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
15768 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
15769 change the radix.
15770
15771 @kindex set output-radix
15772 @item set output-radix @var{base}
15773 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
15774 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
15775 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
15776
15777 @kindex show input-radix
15778 @item show input-radix
15779 Display the current default base for numeric input.
15780
15781 @kindex show output-radix
15782 @item show output-radix
15783 Display the current default base for numeric display.
15784
15785 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
15786 @itemx show radix
15787 @kindex set radix
15788 @kindex show radix
15789 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
15790 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
15791 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
15792 default value of 10.
15793
15794 @end table
15795
15796 @node ABI
15797 @section Configuring the Current ABI
15798
15799 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
15800 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
15801 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
15802 current ABI.
15803
15804 @cindex OS ABI
15805 @kindex set osabi
15806 @kindex show osabi
15807
15808 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
15809 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
15810 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
15811 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
15812 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
15813 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
15814 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
15815 platform provides.
15816
15817 @table @code
15818 @item show osabi
15819 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
15820
15821 @item set osabi
15822 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
15823
15824 @item set osabi @var{abi}
15825 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
15826 @end table
15827
15828 @cindex float promotion
15829
15830 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
15831 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
15832 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
15833 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
15834 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
15835 @code{double} and then passed.
15836
15837 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
15838 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
15839 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
15840
15841 @table @code
15842 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
15843 @item set coerce-float-to-double
15844 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
15845 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
15846 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
15847
15848 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
15849 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
15850 functions.
15851
15852 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
15853 @item show coerce-float-to-double
15854 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
15855 @end table
15856
15857 @kindex set cp-abi
15858 @kindex show cp-abi
15859 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
15860 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
15861 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
15862 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
15863 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
15864 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
15865 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
15866 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
15867 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
15868 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
15869 ``auto''.
15870
15871 @table @code
15872 @item show cp-abi
15873 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
15874
15875 @item set cp-abi
15876 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
15877
15878 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
15879 @itemx set cp-abi auto
15880 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
15881 @end table
15882
15883 @node Messages/Warnings
15884 @section Optional Warnings and Messages
15885
15886 @cindex verbose operation
15887 @cindex optional warnings
15888 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
15889 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
15890 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
15891 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
15892
15893 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
15894 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
15895 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
15896
15897 @table @code
15898 @kindex set verbose
15899 @item set verbose on
15900 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
15901
15902 @item set verbose off
15903 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
15904
15905 @kindex show verbose
15906 @item show verbose
15907 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
15908 @end table
15909
15910 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
15911 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
15912 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading
15913 Symbol Files}).
15914
15915 @table @code
15916
15917 @kindex set complaints
15918 @item set complaints @var{limit}
15919 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
15920 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
15921 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
15922 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
15923
15924 @kindex show complaints
15925 @item show complaints
15926 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
15927
15928 @end table
15929
15930 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
15931 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
15932 you try to run a program which is already running:
15933
15934 @smallexample
15935 (@value{GDBP}) run
15936 The program being debugged has been started already.
15937 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
15938 @end smallexample
15939
15940 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
15941 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
15942
15943 @table @code
15944
15945 @kindex set confirm
15946 @cindex flinching
15947 @cindex confirmation
15948 @cindex stupid questions
15949 @item set confirm off
15950 Disables confirmation requests.
15951
15952 @item set confirm on
15953 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
15954
15955 @kindex show confirm
15956 @item show confirm
15957 Displays state of confirmation requests.
15958
15959 @end table
15960
15961 @cindex command tracing
15962 If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
15963 useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
15964 printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
15965 quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
15966
15967 @table @code
15968 @kindex set trace-commands
15969 @cindex command scripts, debugging
15970 @item set trace-commands on
15971 Enable command tracing.
15972 @item set trace-commands off
15973 Disable command tracing.
15974 @item show trace-commands
15975 Display the current state of command tracing.
15976 @end table
15977
15978 @node Debugging Output
15979 @section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings
15980 @cindex optional debugging messages
15981
15982 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
15983 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
15984 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
15985 section documents those commands.
15986
15987 @table @code
15988 @kindex set exec-done-display
15989 @item set exec-done-display
15990 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
15991 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
15992 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
15993 @kindex show exec-done-display
15994 @item show exec-done-display
15995 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
15996 notification.
15997 @kindex set debug
15998 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
15999 @cindex architecture debugging info
16000 @item set debug arch
16001 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
16002 @kindex show debug
16003 @item show debug arch
16004 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
16005 @item set debug aix-thread
16006 @cindex AIX threads
16007 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
16008 module.
16009 @item show debug aix-thread
16010 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
16011 @item set debug event
16012 @cindex event debugging info
16013 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
16014 default is off.
16015 @item show debug event
16016 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
16017 info.
16018 @item set debug expression
16019 @cindex expression debugging info
16020 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
16021 expression parsing. The default is off.
16022 @item show debug expression
16023 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
16024 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
16025 @item set debug frame
16026 @cindex frame debugging info
16027 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
16028 default is off.
16029 @item show debug frame
16030 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
16031 info.
16032 @item set debug infrun
16033 @cindex inferior debugging info
16034 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
16035 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
16036 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
16037 @item show debug infrun
16038 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
16039 @item set debug lin-lwp
16040 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
16041 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
16042 Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
16043 @item show debug lin-lwp
16044 Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
16045 @item set debug observer
16046 @cindex observer debugging info
16047 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
16048 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
16049 @item show debug observer
16050 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
16051 @item set debug overload
16052 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
16053 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
16054 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
16055 is off.
16056 @item show debug overload
16057 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
16058 debugging info.
16059 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
16060 @cindex serial connections, debugging
16061 @cindex debug remote protocol
16062 @cindex remote protocol debugging
16063 @cindex display remote packets
16064 @item set debug remote
16065 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
16066 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
16067 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
16068 @item show debug remote
16069 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
16070 @item set debug serial
16071 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
16072 default is off.
16073 @item show debug serial
16074 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
16075 info.
16076 @item set debug solib-frv
16077 @cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
16078 Turns on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
16079 @item show debug solib-frv
16080 Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
16081 messages.
16082 @item set debug target
16083 @cindex target debugging info
16084 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
16085 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
16086 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
16087 value of large memory transfers. Changes to this flag do not take effect
16088 until the next time you connect to a target or use the @code{run} command.
16089 @item show debug target
16090 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
16091 info.
16092 @item set debugvarobj
16093 @cindex variable object debugging info
16094 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
16095 info. The default is off.
16096 @item show debugvarobj
16097 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
16098 debugging info.
16099 @item set debug xml
16100 @cindex XML parser debugging
16101 Turns on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
16102 @item show debug xml
16103 Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
16104 @end table
16105
16106 @node Sequences
16107 @chapter Canned Sequences of Commands
16108
16109 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
16110 Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
16111 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
16112 files.
16113
16114 @menu
16115 * Define:: How to define your own commands
16116 * Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
16117 * Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
16118 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
16119 @end menu
16120
16121 @node Define
16122 @section User-defined Commands
16123
16124 @cindex user-defined command
16125 @cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
16126 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
16127 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
16128 @code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
16129 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
16130 via @code{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
16131
16132 @smallexample
16133 define adder
16134 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
16135 end
16136 @end smallexample
16137
16138 @noindent
16139 To execute the command use:
16140
16141 @smallexample
16142 adder 1 2 3
16143 @end smallexample
16144
16145 @noindent
16146 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
16147 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
16148 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
16149 functions calls.
16150
16151 @cindex argument count in user-defined commands
16152 @cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
16153 In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
16154 been passed. This expands to a number in the range 0@dots{}10.
16155
16156 @smallexample
16157 define adder
16158 if $argc == 2
16159 print $arg0 + $arg1
16160 end
16161 if $argc == 3
16162 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
16163 end
16164 end
16165 @end smallexample
16166
16167 @table @code
16168
16169 @kindex define
16170 @item define @var{commandname}
16171 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
16172 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
16173
16174 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
16175 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
16176 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
16177
16178 @kindex document
16179 @kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
16180 @item document @var{commandname}
16181 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
16182 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
16183 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
16184 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
16185 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
16186 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
16187
16188 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
16189 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
16190 does not change the documentation.
16191
16192 @kindex dont-repeat
16193 @cindex don't repeat command
16194 @item dont-repeat
16195 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
16196 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
16197 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
16198
16199 @kindex help user-defined
16200 @item help user-defined
16201 List all user-defined commands, with the first line of the documentation
16202 (if any) for each.
16203
16204 @kindex show user
16205 @item show user
16206 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
16207 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
16208 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
16209 definitions for all user-defined commands.
16210
16211 @cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
16212 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
16213 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
16214 @item show max-user-call-depth
16215 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
16216 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
16217 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an
16218 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
16219 @end table
16220
16221 In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
16222 use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
16223
16224 When user-defined commands are executed, the
16225 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
16226 stops execution of the user-defined command.
16227
16228 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
16229 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
16230 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
16231 messages when used in a user-defined command.
16232
16233 @node Hooks
16234 @section User-defined Command Hooks
16235 @cindex command hooks
16236 @cindex hooks, for commands
16237 @cindex hooks, pre-command
16238
16239 @kindex hook
16240 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
16241 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
16242 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
16243 before that command.
16244
16245 @cindex hooks, post-command
16246 @kindex hookpost
16247 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
16248 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
16249 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
16250 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
16251 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
16252
16253 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
16254 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
16255
16256 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
16257 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
16258
16259 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
16260 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
16261 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
16262 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
16263 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
16264
16265 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
16266 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
16267 you could define:
16268
16269 @smallexample
16270 define hook-stop
16271 handle SIGALRM nopass
16272 end
16273
16274 define hook-run
16275 handle SIGALRM pass
16276 end
16277
16278 define hook-continue
16279 handle SIGALRM pass
16280 end
16281 @end smallexample
16282
16283 As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo}
16284 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
16285 you could define:
16286
16287 @smallexample
16288 define hook-echo
16289 echo <<<---
16290 end
16291
16292 define hookpost-echo
16293 echo --->>>\n
16294 end
16295
16296 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
16297 <<<---Hello World--->>>
16298 (@value{GDBP})
16299
16300 @end smallexample
16301
16302 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
16303 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
16304 name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
16305 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
16306 @c or not?
16307 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
16308 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
16309 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
16310
16311 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
16312 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
16313
16314 @node Command Files
16315 @section Command Files
16316
16317 @cindex command files
16318 @cindex scripting commands
16319 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
16320 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
16321 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
16322 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
16323 terminal.
16324
16325 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
16326 command:
16327
16328 @table @code
16329 @kindex source
16330 @cindex execute commands from a file
16331 @item source [@code{-v}] @var{filename}
16332 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
16333 @end table
16334
16335 The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
16336 unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
16337 @emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
16338 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
16339 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
16340
16341 @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename} in the current directory and then
16342 on the search path (specified with the @samp{directory} command).
16343
16344 If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
16345 each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
16346 @var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
16347
16348 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
16349 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
16350 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
16351 when called from command files.
16352
16353 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
16354 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
16355 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
16356 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
16357 the next command.
16358
16359 @smallexample
16360 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
16361 @end smallexample
16362
16363 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
16364 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
16365 would be directed to @file{log}.
16366
16367 Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
16368 commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
16369 complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
16370 variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
16371 built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
16372 deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
16373 complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
16374 conditionally, etc.
16375
16376 @table @code
16377 @kindex if
16378 @kindex else
16379 @item if
16380 @itemx else
16381 This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
16382 commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
16383 expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
16384 are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
16385 There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
16386 of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
16387 end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
16388
16389 @kindex while
16390 @item while
16391 This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
16392 @code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
16393 to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
16394 line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
16395 @dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
16396 executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
16397
16398 @kindex loop_break
16399 @item loop_break
16400 This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
16401 Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
16402 line.
16403
16404 @kindex loop_continue
16405 @item loop_continue
16406 This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
16407 in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
16408 branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
16409 the controlling expression.
16410
16411 @kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
16412 @item end
16413 Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
16414 @code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
16415 @end table
16416
16417
16418 @node Output
16419 @section Commands for Controlled Output
16420
16421 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
16422 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
16423 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
16424 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
16425 want.
16426
16427 @table @code
16428 @kindex echo
16429 @item echo @var{text}
16430 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
16431 @c because it is not in ANSI.
16432 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
16433 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
16434 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
16435 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
16436 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
16437 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
16438 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
16439 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
16440 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
16441
16442 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
16443 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
16444
16445 @smallexample
16446 echo This is some text\n\
16447 which is continued\n\
16448 onto several lines.\n
16449 @end smallexample
16450
16451 produces the same output as
16452
16453 @smallexample
16454 echo This is some text\n
16455 echo which is continued\n
16456 echo onto several lines.\n
16457 @end smallexample
16458
16459 @kindex output
16460 @item output @var{expression}
16461 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
16462 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
16463 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
16464 on expressions.
16465
16466 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
16467 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
16468 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
16469 Formats}, for more information.
16470
16471 @kindex printf
16472 @item printf @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
16473 Print the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
16474 the string @var{template}. To print several values, make
16475 @var{expressions} be a comma-separated list of individual expressions,
16476 which may be either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as
16477 specified by @var{template}, exactly as a C program would do by
16478 executing the code below:
16479
16480 @smallexample
16481 printf (@var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
16482 @end smallexample
16483
16484 As in @code{C} @code{printf}, ordinary characters in @var{template}
16485 are printed verbatim, while @dfn{conversion specification} introduced
16486 by the @samp{%} character cause subsequent @var{expressions} to be
16487 evaluated, their values converted and formatted according to type and
16488 style information encoded in the conversion specifications, and then
16489 printed.
16490
16491 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
16492
16493 @smallexample
16494 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
16495 @end smallexample
16496
16497 @code{printf} supports all the standard @code{C} conversion
16498 specifications, including the flags and modifiers between the @samp{%}
16499 character and the conversion letter, with the following exceptions:
16500
16501 @itemize @bullet
16502 @item
16503 The argument-ordering modifiers, such as @samp{2$}, are not supported.
16504
16505 @item
16506 The modifier @samp{*} is not supported for specifying precision or
16507 width.
16508
16509 @item
16510 The @samp{'} flag (for separation of digits into groups according to
16511 @code{LC_NUMERIC'}) is not supported.
16512
16513 @item
16514 The type modifiers @samp{hh}, @samp{j}, @samp{t}, and @samp{z} are not
16515 supported.
16516
16517 @item
16518 The conversion letter @samp{n} (as in @samp{%n}) is not supported.
16519
16520 @item
16521 The conversion letters @samp{a} and @samp{A} are not supported.
16522 @end itemize
16523
16524 @noindent
16525 Note that the @samp{ll} type modifier is supported only if the
16526 underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} supports
16527 the @code{long long int} type, and the @samp{L} type modifier is
16528 supported only if @code{long double} type is available.
16529
16530 As in @code{C}, @code{printf} supports simple backslash-escape
16531 sequences, such as @code{\n}, @samp{\t}, @samp{\\}, @samp{\"},
16532 @samp{\a}, and @samp{\f}, that consist of backslash followed by a
16533 single character. Octal and hexadecimal escape sequences are not
16534 supported.
16535 @end table
16536
16537 @node Interpreters
16538 @chapter Command Interpreters
16539 @cindex command interpreters
16540
16541 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
16542 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
16543 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
16544
16545 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
16546 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
16547 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
16548 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
16549
16550 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
16551 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
16552 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
16553 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
16554
16555 @table @code
16556 @item console
16557 @cindex console interpreter
16558 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
16559 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
16560 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
16561
16562 @item mi
16563 @cindex mi interpreter
16564 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
16565 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
16566 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
16567 Interface}.
16568
16569 @item mi2
16570 @cindex mi2 interpreter
16571 The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
16572
16573 @item mi1
16574 @cindex mi1 interpreter
16575 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
16576
16577 @end table
16578
16579 @cindex invoke another interpreter
16580 The interpreter being used by @value{GDBN} may not be dynamically
16581 switched at runtime. Although possible, this could lead to a very
16582 precarious situation. Consider an IDE using @sc{gdb/mi}. If a user
16583 enters the command "interpreter-set console" in a console view,
16584 @value{GDBN} would switch to using the console interpreter, rendering
16585 the IDE inoperable!
16586
16587 @kindex interpreter-exec
16588 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, you may execute
16589 commands in any interpreter from the current interpreter using the appropriate
16590 command. If you are running the console interpreter, simply use the
16591 @code{interpreter-exec} command:
16592
16593 @smallexample
16594 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
16595 @end smallexample
16596
16597 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
16598 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
16599
16600 @node TUI
16601 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
16602 @cindex TUI
16603 @cindex Text User Interface
16604
16605 @menu
16606 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
16607 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
16608 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
16609 * TUI Commands:: TUI-specific commands
16610 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
16611 @end menu
16612
16613 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface (TUI) is a terminal
16614 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
16615 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
16616 commands in separate text windows. The TUI mode is supported only
16617 on platforms where a suitable version of the @code{curses} library
16618 is available.
16619
16620 @pindex @value{GDBTUI}
16621 The TUI mode is enabled by default when you invoke @value{GDBN} as
16622 either @samp{@value{GDBTUI}} or @samp{@value{GDBP} -tui}.
16623 You can also switch in and out of TUI mode while @value{GDBN} runs by
16624 using various TUI commands and key bindings, such as @kbd{C-x C-a}.
16625 @xref{TUI Keys, ,TUI Key Bindings}.
16626
16627 @node TUI Overview
16628 @section TUI Overview
16629
16630 In TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text windows:
16631
16632 @table @emph
16633 @item command
16634 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
16635 prompt and the @value{GDBN} output. The @value{GDBN} input is still
16636 managed using readline.
16637
16638 @item source
16639 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
16640 line and active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
16641
16642 @item assembly
16643 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
16644
16645 @item register
16646 This window shows the processor registers. Registers are highlighted
16647 when their values change.
16648 @end table
16649
16650 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
16651 by highlighting the current line and marking it with a @samp{>} marker.
16652 Breakpoints are indicated with two markers. The first marker
16653 indicates the breakpoint type:
16654
16655 @table @code
16656 @item B
16657 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
16658
16659 @item b
16660 Breakpoint which was never hit.
16661
16662 @item H
16663 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
16664
16665 @item h
16666 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
16667 @end table
16668
16669 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
16670
16671 @table @code
16672 @item +
16673 Breakpoint is enabled.
16674
16675 @item -
16676 Breakpoint is disabled.
16677 @end table
16678
16679 The source, assembly and register windows are updated when the current
16680 thread changes, when the frame changes, or when the program counter
16681 changes.
16682
16683 These windows are not all visible at the same time. The command
16684 window is always visible. The others can be arranged in several
16685 layouts:
16686
16687 @itemize @bullet
16688 @item
16689 source only,
16690
16691 @item
16692 assembly only,
16693
16694 @item
16695 source and assembly,
16696
16697 @item
16698 source and registers, or
16699
16700 @item
16701 assembly and registers.
16702 @end itemize
16703
16704 A status line above the command window shows the following information:
16705
16706 @table @emph
16707 @item target
16708 Indicates the current @value{GDBN} target.
16709 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
16710
16711 @item process
16712 Gives the current process or thread number.
16713 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
16714
16715 @item function
16716 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
16717 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
16718 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter,
16719 the string @code{??} is displayed.
16720
16721 @item line
16722 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
16723 When the current line number is not known, the string @code{??} is displayed.
16724
16725 @item pc
16726 Indicates the current program counter address.
16727 @end table
16728
16729 @node TUI Keys
16730 @section TUI Key Bindings
16731 @cindex TUI key bindings
16732
16733 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
16734 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}). The following key bindings
16735 are installed for both TUI mode and the @value{GDBN} standard mode.
16736
16737 @table @kbd
16738 @kindex C-x C-a
16739 @item C-x C-a
16740 @kindex C-x a
16741 @itemx C-x a
16742 @kindex C-x A
16743 @itemx C-x A
16744 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When leaving the TUI mode,
16745 the curses window management stops and @value{GDBN} operates using
16746 its standard mode, writing on the terminal directly. When reentering
16747 the TUI mode, control is given back to the curses windows.
16748 The screen is then refreshed.
16749
16750 @kindex C-x 1
16751 @item C-x 1
16752 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
16753 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
16754 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
16755
16756 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
16757
16758 @kindex C-x 2
16759 @item C-x 2
16760 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
16761 layout already has two windows, the next layout with two windows is used.
16762 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
16763 previous layout and the new one.
16764
16765 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
16766
16767 @kindex C-x o
16768 @item C-x o
16769 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
16770 (like scrolling and arrow keys) with the active window. This command
16771 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
16772
16773 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
16774
16775 @kindex C-x s
16776 @item C-x s
16777 Switch in and out of the TUI SingleKey mode that binds single
16778 keys to @value{GDBN} commands (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
16779 @end table
16780
16781 The following key bindings only work in the TUI mode:
16782
16783 @table @asis
16784 @kindex PgUp
16785 @item @key{PgUp}
16786 Scroll the active window one page up.
16787
16788 @kindex PgDn
16789 @item @key{PgDn}
16790 Scroll the active window one page down.
16791
16792 @kindex Up
16793 @item @key{Up}
16794 Scroll the active window one line up.
16795
16796 @kindex Down
16797 @item @key{Down}
16798 Scroll the active window one line down.
16799
16800 @kindex Left
16801 @item @key{Left}
16802 Scroll the active window one column left.
16803
16804 @kindex Right
16805 @item @key{Right}
16806 Scroll the active window one column right.
16807
16808 @kindex C-L
16809 @item @kbd{C-L}
16810 Refresh the screen.
16811 @end table
16812
16813 Because the arrow keys scroll the active window in the TUI mode, they
16814 are not available for their normal use by readline unless the command
16815 window has the focus. When another window is active, you must use
16816 other readline key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b}
16817 and @kbd{C-f} to control the command window.
16818
16819 @node TUI Single Key Mode
16820 @section TUI Single Key Mode
16821 @cindex TUI single key mode
16822
16823 The TUI also provides a @dfn{SingleKey} mode, which binds several
16824 frequently used @value{GDBN} commands to single keys. Type @kbd{C-x s} to
16825 switch into this mode, where the following key bindings are used:
16826
16827 @table @kbd
16828 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16829 @item c
16830 continue
16831
16832 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16833 @item d
16834 down
16835
16836 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16837 @item f
16838 finish
16839
16840 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16841 @item n
16842 next
16843
16844 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16845 @item q
16846 exit the SingleKey mode.
16847
16848 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16849 @item r
16850 run
16851
16852 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16853 @item s
16854 step
16855
16856 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16857 @item u
16858 up
16859
16860 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16861 @item v
16862 info locals
16863
16864 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16865 @item w
16866 where
16867 @end table
16868
16869 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
16870 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
16871 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
16872 with the TUI SingleKey mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
16873 SingleKey mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
16874 this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
16875
16876
16877 @node TUI Commands
16878 @section TUI-specific Commands
16879 @cindex TUI commands
16880
16881 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
16882 These commands are always available, even when @value{GDBN} is not in
16883 the TUI mode. When @value{GDBN} is in the standard mode, most
16884 of these commands will automatically switch to the TUI mode.
16885
16886 @table @code
16887 @item info win
16888 @kindex info win
16889 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
16890
16891 @item layout next
16892 @kindex layout
16893 Display the next layout.
16894
16895 @item layout prev
16896 Display the previous layout.
16897
16898 @item layout src
16899 Display the source window only.
16900
16901 @item layout asm
16902 Display the assembly window only.
16903
16904 @item layout split
16905 Display the source and assembly window.
16906
16907 @item layout regs
16908 Display the register window together with the source or assembly window.
16909
16910 @item focus next
16911 @kindex focus
16912 Make the next window active for scrolling.
16913
16914 @item focus prev
16915 Make the previous window active for scrolling.
16916
16917 @item focus src
16918 Make the source window active for scrolling.
16919
16920 @item focus asm
16921 Make the assembly window active for scrolling.
16922
16923 @item focus regs
16924 Make the register window active for scrolling.
16925
16926 @item focus cmd
16927 Make the command window active for scrolling.
16928
16929 @item refresh
16930 @kindex refresh
16931 Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
16932
16933 @item tui reg float
16934 @kindex tui reg
16935 Show the floating point registers in the register window.
16936
16937 @item tui reg general
16938 Show the general registers in the register window.
16939
16940 @item tui reg next
16941 Show the next register group. The list of register groups as well as
16942 their order is target specific. The predefined register groups are the
16943 following: @code{general}, @code{float}, @code{system}, @code{vector},
16944 @code{all}, @code{save}, @code{restore}.
16945
16946 @item tui reg system
16947 Show the system registers in the register window.
16948
16949 @item update
16950 @kindex update
16951 Update the source window and the current execution point.
16952
16953 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
16954 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
16955 @kindex winheight
16956 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
16957 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
16958 decrease it.
16959
16960 @item tabset @var{nchars}
16961 @kindex tabset
16962 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters.
16963 @end table
16964
16965 @node TUI Configuration
16966 @section TUI Configuration Variables
16967 @cindex TUI configuration variables
16968
16969 Several configuration variables control the appearance of TUI windows.
16970
16971 @table @code
16972 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
16973 @kindex set tui border-kind
16974 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
16975 The possible values are the following:
16976 @table @code
16977 @item space
16978 Use a space character to draw the border.
16979
16980 @item ascii
16981 Use @sc{ascii} characters @samp{+}, @samp{-} and @samp{|} to draw the border.
16982
16983 @item acs
16984 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
16985 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
16986 @end table
16987
16988 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
16989 @kindex set tui border-mode
16990 @itemx set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
16991 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
16992 Select the display attributes for the borders of the inactive windows
16993 or the active window. The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
16994 @table @code
16995 @item normal
16996 Use normal attributes to display the border.
16997
16998 @item standout
16999 Use standout mode.
17000
17001 @item reverse
17002 Use reverse video mode.
17003
17004 @item half
17005 Use half bright mode.
17006
17007 @item half-standout
17008 Use half bright and standout mode.
17009
17010 @item bold
17011 Use extra bright or bold mode.
17012
17013 @item bold-standout
17014 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
17015 @end table
17016 @end table
17017
17018 @node Emacs
17019 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
17020
17021 @cindex Emacs
17022 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
17023 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
17024 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
17025 @value{GDBN}.
17026
17027 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
17028 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
17029 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
17030 created Emacs buffer.
17031 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
17032
17033 Running @value{GDBN} under Emacs can be just like running @value{GDBN} normally except for two
17034 things:
17035
17036 @itemize @bullet
17037 @item
17038 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through an Emacs buffer, called
17039 the GUD buffer.
17040
17041 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
17042 and output done by the program you are debugging.
17043
17044 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
17045 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
17046 in this way.
17047
17048 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
17049 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
17050 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
17051 stop.
17052
17053 @item
17054 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
17055
17056 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
17057 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
17058 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
17059 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
17060 and the source.
17061
17062 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
17063 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
17064 @end itemize
17065
17066 We call this @dfn{text command mode}. Emacs 22.1, and later, also uses
17067 a graphical mode, enabled by default, which provides further buffers
17068 that can control the execution and describe the state of your program.
17069 @xref{GDB Graphical Interface,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}.
17070
17071 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
17072 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
17073 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
17074 sets your current working directory to to the directory associated
17075 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
17076 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
17077 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
17078 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
17079 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
17080
17081 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
17082 line of the GUD buffer and this serves as a default for the commands
17083 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files,
17084 ,Commands to Specify Files}.
17085
17086 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
17087 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
17088 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
17089 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
17090 one you want.
17091
17092 In the GUD buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
17093 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
17094
17095 @table @kbd
17096 @item C-h m
17097 Describe the features of Emacs' GUD Mode.
17098
17099 @item C-c C-s
17100 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
17101 update the display window to show the current file and location.
17102
17103 @item C-c C-n
17104 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
17105 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
17106 to show the current file and location.
17107
17108 @item C-c C-i
17109 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
17110 display window accordingly.
17111
17112 @item C-c C-f
17113 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
17114 @code{finish} command.
17115
17116 @item C-c C-r
17117 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
17118 command.
17119
17120 @item C-c <
17121 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
17122 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
17123 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
17124
17125 @item C-c >
17126 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
17127 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
17128 @end table
17129
17130 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
17131 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
17132
17133 In text command mode, if you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, Emacs displays a
17134 separate frame which shows a backtrace when the GUD buffer is current.
17135 Move point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it
17136 become the current frame and display the associated source in the
17137 source buffer. Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the
17138 selected frame become the current one. In graphical mode, the
17139 speedbar displays watch expressions.
17140
17141 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
17142 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
17143 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
17144 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
17145 frame.
17146
17147 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
17148 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
17149 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
17150 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
17151 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
17152 to correspond properly with the code.
17153
17154 A more detailed description of Emacs' interaction with @value{GDBN} is
17155 given in the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu}
17156 Emacs Manual}).
17157
17158 @c The following dropped because Epoch is nonstandard. Reactivate
17159 @c if/when v19 does something similar. ---doc@cygnus.com 19dec1990
17160 @ignore
17161 @kindex Emacs Epoch environment
17162 @kindex Epoch
17163 @kindex inspect
17164
17165 Version 18 of @sc{gnu} Emacs has a built-in window system
17166 called the @code{epoch}
17167 environment. Users of this environment can use a new command,
17168 @code{inspect} which performs identically to @code{print} except that
17169 each value is printed in its own window.
17170 @end ignore
17171
17172
17173 @node GDB/MI
17174 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
17175
17176 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
17177
17178 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
17179 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
17180 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
17181 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
17182 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
17183 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
17184
17185 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
17186 in the form of a reference manual.
17187
17188 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
17189 features described below are incomplete and subject to change
17190 (@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
17191
17192 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
17193
17194 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
17195 This chapter uses the following notation:
17196
17197 @itemize @bullet
17198 @item
17199 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
17200
17201 @item
17202 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
17203 it may or may not be given.
17204
17205 @item
17206 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
17207 may repeat zero or more times.
17208
17209 @item
17210 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
17211 may repeat one or more times.
17212
17213 @item
17214 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
17215 @end itemize
17216
17217 @ignore
17218 @heading Dependencies
17219 @end ignore
17220
17221 @menu
17222 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
17223 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
17224 * GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
17225 * GDB/MI Output Records::
17226 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
17227 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
17228 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
17229 * GDB/MI Program Context::
17230 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
17231 * GDB/MI Program Execution::
17232 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
17233 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
17234 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
17235 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
17236 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
17237 * GDB/MI File Commands::
17238 @ignore
17239 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
17240 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
17241 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
17242 @end ignore
17243 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
17244 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
17245 @end menu
17246
17247 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17248 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
17249 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
17250
17251 @menu
17252 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
17253 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
17254 @end menu
17255
17256 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
17257 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
17258
17259 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
17260 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
17261 @table @code
17262 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
17263 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
17264
17265 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
17266 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
17267 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
17268
17269 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
17270 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
17271 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
17272
17273 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
17274 "any sequence of digits"
17275
17276 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
17277 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
17278
17279 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
17280 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
17281
17282 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
17283 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
17284
17285 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
17286 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
17287 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
17288
17289 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
17290 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
17291
17292 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
17293 @code{CR | CR-LF}
17294 @end table
17295
17296 @noindent
17297 Notes:
17298
17299 @itemize @bullet
17300 @item
17301 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
17302 output is described below.
17303
17304 @item
17305 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
17306 finishes.
17307
17308 @item
17309 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
17310 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
17311 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
17312 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
17313 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
17314 @end itemize
17315
17316 Pragmatics:
17317
17318 @itemize @bullet
17319 @item
17320 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
17321
17322 @item
17323 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
17324 @end itemize
17325
17326 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
17327 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
17328
17329 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
17330 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
17331 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
17332 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
17333 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
17334 terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
17335
17336 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
17337 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
17338 @var{token}.
17339
17340 @table @code
17341 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
17342 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
17343
17344 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
17345 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
17346
17347 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
17348 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
17349
17350 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
17351 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
17352
17353 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
17354 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output}}
17355
17356 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
17357 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output}}
17358
17359 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
17360 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output}}
17361
17362 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
17363 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
17364
17365 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
17366 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
17367
17368 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
17369 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
17370 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
17371
17372 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
17373 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
17374
17375 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
17376 @code{ @var{string} }
17377
17378 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
17379 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
17380
17381 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
17382 @code{@var{c-string}}
17383
17384 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
17385 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
17386
17387 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
17388 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
17389 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
17390
17391 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
17392 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
17393
17394 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
17395 @code{"~" @var{c-string}}
17396
17397 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
17398 @code{"@@" @var{c-string}}
17399
17400 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
17401 @code{"&" @var{c-string}}
17402
17403 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
17404 @code{CR | CR-LF}
17405
17406 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
17407 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
17408 @end table
17409
17410 @noindent
17411 Notes:
17412
17413 @itemize @bullet
17414 @item
17415 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
17416
17417 @item
17418 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. If an execution
17419 command is interrupted by the @samp{-exec-interrupt} command, the
17420 @var{token} associated with the @samp{*stopped} message is the one of the
17421 original execution command, not the one of the interrupt command.
17422
17423 @item
17424 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17425 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
17426 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
17427 prefixed by @samp{+}.
17428
17429 @item
17430 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17431 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
17432 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
17433 @samp{*}.
17434
17435 @item
17436 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17437 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
17438 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
17439 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
17440
17441 @item
17442 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17443 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
17444 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
17445 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
17446
17447 @item
17448 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17449 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
17450 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
17451
17452 @item
17453 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17454 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
17455 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
17456 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
17457
17458 @item
17459 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17460 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
17461 @var{values}.
17462
17463
17464 @end itemize
17465
17466 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
17467 details about the various output records.
17468
17469 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17470 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
17471 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
17472
17473 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
17474 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
17475
17476 For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
17477 but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
17478 that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
17479 command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
17480 @code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
17481 @samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
17482
17483 This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
17484 recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
17485 (@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
17486
17487 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17488 @node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
17489 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
17490 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
17491
17492 The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
17493 program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
17494
17495 Although @sc{gdb/mi} is still incomplete, it is currently being used
17496 by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}. This makes it difficult
17497 to introduce new functionality without breaking existing usage. This
17498 section tries to minimize the problems by describing how the protocol
17499 might change.
17500
17501 Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
17502 for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
17503 list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
17504 parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
17505
17506 @itemize @bullet
17507 @item
17508 New MI commands may be added.
17509
17510 @item
17511 New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
17512
17513 @item
17514 The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g.,
17515 @code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended.
17516
17517 @c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
17518 @c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
17519
17520 @c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
17521 @c resolve inconsistencies.
17522 @end itemize
17523
17524 If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
17525 will be increased by one. This will allow the front end to parse the
17526 output according to the MI version. Apart from mi0, new versions of
17527 @value{GDBN} will not support old versions of MI and it will be the
17528 responsibility of the front end to work with the new one.
17529
17530 @c Starting with mi3, add a new command -mi-version that prints the MI
17531 @c version?
17532
17533 The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
17534 end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
17535 follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
17536 @email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}. There is also the mailing list
17537 @email{dmi-discuss@@lists.freestandards.org}, hosted by the Free Standards
17538 Group, which has the aim of creating a more general MI protocol
17539 called Debugger Machine Interface (DMI) that will become a standard
17540 for all debuggers, not just @value{GDBN}.
17541 @cindex mailing lists
17542
17543 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17544 @node GDB/MI Output Records
17545 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
17546
17547 @menu
17548 * GDB/MI Result Records::
17549 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
17550 * GDB/MI Out-of-band Records::
17551 @end menu
17552
17553 @node GDB/MI Result Records
17554 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
17555
17556 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
17557 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
17558 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
17559 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
17560
17561 @table @code
17562 @findex ^done
17563 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
17564 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
17565 values.
17566
17567 @item "^running"
17568 @findex ^running
17569 @c Is this one correct? Should it be an out-of-band notification?
17570 The asynchronous operation was successfully started. The target is
17571 running.
17572
17573 @item "^connected"
17574 @findex ^connected
17575 @value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target.
17576
17577 @item "^error" "," @var{c-string}
17578 @findex ^error
17579 The operation failed. The @code{@var{c-string}} contains the corresponding
17580 error message.
17581
17582 @item "^exit"
17583 @findex ^exit
17584 @value{GDBN} has terminated.
17585
17586 @end table
17587
17588 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
17589 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
17590
17591 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
17592 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
17593 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
17594 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
17595 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
17596
17597 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
17598 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
17599 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
17600 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
17601 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
17602
17603 @table @code
17604 @item "~" @var{string-output}
17605 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
17606 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
17607
17608 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
17609 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
17610 target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
17611 asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
17612
17613 @item "&" @var{string-output}
17614 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
17615 internals.
17616 @end table
17617
17618 @node GDB/MI Out-of-band Records
17619 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Out-of-band Records
17620
17621 @cindex out-of-band records in @sc{gdb/mi}
17622 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, out-of-band records
17623 @dfn{Out-of-band} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
17624 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
17625 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
17626 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
17627
17628 The following is a preliminary list of possible out-of-band records.
17629 In particular, the @var{exec-async-output} records.
17630
17631 @table @code
17632 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}"
17633 @end table
17634
17635 @var{reason} can be one of the following:
17636
17637 @table @code
17638 @item breakpoint-hit
17639 A breakpoint was reached.
17640 @item watchpoint-trigger
17641 A watchpoint was triggered.
17642 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
17643 A read watchpoint was triggered.
17644 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
17645 An access watchpoint was triggered.
17646 @item function-finished
17647 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
17648 @item location-reached
17649 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
17650 @item watchpoint-scope
17651 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
17652 @item end-stepping-range
17653 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
17654 similar CLI command was accomplished.
17655 @item exited-signalled
17656 The inferior exited because of a signal.
17657 @item exited
17658 The inferior exited.
17659 @item exited-normally
17660 The inferior exited normally.
17661 @item signal-received
17662 A signal was received by the inferior.
17663 @end table
17664
17665
17666 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17667 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
17668 @section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
17669 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
17670
17671 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
17672 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
17673 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
17674 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
17675
17676 Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
17677 readability, they don't appear in the real output.
17678
17679 @subheading Setting a Breakpoint
17680
17681 Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
17682 information of the breakpoint.
17683
17684 @smallexample
17685 -> -break-insert main
17686 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
17687 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
17688 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",times="0"@}
17689 <- (gdb)
17690 @end smallexample
17691
17692 @subheading Program Execution
17693
17694 Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
17695 reason that execution stopped.
17696
17697 @smallexample
17698 -> -exec-run
17699 <- ^running
17700 <- (gdb)
17701 <- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
17702 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
17703 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
17704 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68"@}
17705 <- (gdb)
17706 -> -exec-continue
17707 <- ^running
17708 <- (gdb)
17709 <- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
17710 <- (gdb)
17711 @end smallexample
17712
17713 @subheading Quitting @value{GDBN}
17714
17715 Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
17716
17717 @smallexample
17718 -> (gdb)
17719 <- -gdb-exit
17720 <- ^exit
17721 @end smallexample
17722
17723 @subheading A Bad Command
17724
17725 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
17726
17727 @smallexample
17728 -> -rubbish
17729 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
17730 <- (gdb)
17731 @end smallexample
17732
17733
17734 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17735 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
17736 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
17737
17738 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
17739 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
17740
17741 @subheading Motivation
17742
17743 The motivation for this collection of commands.
17744
17745 @subheading Introduction
17746
17747 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
17748
17749 @subheading Commands
17750
17751 For each command in the block, the following is described:
17752
17753 @subsubheading Synopsis
17754
17755 @smallexample
17756 -command @var{args}@dots{}
17757 @end smallexample
17758
17759 @subsubheading Result
17760
17761 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17762
17763 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
17764
17765 @subsubheading Example
17766
17767 Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
17768 not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
17769
17770
17771 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17772 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
17773 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
17774
17775 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
17776 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
17777 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
17778 breakpoints.
17779
17780 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
17781 @findex -break-after
17782
17783 @subsubheading Synopsis
17784
17785 @smallexample
17786 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
17787 @end smallexample
17788
17789 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
17790 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
17791 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
17792 @samp{-break-list} command below.
17793
17794 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17795
17796 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
17797
17798 @subsubheading Example
17799
17800 @smallexample
17801 (gdb)
17802 -break-insert main
17803 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x000100d0",file="hello.c",
17804 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",times="0"@}
17805 (gdb)
17806 -break-after 1 3
17807 ~
17808 ^done
17809 (gdb)
17810 -break-list
17811 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
17812 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
17813 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
17814 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
17815 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
17816 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
17817 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
17818 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
17819 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
17820 line="5",times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
17821 (gdb)
17822 @end smallexample
17823
17824 @ignore
17825 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
17826 @findex -break-catch
17827
17828 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
17829 @findex -break-commands
17830 @end ignore
17831
17832
17833 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
17834 @findex -break-condition
17835
17836 @subsubheading Synopsis
17837
17838 @smallexample
17839 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
17840 @end smallexample
17841
17842 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
17843 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
17844 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
17845 command below).
17846
17847 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17848
17849 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
17850
17851 @subsubheading Example
17852
17853 @smallexample
17854 (gdb)
17855 -break-condition 1 1
17856 ^done
17857 (gdb)
17858 -break-list
17859 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
17860 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
17861 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
17862 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
17863 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
17864 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
17865 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
17866 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
17867 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
17868 line="5",cond="1",times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
17869 (gdb)
17870 @end smallexample
17871
17872 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
17873 @findex -break-delete
17874
17875 @subsubheading Synopsis
17876
17877 @smallexample
17878 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
17879 @end smallexample
17880
17881 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
17882 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
17883
17884 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17885
17886 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
17887
17888 @subsubheading Example
17889
17890 @smallexample
17891 (gdb)
17892 -break-delete 1
17893 ^done
17894 (gdb)
17895 -break-list
17896 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
17897 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
17898 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
17899 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
17900 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
17901 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
17902 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
17903 body=[]@}
17904 (gdb)
17905 @end smallexample
17906
17907 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
17908 @findex -break-disable
17909
17910 @subsubheading Synopsis
17911
17912 @smallexample
17913 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
17914 @end smallexample
17915
17916 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
17917 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
17918
17919 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17920
17921 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
17922
17923 @subsubheading Example
17924
17925 @smallexample
17926 (gdb)
17927 -break-disable 2
17928 ^done
17929 (gdb)
17930 -break-list
17931 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
17932 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
17933 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
17934 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
17935 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
17936 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
17937 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
17938 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
17939 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
17940 line="5",times="0"@}]@}
17941 (gdb)
17942 @end smallexample
17943
17944 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
17945 @findex -break-enable
17946
17947 @subsubheading Synopsis
17948
17949 @smallexample
17950 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
17951 @end smallexample
17952
17953 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
17954
17955 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17956
17957 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
17958
17959 @subsubheading Example
17960
17961 @smallexample
17962 (gdb)
17963 -break-enable 2
17964 ^done
17965 (gdb)
17966 -break-list
17967 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
17968 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
17969 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
17970 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
17971 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
17972 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
17973 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
17974 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
17975 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
17976 line="5",times="0"@}]@}
17977 (gdb)
17978 @end smallexample
17979
17980 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
17981 @findex -break-info
17982
17983 @subsubheading Synopsis
17984
17985 @smallexample
17986 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
17987 @end smallexample
17988
17989 @c REDUNDANT???
17990 Get information about a single breakpoint.
17991
17992 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17993
17994 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
17995
17996 @subsubheading Example
17997 N.A.
17998
17999 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
18000 @findex -break-insert
18001
18002 @subsubheading Synopsis
18003
18004 @smallexample
18005 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -r ]
18006 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
18007 [ -p @var{thread} ] [ @var{line} | @var{addr} ]
18008 @end smallexample
18009
18010 @noindent
18011 If specified, @var{line}, can be one of:
18012
18013 @itemize @bullet
18014 @item function
18015 @c @item +offset
18016 @c @item -offset
18017 @c @item linenum
18018 @item filename:linenum
18019 @item filename:function
18020 @item *address
18021 @end itemize
18022
18023 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
18024
18025 @table @samp
18026 @item -t
18027 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
18028 @item -h
18029 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
18030 @item -c @var{condition}
18031 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
18032 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
18033 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
18034 @item -r
18035 Insert a regular breakpoint in all the functions whose names match the
18036 given regular expression. Other flags are not applicable to regular
18037 expressions.
18038 @end table
18039
18040 @subsubheading Result
18041
18042 The result is in the form:
18043
18044 @smallexample
18045 ^done,bkpt=@{number="@var{number}",type="@var{type}",disp="del"|"keep",
18046 enabled="y"|"n",addr="@var{hex}",func="@var{funcname}",file="@var{filename}",
18047 fullname="@var{full_filename}",line="@var{lineno}",[thread="@var{threadno},]
18048 times="@var{times}"@}
18049 @end smallexample
18050
18051 @noindent
18052 where @var{number} is the @value{GDBN} number for this breakpoint,
18053 @var{funcname} is the name of the function where the breakpoint was
18054 inserted, @var{filename} is the name of the source file which contains
18055 this function, @var{lineno} is the source line number within that file
18056 and @var{times} the number of times that the breakpoint has been hit
18057 (always 0 for -break-insert but may be greater for -break-info or -break-list
18058 which use the same output).
18059
18060 Note: this format is open to change.
18061 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
18062
18063 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18064
18065 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
18066 @samp{hbreak}, @samp{thbreak}, and @samp{rbreak}.
18067
18068 @subsubheading Example
18069
18070 @smallexample
18071 (gdb)
18072 -break-insert main
18073 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
18074 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",times="0"@}
18075 (gdb)
18076 -break-insert -t foo
18077 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
18078 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",times="0"@}
18079 (gdb)
18080 -break-list
18081 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
18082 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18083 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18084 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18085 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18086 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18087 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18088 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18089 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
18090 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",times="0"@},
18091 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
18092 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
18093 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}]@}
18094 (gdb)
18095 -break-insert -r foo.*
18096 ~int foo(int, int);
18097 ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
18098 "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}
18099 (gdb)
18100 @end smallexample
18101
18102 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
18103 @findex -break-list
18104
18105 @subsubheading Synopsis
18106
18107 @smallexample
18108 -break-list
18109 @end smallexample
18110
18111 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
18112
18113 @table @samp
18114 @item Number
18115 number of the breakpoint
18116 @item Type
18117 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
18118 @item Disposition
18119 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
18120 or @samp{nokeep}
18121 @item Enabled
18122 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
18123 @item Address
18124 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
18125 @item What
18126 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
18127 name, line number
18128 @item Times
18129 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
18130 @end table
18131
18132 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
18133 @code{body} field is an empty list.
18134
18135 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18136
18137 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
18138
18139 @subsubheading Example
18140
18141 @smallexample
18142 (gdb)
18143 -break-list
18144 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
18145 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18146 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18147 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18148 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18149 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18150 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18151 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18152 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",times="0"@},
18153 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18154 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
18155 line="13",times="0"@}]@}
18156 (gdb)
18157 @end smallexample
18158
18159 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
18160
18161 @smallexample
18162 (gdb)
18163 -break-list
18164 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
18165 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18166 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18167 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18168 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18169 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18170 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18171 body=[]@}
18172 (gdb)
18173 @end smallexample
18174
18175 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
18176 @findex -break-watch
18177
18178 @subsubheading Synopsis
18179
18180 @smallexample
18181 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
18182 @end smallexample
18183
18184 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
18185 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a
18186 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
18187 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will
18188 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
18189 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
18190 i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
18191 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}.
18192
18193 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
18194 breakpoints inserted.
18195
18196 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18197
18198 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
18199 @samp{rwatch}.
18200
18201 @subsubheading Example
18202
18203 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
18204
18205 @smallexample
18206 (gdb)
18207 -break-watch x
18208 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
18209 (gdb)
18210 -exec-continue
18211 ^running
18212 (gdb)
18213 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
18214 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
18215 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
18216 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5"@}
18217 (gdb)
18218 @end smallexample
18219
18220 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
18221 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
18222 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
18223
18224 @smallexample
18225 (gdb)
18226 -break-watch C
18227 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
18228 (gdb)
18229 -exec-continue
18230 ^running
18231 (gdb)
18232 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
18233 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
18234 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
18235 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18236 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
18237 (gdb)
18238 -exec-continue
18239 ^running
18240 (gdb)
18241 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
18242 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
18243 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
18244 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18245 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
18246 (gdb)
18247 @end smallexample
18248
18249 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
18250 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
18251 deleted.
18252
18253 @smallexample
18254 (gdb)
18255 -break-watch C
18256 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
18257 (gdb)
18258 -break-list
18259 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
18260 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18261 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18262 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18263 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18264 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18265 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18266 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18267 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
18268 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18269 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",times="1"@},
18270 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
18271 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="0"@}]@}
18272 (gdb)
18273 -exec-continue
18274 ^running
18275 (gdb)
18276 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
18277 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
18278 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
18279 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18280 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
18281 (gdb)
18282 -break-list
18283 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
18284 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18285 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18286 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18287 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18288 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18289 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18290 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18291 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
18292 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18293 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",times="1"@},
18294 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
18295 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="-5"@}]@}
18296 (gdb)
18297 -exec-continue
18298 ^running
18299 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
18300 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
18301 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
18302 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18303 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
18304 (gdb)
18305 -break-list
18306 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
18307 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18308 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18309 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18310 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18311 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18312 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18313 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18314 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
18315 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18316 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
18317 times="1"@}]@}
18318 (gdb)
18319 @end smallexample
18320
18321 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18322 @node GDB/MI Program Context
18323 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
18324
18325 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
18326 @findex -exec-arguments
18327
18328
18329 @subsubheading Synopsis
18330
18331 @smallexample
18332 -exec-arguments @var{args}
18333 @end smallexample
18334
18335 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
18336 @samp{-exec-run}.
18337
18338 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18339
18340 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
18341
18342 @subsubheading Example
18343
18344 @c FIXME!
18345 Don't have one around.
18346
18347
18348 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
18349 @findex -exec-show-arguments
18350
18351 @subsubheading Synopsis
18352
18353 @smallexample
18354 -exec-show-arguments
18355 @end smallexample
18356
18357 Print the arguments of the program.
18358
18359 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18360
18361 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
18362
18363 @subsubheading Example
18364 N.A.
18365
18366
18367 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
18368 @findex -environment-cd
18369
18370 @subsubheading Synopsis
18371
18372 @smallexample
18373 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
18374 @end smallexample
18375
18376 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
18377
18378 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18379
18380 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
18381
18382 @subsubheading Example
18383
18384 @smallexample
18385 (gdb)
18386 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
18387 ^done
18388 (gdb)
18389 @end smallexample
18390
18391
18392 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
18393 @findex -environment-directory
18394
18395 @subsubheading Synopsis
18396
18397 @smallexample
18398 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
18399 @end smallexample
18400
18401 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
18402 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
18403 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
18404 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
18405 occurs as normal.
18406 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
18407 multiple directories in a single command
18408 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
18409 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
18410 If blanks are needed as
18411 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
18412 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
18413 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
18414 character must not be used
18415 in any directory name.
18416 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
18417
18418 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18419
18420 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
18421
18422 @subsubheading Example
18423
18424 @smallexample
18425 (gdb)
18426 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
18427 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
18428 (gdb)
18429 -environment-directory ""
18430 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
18431 (gdb)
18432 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
18433 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
18434 (gdb)
18435 -environment-directory -r
18436 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
18437 (gdb)
18438 @end smallexample
18439
18440
18441 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
18442 @findex -environment-path
18443
18444 @subsubheading Synopsis
18445
18446 @smallexample
18447 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
18448 @end smallexample
18449
18450 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
18451 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
18452 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
18453 supplied in addition to the
18454 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
18455 occurs as normal.
18456 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
18457 multiple directories in a single command
18458 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
18459 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
18460 If blanks are needed as
18461 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
18462 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
18463 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
18464 character must not be used
18465 in any directory name.
18466 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
18467
18468
18469 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18470
18471 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
18472
18473 @subsubheading Example
18474
18475 @smallexample
18476 (gdb)
18477 -environment-path
18478 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
18479 (gdb)
18480 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
18481 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
18482 (gdb)
18483 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
18484 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
18485 (gdb)
18486 @end smallexample
18487
18488
18489 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
18490 @findex -environment-pwd
18491
18492 @subsubheading Synopsis
18493
18494 @smallexample
18495 -environment-pwd
18496 @end smallexample
18497
18498 Show the current working directory.
18499
18500 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18501
18502 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
18503
18504 @subsubheading Example
18505
18506 @smallexample
18507 (gdb)
18508 -environment-pwd
18509 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
18510 (gdb)
18511 @end smallexample
18512
18513 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18514 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
18515 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
18516
18517
18518 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
18519 @findex -thread-info
18520
18521 @subsubheading Synopsis
18522
18523 @smallexample
18524 -thread-info
18525 @end smallexample
18526
18527 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18528
18529 No equivalent.
18530
18531 @subsubheading Example
18532 N.A.
18533
18534
18535 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-all-threads} Command
18536 @findex -thread-list-all-threads
18537
18538 @subsubheading Synopsis
18539
18540 @smallexample
18541 -thread-list-all-threads
18542 @end smallexample
18543
18544 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18545
18546 The equivalent @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info threads}.
18547
18548 @subsubheading Example
18549 N.A.
18550
18551
18552 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
18553 @findex -thread-list-ids
18554
18555 @subsubheading Synopsis
18556
18557 @smallexample
18558 -thread-list-ids
18559 @end smallexample
18560
18561 Produces a list of the currently known @value{GDBN} thread ids. At the
18562 end of the list it also prints the total number of such threads.
18563
18564 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18565
18566 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
18567
18568 @subsubheading Example
18569
18570 No threads present, besides the main process:
18571
18572 @smallexample
18573 (gdb)
18574 -thread-list-ids
18575 ^done,thread-ids=@{@},number-of-threads="0"
18576 (gdb)
18577 @end smallexample
18578
18579
18580 Several threads:
18581
18582 @smallexample
18583 (gdb)
18584 -thread-list-ids
18585 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
18586 number-of-threads="3"
18587 (gdb)
18588 @end smallexample
18589
18590
18591 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
18592 @findex -thread-select
18593
18594 @subsubheading Synopsis
18595
18596 @smallexample
18597 -thread-select @var{threadnum}
18598 @end smallexample
18599
18600 Make @var{threadnum} the current thread. It prints the number of the new
18601 current thread, and the topmost frame for that thread.
18602
18603 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18604
18605 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
18606
18607 @subsubheading Example
18608
18609 @smallexample
18610 (gdb)
18611 -exec-next
18612 ^running
18613 (gdb)
18614 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
18615 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
18616 (gdb)
18617 -thread-list-ids
18618 ^done,
18619 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
18620 number-of-threads="3"
18621 (gdb)
18622 -thread-select 3
18623 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
18624 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
18625 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
18626 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@}
18627 (gdb)
18628 @end smallexample
18629
18630 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18631 @node GDB/MI Program Execution
18632 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
18633
18634 These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
18635 record @samp{*stopped}. Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes
18636 asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
18637 other cases.
18638
18639 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
18640 @findex -exec-continue
18641
18642 @subsubheading Synopsis
18643
18644 @smallexample
18645 -exec-continue
18646 @end smallexample
18647
18648 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until a breakpoint is
18649 encountered, or until the inferior exits.
18650
18651 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18652
18653 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
18654
18655 @subsubheading Example
18656
18657 @smallexample
18658 -exec-continue
18659 ^running
18660 (gdb)
18661 @@Hello world
18662 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="2",frame=@{func="foo",args=[],
18663 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="13"@}
18664 (gdb)
18665 @end smallexample
18666
18667
18668 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
18669 @findex -exec-finish
18670
18671 @subsubheading Synopsis
18672
18673 @smallexample
18674 -exec-finish
18675 @end smallexample
18676
18677 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
18678 function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
18679
18680 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18681
18682 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
18683
18684 @subsubheading Example
18685
18686 Function returning @code{void}.
18687
18688 @smallexample
18689 -exec-finish
18690 ^running
18691 (gdb)
18692 @@hello from foo
18693 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
18694 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7"@}
18695 (gdb)
18696 @end smallexample
18697
18698 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
18699 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
18700 value itself.
18701
18702 @smallexample
18703 -exec-finish
18704 ^running
18705 (gdb)
18706 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
18707 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
18708 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
18709 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
18710 (gdb)
18711 @end smallexample
18712
18713
18714 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
18715 @findex -exec-interrupt
18716
18717 @subsubheading Synopsis
18718
18719 @smallexample
18720 -exec-interrupt
18721 @end smallexample
18722
18723 Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
18724 associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
18725 that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
18726 appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
18727 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
18728
18729 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18730
18731 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
18732
18733 @subsubheading Example
18734
18735 @smallexample
18736 (gdb)
18737 111-exec-continue
18738 111^running
18739
18740 (gdb)
18741 222-exec-interrupt
18742 222^done
18743 (gdb)
18744 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
18745 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
18746 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13"@}
18747 (gdb)
18748
18749 (gdb)
18750 -exec-interrupt
18751 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
18752 (gdb)
18753 @end smallexample
18754
18755
18756 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
18757 @findex -exec-next
18758
18759 @subsubheading Synopsis
18760
18761 @smallexample
18762 -exec-next
18763 @end smallexample
18764
18765 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
18766 of the next source line is reached.
18767
18768 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18769
18770 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
18771
18772 @subsubheading Example
18773
18774 @smallexample
18775 -exec-next
18776 ^running
18777 (gdb)
18778 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
18779 (gdb)
18780 @end smallexample
18781
18782
18783 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
18784 @findex -exec-next-instruction
18785
18786 @subsubheading Synopsis
18787
18788 @smallexample
18789 -exec-next-instruction
18790 @end smallexample
18791
18792 Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
18793 call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
18794 instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
18795 printed as well.
18796
18797 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18798
18799 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
18800
18801 @subsubheading Example
18802
18803 @smallexample
18804 (gdb)
18805 -exec-next-instruction
18806 ^running
18807
18808 (gdb)
18809 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
18810 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
18811 (gdb)
18812 @end smallexample
18813
18814
18815 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
18816 @findex -exec-return
18817
18818 @subsubheading Synopsis
18819
18820 @smallexample
18821 -exec-return
18822 @end smallexample
18823
18824 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
18825 Displays the new current frame.
18826
18827 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18828
18829 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
18830
18831 @subsubheading Example
18832
18833 @smallexample
18834 (gdb)
18835 200-break-insert callee4
18836 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
18837 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
18838 (gdb)
18839 000-exec-run
18840 000^running
18841 (gdb)
18842 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",
18843 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
18844 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18845 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
18846 (gdb)
18847 205-break-delete
18848 205^done
18849 (gdb)
18850 111-exec-return
18851 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
18852 args=[@{name="strarg",
18853 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
18854 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18855 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
18856 (gdb)
18857 @end smallexample
18858
18859
18860 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
18861 @findex -exec-run
18862
18863 @subsubheading Synopsis
18864
18865 @smallexample
18866 -exec-run
18867 @end smallexample
18868
18869 Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
18870 executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
18871 exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
18872 the program has exited exceptionally.
18873
18874 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18875
18876 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
18877
18878 @subsubheading Examples
18879
18880 @smallexample
18881 (gdb)
18882 -break-insert main
18883 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
18884 (gdb)
18885 -exec-run
18886 ^running
18887 (gdb)
18888 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",
18889 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
18890 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}
18891 (gdb)
18892 @end smallexample
18893
18894 @noindent
18895 Program exited normally:
18896
18897 @smallexample
18898 (gdb)
18899 -exec-run
18900 ^running
18901 (gdb)
18902 x = 55
18903 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
18904 (gdb)
18905 @end smallexample
18906
18907 @noindent
18908 Program exited exceptionally:
18909
18910 @smallexample
18911 (gdb)
18912 -exec-run
18913 ^running
18914 (gdb)
18915 x = 55
18916 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
18917 (gdb)
18918 @end smallexample
18919
18920 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
18921 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
18922
18923 @smallexample
18924 (gdb)
18925 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
18926 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
18927 @end smallexample
18928
18929
18930 @c @subheading -exec-signal
18931
18932
18933 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
18934 @findex -exec-step
18935
18936 @subsubheading Synopsis
18937
18938 @smallexample
18939 -exec-step
18940 @end smallexample
18941
18942 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
18943 of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
18944 function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
18945 function.
18946
18947 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18948
18949 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
18950
18951 @subsubheading Example
18952
18953 Stepping into a function:
18954
18955 @smallexample
18956 -exec-step
18957 ^running
18958 (gdb)
18959 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
18960 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
18961 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
18962 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@}
18963 (gdb)
18964 @end smallexample
18965
18966 Regular stepping:
18967
18968 @smallexample
18969 -exec-step
18970 ^running
18971 (gdb)
18972 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
18973 (gdb)
18974 @end smallexample
18975
18976
18977 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
18978 @findex -exec-step-instruction
18979
18980 @subsubheading Synopsis
18981
18982 @smallexample
18983 -exec-step-instruction
18984 @end smallexample
18985
18986 Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. The
18987 output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on whether
18988 we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the former
18989 case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed as
18990 well.
18991
18992 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18993
18994 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
18995
18996 @subsubheading Example
18997
18998 @smallexample
18999 (gdb)
19000 -exec-step-instruction
19001 ^running
19002
19003 (gdb)
19004 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
19005 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
19006 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
19007 (gdb)
19008 -exec-step-instruction
19009 ^running
19010
19011 (gdb)
19012 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
19013 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
19014 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
19015 (gdb)
19016 @end smallexample
19017
19018
19019 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
19020 @findex -exec-until
19021
19022 @subsubheading Synopsis
19023
19024 @smallexample
19025 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
19026 @end smallexample
19027
19028 Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
19029 argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
19030 until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
19031 reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
19032
19033 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19034
19035 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
19036
19037 @subsubheading Example
19038
19039 @smallexample
19040 (gdb)
19041 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
19042 ^running
19043 (gdb)
19044 x = 55
19045 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
19046 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6"@}
19047 (gdb)
19048 @end smallexample
19049
19050 @ignore
19051 @subheading -file-clear
19052 Is this going away????
19053 @end ignore
19054
19055 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19056 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
19057 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
19058
19059
19060 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
19061 @findex -stack-info-frame
19062
19063 @subsubheading Synopsis
19064
19065 @smallexample
19066 -stack-info-frame
19067 @end smallexample
19068
19069 Get info on the selected frame.
19070
19071 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19072
19073 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
19074 (without arguments).
19075
19076 @subsubheading Example
19077
19078 @smallexample
19079 (gdb)
19080 -stack-info-frame
19081 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
19082 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19083 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@}
19084 (gdb)
19085 @end smallexample
19086
19087 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
19088 @findex -stack-info-depth
19089
19090 @subsubheading Synopsis
19091
19092 @smallexample
19093 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
19094 @end smallexample
19095
19096 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
19097 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
19098
19099 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19100
19101 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
19102
19103 @subsubheading Example
19104
19105 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
19106
19107 @smallexample
19108 (gdb)
19109 -stack-info-depth
19110 ^done,depth="12"
19111 (gdb)
19112 -stack-info-depth 4
19113 ^done,depth="4"
19114 (gdb)
19115 -stack-info-depth 12
19116 ^done,depth="12"
19117 (gdb)
19118 -stack-info-depth 11
19119 ^done,depth="11"
19120 (gdb)
19121 -stack-info-depth 13
19122 ^done,depth="12"
19123 (gdb)
19124 @end smallexample
19125
19126 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
19127 @findex -stack-list-arguments
19128
19129 @subsubheading Synopsis
19130
19131 @smallexample
19132 -stack-list-arguments @var{show-values}
19133 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
19134 @end smallexample
19135
19136 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
19137 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
19138 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
19139 call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
19140 at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
19141 larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
19142 @var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
19143 which case only existing frames will be returned.
19144
19145 The @var{show-values} argument must have a value of 0 or 1. A value of
19146 0 means that only the names of the arguments are listed, a value of 1
19147 means that both names and values of the arguments are printed.
19148
19149 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19150
19151 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
19152 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
19153 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
19154
19155 @subsubheading Example
19156
19157 @smallexample
19158 (gdb)
19159 -stack-list-frames
19160 ^done,
19161 stack=[
19162 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
19163 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19164 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@},
19165 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
19166 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19167 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@},
19168 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
19169 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19170 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@},
19171 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
19172 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19173 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@},
19174 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
19175 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19176 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}]
19177 (gdb)
19178 -stack-list-arguments 0
19179 ^done,
19180 stack-args=[
19181 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
19182 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
19183 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
19184 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
19185 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
19186 (gdb)
19187 -stack-list-arguments 1
19188 ^done,
19189 stack-args=[
19190 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
19191 frame=@{level="1",
19192 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
19193 frame=@{level="2",args=[
19194 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
19195 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
19196 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
19197 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
19198 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
19199 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
19200 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
19201 (gdb)
19202 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
19203 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
19204 (gdb)
19205 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
19206 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
19207 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
19208 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
19209 (gdb)
19210 @end smallexample
19211
19212 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
19213
19214
19215 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
19216 @findex -stack-list-frames
19217
19218 @subsubheading Synopsis
19219
19220 @smallexample
19221 -stack-list-frames [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
19222 @end smallexample
19223
19224 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
19225 following info:
19226
19227 @table @samp
19228 @item @var{level}
19229 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function.
19230 @item @var{addr}
19231 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
19232 @item @var{func}
19233 Function name.
19234 @item @var{file}
19235 File name of the source file where the function lives.
19236 @item @var{line}
19237 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
19238 @end table
19239
19240 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
19241 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
19242 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
19243 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
19244 an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
19245 frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
19246 actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be returned.
19247
19248 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19249
19250 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
19251
19252 @subsubheading Example
19253
19254 Full stack backtrace:
19255
19256 @smallexample
19257 (gdb)
19258 -stack-list-frames
19259 ^done,stack=
19260 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
19261 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@},
19262 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19263 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19264 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19265 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19266 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19267 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19268 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19269 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19270 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19271 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19272 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19273 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19274 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19275 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19276 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19277 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19278 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19279 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19280 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19281 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19282 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
19283 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}]
19284 (gdb)
19285 @end smallexample
19286
19287 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
19288
19289 @smallexample
19290 (gdb)
19291 -stack-list-frames 3 5
19292 ^done,stack=
19293 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19294 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19295 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19296 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19297 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19298 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
19299 (gdb)
19300 @end smallexample
19301
19302 Show a single frame:
19303
19304 @smallexample
19305 (gdb)
19306 -stack-list-frames 3 3
19307 ^done,stack=
19308 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19309 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
19310 (gdb)
19311 @end smallexample
19312
19313
19314 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
19315 @findex -stack-list-locals
19316
19317 @subsubheading Synopsis
19318
19319 @smallexample
19320 -stack-list-locals @var{print-values}
19321 @end smallexample
19322
19323 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
19324 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
19325 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
19326 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
19327 type and value for simple data types and the name and type for arrays,
19328 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
19329 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
19330 other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in
19331 more detail.
19332
19333 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19334
19335 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
19336
19337 @subsubheading Example
19338
19339 @smallexample
19340 (gdb)
19341 -stack-list-locals 0
19342 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
19343 (gdb)
19344 -stack-list-locals --all-values
19345 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
19346 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
19347 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
19348 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
19349 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
19350 (gdb)
19351 @end smallexample
19352
19353
19354 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
19355 @findex -stack-select-frame
19356
19357 @subsubheading Synopsis
19358
19359 @smallexample
19360 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
19361 @end smallexample
19362
19363 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
19364 the stack.
19365
19366 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19367
19368 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
19369 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
19370
19371 @subsubheading Example
19372
19373 @smallexample
19374 (gdb)
19375 -stack-select-frame 2
19376 ^done
19377 (gdb)
19378 @end smallexample
19379
19380 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19381 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
19382 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
19383
19384 @ignore
19385
19386 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
19387
19388 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
19389 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
19390 used by @code{Insight}.
19391
19392 The two main reasons for that are:
19393
19394 @enumerate 1
19395 @item
19396 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
19397
19398 @item
19399 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
19400 now).
19401 @end enumerate
19402
19403 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
19404 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
19405 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
19406 hints about their use.
19407
19408 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
19409 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
19410 least, the following operations:
19411
19412 @itemize @bullet
19413 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
19414 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
19415 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
19416 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
19417 @end itemize
19418
19419 @end ignore
19420
19421 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects
19422
19423 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
19424
19425 Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and
19426 changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that
19427 work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for
19428 simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object
19429 is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the
19430 frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The
19431 expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex
19432 expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a
19433 variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object
19434 operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable
19435 object, or to change display format.
19436
19437 Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object
19438 that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has
19439 a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each
19440 element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have
19441 children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach
19442 leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types. Child variable
19443 objects are created only by explicit request, so if a frontend
19444 is not interested in the children of a particular variable object, no
19445 child will be created.
19446
19447 For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a
19448 string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also
19449 obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string
19450 that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its
19451 contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed.
19452
19453 A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time
19454 the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all
19455 variable objects whose values has changed since the last update
19456 operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must
19457 be transferred to the frontend. As noted above, children variable
19458 objects are created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a
19459 real value. As result, gdb will read target memory only for leaf
19460 variables that frontend has created.
19461
19462 The automatic update is not always desirable. For example, a frontend
19463 might want to keep a value of some expression for future reference,
19464 and never update it. For another example, fetching memory is
19465 relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want
19466 to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not
19467 visible on the screen, or ``closed''. This is possible using so
19468 called ``frozen variable objects''. Such variable objects are never
19469 implicitly updated.
19470
19471 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
19472 access this functionality:
19473
19474 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
19475 @item @strong{Operation}
19476 @tab @strong{Description}
19477
19478 @item @code{-var-create}
19479 @tab create a variable object
19480 @item @code{-var-delete}
19481 @tab delete the variable object and/or its children
19482 @item @code{-var-set-format}
19483 @tab set the display format of this variable
19484 @item @code{-var-show-format}
19485 @tab show the display format of this variable
19486 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
19487 @tab tells how many children this object has
19488 @item @code{-var-list-children}
19489 @tab return a list of the object's children
19490 @item @code{-var-info-type}
19491 @tab show the type of this variable object
19492 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
19493 @tab print parent-relative expression that this variable object represents
19494 @item @code{-var-info-path-expression}
19495 @tab print full expression that this variable object represents
19496 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
19497 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
19498 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
19499 @tab get the value of this variable
19500 @item @code{-var-assign}
19501 @tab set the value of this variable
19502 @item @code{-var-update}
19503 @tab update the variable and its children
19504 @item @code{-var-set-frozen}
19505 @tab set frozeness attribute
19506 @end multitable
19507
19508 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
19509 how it can be used.
19510
19511 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
19512
19513 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
19514 @findex -var-create
19515
19516 @subsubheading Synopsis
19517
19518 @smallexample
19519 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
19520 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*"@} @var{expression}
19521 @end smallexample
19522
19523 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
19524 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
19525 register.
19526
19527 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
19528 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
19529 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
19530 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} on that format.
19531 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
19532
19533 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
19534 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
19535 frame should be used.
19536
19537 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
19538 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
19539
19540 @itemize @bullet
19541 @item
19542 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
19543
19544 @item
19545 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
19546
19547 @item
19548 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
19549 @end itemize
19550
19551 @subsubheading Result
19552
19553 This operation returns the name, number of children and the type of the
19554 object created. Type is returned as a string as the ones generated by
19555 the @value{GDBN} CLI:
19556
19557 @smallexample
19558 name="@var{name}",numchild="N",type="@var{type}"
19559 @end smallexample
19560
19561
19562 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
19563 @findex -var-delete
19564
19565 @subsubheading Synopsis
19566
19567 @smallexample
19568 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
19569 @end smallexample
19570
19571 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
19572 With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
19573
19574 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
19575
19576
19577 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
19578 @findex -var-set-format
19579
19580 @subsubheading Synopsis
19581
19582 @smallexample
19583 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
19584 @end smallexample
19585
19586 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
19587 @var{format-spec}.
19588
19589 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
19590
19591 @smallexample
19592 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
19593 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural@}
19594 @end smallexample
19595
19596 The natural format is the default format choosen automatically
19597 based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
19598 for pointers, etc.).
19599
19600 For a variable with children, the format is set only on the
19601 variable itself, and the children are not affected.
19602
19603 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
19604 @findex -var-show-format
19605
19606 @subsubheading Synopsis
19607
19608 @smallexample
19609 -var-show-format @var{name}
19610 @end smallexample
19611
19612 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
19613
19614 @smallexample
19615 @var{format} @expansion{}
19616 @var{format-spec}
19617 @end smallexample
19618
19619
19620 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
19621 @findex -var-info-num-children
19622
19623 @subsubheading Synopsis
19624
19625 @smallexample
19626 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
19627 @end smallexample
19628
19629 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
19630
19631 @smallexample
19632 numchild=@var{n}
19633 @end smallexample
19634
19635
19636 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
19637 @findex -var-list-children
19638
19639 @subsubheading Synopsis
19640
19641 @smallexample
19642 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name}
19643 @end smallexample
19644 @anchor{-var-list-children}
19645
19646 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
19647 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
19648 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value for of 0 or
19649 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
19650 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
19651 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
19652 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
19653 and unions.
19654
19655 @subsubheading Example
19656
19657 @smallexample
19658 (gdb)
19659 -var-list-children n
19660 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[@{name=@var{name},
19661 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
19662 (gdb)
19663 -var-list-children --all-values n
19664 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[@{name=@var{name},
19665 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
19666 @end smallexample
19667
19668
19669 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
19670 @findex -var-info-type
19671
19672 @subsubheading Synopsis
19673
19674 @smallexample
19675 -var-info-type @var{name}
19676 @end smallexample
19677
19678 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
19679 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
19680 @value{GDBN} CLI:
19681
19682 @smallexample
19683 type=@var{typename}
19684 @end smallexample
19685
19686
19687 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
19688 @findex -var-info-expression
19689
19690 @subsubheading Synopsis
19691
19692 @smallexample
19693 -var-info-expression @var{name}
19694 @end smallexample
19695
19696 Returns a string that is suitable for presenting this
19697 variable object in user interface. The string is generally
19698 not valid expression in the current language, and cannot be evaluated.
19699
19700 For example, if @code{a} is an array, and variable object
19701 @code{A} was created for @code{a}, then we'll get this output:
19702
19703 @smallexample
19704 (gdb) -var-info-expression A.1
19705 ^done,lang="C",exp="1"
19706 @end smallexample
19707
19708 @noindent
19709 Here, the values of @code{lang} can be @code{@{"C" | "C++" | "Java"@}}.
19710
19711 Note that the output of the @code{-var-list-children} command also
19712 includes those expressions, so the @code{-var-info-expression} command
19713 is of limited use.
19714
19715 @subheading The @code{-var-info-path-expression} Command
19716 @findex -var-info-path-expression
19717
19718 @subsubheading Synopsis
19719
19720 @smallexample
19721 -var-info-path-expression @var{name}
19722 @end smallexample
19723
19724 Returns an expression that can be evaluated in the current
19725 context and will yield the same value that a variable object has.
19726 Compare this with the @code{-var-info-expression} command, which
19727 result can be used only for UI presentation. Typical use of
19728 the @code{-var-info-path-expression} command is creating a
19729 watchpoint from a variable object.
19730
19731 For example, suppose @code{C} is a C@t{++} class, derived from class
19732 @code{Base}, and that the @code{Base} class has a member called
19733 @code{m_size}. Assume a variable @code{c} is has the type of
19734 @code{C} and a variable object @code{C} was created for variable
19735 @code{c}. Then, we'll get this output:
19736 @smallexample
19737 (gdb) -var-info-path-expression C.Base.public.m_size
19738 ^done,path_expr=((Base)c).m_size)
19739 @end smallexample
19740
19741 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
19742 @findex -var-show-attributes
19743
19744 @subsubheading Synopsis
19745
19746 @smallexample
19747 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
19748 @end smallexample
19749
19750 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
19751
19752 @smallexample
19753 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
19754 @end smallexample
19755
19756 @noindent
19757 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
19758
19759 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
19760 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
19761
19762 @subsubheading Synopsis
19763
19764 @smallexample
19765 -var-evaluate-expression @var{name}
19766 @end smallexample
19767
19768 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
19769 object and returns its value as a string. The format of the
19770 string can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command.
19771
19772 @smallexample
19773 value=@var{value}
19774 @end smallexample
19775
19776 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
19777 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
19778
19779 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
19780 @findex -var-assign
19781
19782 @subsubheading Synopsis
19783
19784 @smallexample
19785 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
19786 @end smallexample
19787
19788 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
19789 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
19790 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
19791 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
19792
19793 @subsubheading Example
19794
19795 @smallexample
19796 (gdb)
19797 -var-assign var1 3
19798 ^done,value="3"
19799 (gdb)
19800 -var-update *
19801 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
19802 (gdb)
19803 @end smallexample
19804
19805 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
19806 @findex -var-update
19807
19808 @subsubheading Synopsis
19809
19810 @smallexample
19811 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
19812 @end smallexample
19813
19814 Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object
19815 @var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the
19816 list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must
19817 be a root variable object. Here, ``changed'' means that the result of
19818 @code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the
19819 @code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used as the variable
19820 object names, all existing variable objects are updated, except
19821 for frozen ones (@pxref{-var-set-frozen}). The option
19822 @var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just
19823 names are printed. The possible values of this options are the same
19824 as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is
19825 recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the
19826 number of MI commands needed on each program stop.
19827
19828
19829 @subsubheading Example
19830
19831 @smallexample
19832 (gdb)
19833 -var-assign var1 3
19834 ^done,value="3"
19835 (gdb)
19836 -var-update --all-values var1
19837 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
19838 type_changed="false"@}]
19839 (gdb)
19840 @end smallexample
19841
19842 @anchor{-var-update}
19843 The field in_scope may take three values:
19844
19845 @table @code
19846 @item "true"
19847 The variable object's current value is valid.
19848
19849 @item "false"
19850 The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may
19851 hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into
19852 scope.
19853
19854 @item "invalid"
19855 The variable object no longer holds a valid value.
19856 This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed,
19857 either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file}
19858 command. The front end should normally choose to delete these variable
19859 objects.
19860 @end table
19861
19862 In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should
19863 be prepared for this possibility. @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}.
19864
19865 @subheading The @code{-var-set-frozen} Command
19866 @findex -var-set-frozen
19867 @anchor{-var-set-frozen}
19868
19869 @subsubheading Synopsis
19870
19871 @smallexample
19872 -var-set-frozen @var{name} @var{flag}
19873 @end smallexample
19874
19875 Set the frozenness flag on the variable object @var{name}. The
19876 @var{flag} parameter should be either @samp{1} to make the variable
19877 frozen or @samp{0} to make it unfrozen. If a variable object is
19878 frozen, then neither itself, nor any of its children, are
19879 implicitly updated by @code{-var-update} of
19880 a parent variable or by @code{-var-update *}. Only
19881 @code{-var-update} of the variable itself will update its value and
19882 values of its children. After a variable object is unfrozen, it is
19883 implicitly updated by all subsequent @code{-var-update} operations.
19884 Unfreezing a variable does not update it, only subsequent
19885 @code{-var-update} does.
19886
19887 @subsubheading Example
19888
19889 @smallexample
19890 (gdb)
19891 -var-set-frozen V 1
19892 ^done
19893 (gdb)
19894 @end smallexample
19895
19896
19897 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19898 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
19899 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
19900
19901 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
19902 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
19903 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
19904 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
19905
19906 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
19907 @c @subheading -data-assign
19908 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
19909 @c @subsubheading GDB Command
19910 @c set variable
19911 @c @subsubheading Example
19912 @c N.A.
19913
19914 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
19915 @findex -data-disassemble
19916
19917 @subsubheading Synopsis
19918
19919 @smallexample
19920 -data-disassemble
19921 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
19922 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
19923 -- @var{mode}
19924 @end smallexample
19925
19926 @noindent
19927 Where:
19928
19929 @table @samp
19930 @item @var{start-addr}
19931 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
19932 @item @var{end-addr}
19933 is the end address
19934 @item @var{filename}
19935 is the name of the file to disassemble
19936 @item @var{linenum}
19937 is the line number to disassemble around
19938 @item @var{lines}
19939 is the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
19940 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
19941 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
19942 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
19943 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
19944 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
19945 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
19946 are displayed.
19947 @item @var{mode}
19948 is either 0 (meaning only disassembly) or 1 (meaning mixed source and
19949 disassembly).
19950 @end table
19951
19952 @subsubheading Result
19953
19954 The output for each instruction is composed of four fields:
19955
19956 @itemize @bullet
19957 @item Address
19958 @item Func-name
19959 @item Offset
19960 @item Instruction
19961 @end itemize
19962
19963 Note that whatever included in the instruction field, is not manipulated
19964 directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to adjust its format.
19965
19966 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19967
19968 There's no direct mapping from this command to the CLI.
19969
19970 @subsubheading Example
19971
19972 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
19973
19974 @smallexample
19975 (gdb)
19976 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
19977 ^done,
19978 asm_insns=[
19979 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
19980 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
19981 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
19982 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
19983 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
19984 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
19985 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
19986 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
19987 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
19988 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
19989 (gdb)
19990 @end smallexample
19991
19992 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
19993 @code{main}.
19994
19995 @smallexample
19996 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
19997 ^done,asm_insns=[
19998 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
19999 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
20000 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
20001 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
20002 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
20003 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
20004 [@dots{}]
20005 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
20006 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
20007 (gdb)
20008 @end smallexample
20009
20010 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
20011
20012 @smallexample
20013 (gdb)
20014 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
20015 ^done,asm_insns=[
20016 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
20017 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
20018 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
20019 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
20020 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
20021 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
20022 (gdb)
20023 @end smallexample
20024
20025 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
20026
20027 @smallexample
20028 (gdb)
20029 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
20030 ^done,asm_insns=[
20031 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
20032 file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
20033 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
20034 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
20035 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
20036 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
20037 file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
20038 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
20039 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
20040 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
20041 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
20042 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
20043 (gdb)
20044 @end smallexample
20045
20046
20047 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
20048 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
20049
20050 @subsubheading Synopsis
20051
20052 @smallexample
20053 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
20054 @end smallexample
20055
20056 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
20057 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
20058 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
20059
20060 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20061
20062 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
20063 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
20064 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
20065
20066 @subsubheading Example
20067
20068 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
20069 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
20070 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
20071 output.
20072
20073 @smallexample
20074 211-data-evaluate-expression A
20075 211^done,value="1"
20076 (gdb)
20077 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
20078 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
20079 (gdb)
20080 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
20081 411^done,value="4"
20082 (gdb)
20083 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
20084 511^done,value="4"
20085 (gdb)
20086 @end smallexample
20087
20088
20089 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
20090 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
20091
20092 @subsubheading Synopsis
20093
20094 @smallexample
20095 -data-list-changed-registers
20096 @end smallexample
20097
20098 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
20099
20100 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20101
20102 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
20103 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
20104
20105 @subsubheading Example
20106
20107 On a PPC MBX board:
20108
20109 @smallexample
20110 (gdb)
20111 -exec-continue
20112 ^running
20113
20114 (gdb)
20115 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",frame=@{func="main",
20116 args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="5"@}
20117 (gdb)
20118 -data-list-changed-registers
20119 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
20120 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
20121 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
20122 (gdb)
20123 @end smallexample
20124
20125
20126 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
20127 @findex -data-list-register-names
20128
20129 @subsubheading Synopsis
20130
20131 @smallexample
20132 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
20133 @end smallexample
20134
20135 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
20136 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
20137 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
20138 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
20139 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
20140 include empty register names.
20141
20142 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20143
20144 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
20145 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
20146 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
20147
20148 @subsubheading Example
20149
20150 For the PPC MBX board:
20151 @smallexample
20152 (gdb)
20153 -data-list-register-names
20154 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
20155 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
20156 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
20157 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
20158 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
20159 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
20160 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
20161 (gdb)
20162 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
20163 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
20164 (gdb)
20165 @end smallexample
20166
20167 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
20168 @findex -data-list-register-values
20169
20170 @subsubheading Synopsis
20171
20172 @smallexample
20173 -data-list-register-values @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
20174 @end smallexample
20175
20176 Display the registers' contents. @var{fmt} is the format according to
20177 which the registers' contents are to be returned, followed by an optional
20178 list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A missing list of
20179 numbers indicates that the contents of all the registers must be returned.
20180
20181 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
20182
20183 @table @code
20184 @item x
20185 Hexadecimal
20186 @item o
20187 Octal
20188 @item t
20189 Binary
20190 @item d
20191 Decimal
20192 @item r
20193 Raw
20194 @item N
20195 Natural
20196 @end table
20197
20198 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20199
20200 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
20201 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
20202
20203 @subsubheading Example
20204
20205 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
20206 don't appear in the actual output):
20207
20208 @smallexample
20209 (gdb)
20210 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
20211 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
20212 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
20213 (gdb)
20214 -data-list-register-values x
20215 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
20216 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
20217 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
20218 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
20219 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
20220 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
20221 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
20222 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
20223 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
20224 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
20225 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
20226 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
20227 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
20228 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
20229 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
20230 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
20231 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
20232 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
20233 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
20234 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
20235 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
20236 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
20237 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
20238 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
20239 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
20240 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
20241 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
20242 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
20243 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
20244 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
20245 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
20246 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
20247 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
20248 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
20249 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
20250 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
20251 (gdb)
20252 @end smallexample
20253
20254
20255 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
20256 @findex -data-read-memory
20257
20258 @subsubheading Synopsis
20259
20260 @smallexample
20261 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
20262 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
20263 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
20264 @end smallexample
20265
20266 @noindent
20267 where:
20268
20269 @table @samp
20270 @item @var{address}
20271 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
20272 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
20273 quoted using the C convention.
20274
20275 @item @var{word-format}
20276 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
20277 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
20278 ,Output Formats}).
20279
20280 @item @var{word-size}
20281 The size of each memory word in bytes.
20282
20283 @item @var{nr-rows}
20284 The number of rows in the output table.
20285
20286 @item @var{nr-cols}
20287 The number of columns in the output table.
20288
20289 @item @var{aschar}
20290 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
20291 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
20292 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
20293 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
20294
20295 @item @var{byte-offset}
20296 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
20297 @end table
20298
20299 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
20300 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
20301 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
20302 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
20303 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
20304 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
20305 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
20306 @samp{addr}.
20307
20308 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
20309 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
20310 @samp{prev-page}.
20311
20312 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20313
20314 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
20315 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
20316
20317 @subsubheading Example
20318
20319 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
20320 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
20321 word. Display each word in hex.
20322
20323 @smallexample
20324 (gdb)
20325 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
20326 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
20327 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
20328 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
20329 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
20330 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
20331 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
20332 (gdb)
20333 @end smallexample
20334
20335 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
20336 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
20337
20338 @smallexample
20339 (gdb)
20340 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
20341 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
20342 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
20343 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
20344 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
20345 (gdb)
20346 @end smallexample
20347
20348 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
20349 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
20350 used as the non-printable character.
20351
20352 @smallexample
20353 (gdb)
20354 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
20355 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
20356 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
20357 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
20358 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
20359 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
20360 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
20361 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
20362 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
20363 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
20364 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
20365 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
20366 (gdb)
20367 @end smallexample
20368
20369 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20370 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
20371 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
20372
20373 The tracepoint commands are not yet implemented.
20374
20375 @c @subheading -trace-actions
20376
20377 @c @subheading -trace-delete
20378
20379 @c @subheading -trace-disable
20380
20381 @c @subheading -trace-dump
20382
20383 @c @subheading -trace-enable
20384
20385 @c @subheading -trace-exists
20386
20387 @c @subheading -trace-find
20388
20389 @c @subheading -trace-frame-number
20390
20391 @c @subheading -trace-info
20392
20393 @c @subheading -trace-insert
20394
20395 @c @subheading -trace-list
20396
20397 @c @subheading -trace-pass-count
20398
20399 @c @subheading -trace-save
20400
20401 @c @subheading -trace-start
20402
20403 @c @subheading -trace-stop
20404
20405
20406 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20407 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
20408 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
20409
20410
20411 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
20412 @findex -symbol-info-address
20413
20414 @subsubheading Synopsis
20415
20416 @smallexample
20417 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
20418 @end smallexample
20419
20420 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
20421
20422 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20423
20424 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
20425
20426 @subsubheading Example
20427 N.A.
20428
20429
20430 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
20431 @findex -symbol-info-file
20432
20433 @subsubheading Synopsis
20434
20435 @smallexample
20436 -symbol-info-file
20437 @end smallexample
20438
20439 Show the file for the symbol.
20440
20441 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20442
20443 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
20444 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
20445
20446 @subsubheading Example
20447 N.A.
20448
20449
20450 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
20451 @findex -symbol-info-function
20452
20453 @subsubheading Synopsis
20454
20455 @smallexample
20456 -symbol-info-function
20457 @end smallexample
20458
20459 Show which function the symbol lives in.
20460
20461 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20462
20463 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
20464
20465 @subsubheading Example
20466 N.A.
20467
20468
20469 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
20470 @findex -symbol-info-line
20471
20472 @subsubheading Synopsis
20473
20474 @smallexample
20475 -symbol-info-line
20476 @end smallexample
20477
20478 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
20479
20480 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20481
20482 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
20483 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
20484
20485 @subsubheading Example
20486 N.A.
20487
20488
20489 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
20490 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
20491
20492 @subsubheading Synopsis
20493
20494 @smallexample
20495 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
20496 @end smallexample
20497
20498 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
20499
20500 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20501
20502 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
20503
20504 @subsubheading Example
20505 N.A.
20506
20507
20508 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
20509 @findex -symbol-list-functions
20510
20511 @subsubheading Synopsis
20512
20513 @smallexample
20514 -symbol-list-functions
20515 @end smallexample
20516
20517 List the functions in the executable.
20518
20519 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20520
20521 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
20522 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
20523
20524 @subsubheading Example
20525 N.A.
20526
20527
20528 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
20529 @findex -symbol-list-lines
20530
20531 @subsubheading Synopsis
20532
20533 @smallexample
20534 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
20535 @end smallexample
20536
20537 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
20538 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
20539 ascending PC order.
20540
20541 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20542
20543 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
20544
20545 @subsubheading Example
20546 @smallexample
20547 (gdb)
20548 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
20549 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
20550 (gdb)
20551 @end smallexample
20552
20553
20554 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
20555 @findex -symbol-list-types
20556
20557 @subsubheading Synopsis
20558
20559 @smallexample
20560 -symbol-list-types
20561 @end smallexample
20562
20563 List all the type names.
20564
20565 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20566
20567 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
20568 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
20569
20570 @subsubheading Example
20571 N.A.
20572
20573
20574 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
20575 @findex -symbol-list-variables
20576
20577 @subsubheading Synopsis
20578
20579 @smallexample
20580 -symbol-list-variables
20581 @end smallexample
20582
20583 List all the global and static variable names.
20584
20585 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20586
20587 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
20588
20589 @subsubheading Example
20590 N.A.
20591
20592
20593 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
20594 @findex -symbol-locate
20595
20596 @subsubheading Synopsis
20597
20598 @smallexample
20599 -symbol-locate
20600 @end smallexample
20601
20602 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20603
20604 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
20605
20606 @subsubheading Example
20607 N.A.
20608
20609
20610 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
20611 @findex -symbol-type
20612
20613 @subsubheading Synopsis
20614
20615 @smallexample
20616 -symbol-type @var{variable}
20617 @end smallexample
20618
20619 Show type of @var{variable}.
20620
20621 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20622
20623 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
20624 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
20625
20626 @subsubheading Example
20627 N.A.
20628
20629
20630 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20631 @node GDB/MI File Commands
20632 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
20633
20634 This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
20635 and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
20636
20637 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
20638 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
20639
20640 @subsubheading Synopsis
20641
20642 @smallexample
20643 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
20644 @end smallexample
20645
20646 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
20647 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
20648 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
20649 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
20650 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
20651 notification.
20652
20653 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20654
20655 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
20656
20657 @subsubheading Example
20658
20659 @smallexample
20660 (gdb)
20661 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
20662 ^done
20663 (gdb)
20664 @end smallexample
20665
20666
20667 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
20668 @findex -file-exec-file
20669
20670 @subsubheading Synopsis
20671
20672 @smallexample
20673 -file-exec-file @var{file}
20674 @end smallexample
20675
20676 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
20677 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
20678 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
20679 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
20680 notification.
20681
20682 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20683
20684 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
20685
20686 @subsubheading Example
20687
20688 @smallexample
20689 (gdb)
20690 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
20691 ^done
20692 (gdb)
20693 @end smallexample
20694
20695
20696 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
20697 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
20698
20699 @subsubheading Synopsis
20700
20701 @smallexample
20702 -file-list-exec-sections
20703 @end smallexample
20704
20705 List the sections of the current executable file.
20706
20707 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20708
20709 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
20710 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
20711 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
20712
20713 @subsubheading Example
20714 N.A.
20715
20716
20717 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
20718 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
20719
20720 @subsubheading Synopsis
20721
20722 @smallexample
20723 -file-list-exec-source-file
20724 @end smallexample
20725
20726 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
20727 to the current source file for the current executable.
20728
20729 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20730
20731 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
20732
20733 @subsubheading Example
20734
20735 @smallexample
20736 (gdb)
20737 123-file-list-exec-source-file
20738 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c"
20739 (gdb)
20740 @end smallexample
20741
20742
20743 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
20744 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
20745
20746 @subsubheading Synopsis
20747
20748 @smallexample
20749 -file-list-exec-source-files
20750 @end smallexample
20751
20752 List the source files for the current executable.
20753
20754 It will always output the filename, but only when @value{GDBN} can find
20755 the absolute file name of a source file, will it output the fullname.
20756
20757 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20758
20759 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
20760 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
20761
20762 @subsubheading Example
20763 @smallexample
20764 (gdb)
20765 -file-list-exec-source-files
20766 ^done,files=[
20767 @{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
20768 @{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
20769 @{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
20770 (gdb)
20771 @end smallexample
20772
20773 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
20774 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
20775
20776 @subsubheading Synopsis
20777
20778 @smallexample
20779 -file-list-shared-libraries
20780 @end smallexample
20781
20782 List the shared libraries in the program.
20783
20784 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20785
20786 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}.
20787
20788 @subsubheading Example
20789 N.A.
20790
20791
20792 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
20793 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
20794
20795 @subsubheading Synopsis
20796
20797 @smallexample
20798 -file-list-symbol-files
20799 @end smallexample
20800
20801 List symbol files.
20802
20803 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20804
20805 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
20806
20807 @subsubheading Example
20808 N.A.
20809
20810
20811 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
20812 @findex -file-symbol-file
20813
20814 @subsubheading Synopsis
20815
20816 @smallexample
20817 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
20818 @end smallexample
20819
20820 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
20821 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
20822 produced, except for a completion notification.
20823
20824 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20825
20826 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
20827
20828 @subsubheading Example
20829
20830 @smallexample
20831 (gdb)
20832 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
20833 ^done
20834 (gdb)
20835 @end smallexample
20836
20837 @ignore
20838 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20839 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
20840 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
20841
20842 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
20843
20844 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
20845
20846 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
20847
20848 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
20849
20850 @c @subheading -overlay-map
20851
20852 @c @subheading -overlay-off
20853
20854 @c @subheading -overlay-on
20855
20856 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
20857
20858 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20859 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
20860 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
20861
20862 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
20863
20864 @c @subheading -signal-handle
20865
20866 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
20867
20868 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
20869 @end ignore
20870
20871
20872 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20873 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
20874 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
20875
20876
20877 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
20878 @findex -target-attach
20879
20880 @subsubheading Synopsis
20881
20882 @smallexample
20883 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{file}
20884 @end smallexample
20885
20886 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of @value{GDBN}.
20887
20888 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20889
20890 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
20891
20892 @subsubheading Example
20893 N.A.
20894
20895
20896 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
20897 @findex -target-compare-sections
20898
20899 @subsubheading Synopsis
20900
20901 @smallexample
20902 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
20903 @end smallexample
20904
20905 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
20906 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
20907
20908 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20909
20910 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
20911
20912 @subsubheading Example
20913 N.A.
20914
20915
20916 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
20917 @findex -target-detach
20918
20919 @subsubheading Synopsis
20920
20921 @smallexample
20922 -target-detach
20923 @end smallexample
20924
20925 Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
20926 There's no output.
20927
20928 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20929
20930 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
20931
20932 @subsubheading Example
20933
20934 @smallexample
20935 (gdb)
20936 -target-detach
20937 ^done
20938 (gdb)
20939 @end smallexample
20940
20941
20942 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
20943 @findex -target-disconnect
20944
20945 @subsubheading Synopsis
20946
20947 @smallexample
20948 -target-disconnect
20949 @end smallexample
20950
20951 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
20952 generally not resumed.
20953
20954 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20955
20956 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
20957
20958 @subsubheading Example
20959
20960 @smallexample
20961 (gdb)
20962 -target-disconnect
20963 ^done
20964 (gdb)
20965 @end smallexample
20966
20967
20968 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
20969 @findex -target-download
20970
20971 @subsubheading Synopsis
20972
20973 @smallexample
20974 -target-download
20975 @end smallexample
20976
20977 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
20978 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
20979
20980 @table @samp
20981 @item section
20982 The name of the section.
20983 @item section-sent
20984 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
20985 @item section-size
20986 The size of the section.
20987 @item total-sent
20988 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
20989 @item total-size
20990 The size of the overall executable to download.
20991 @end table
20992
20993 @noindent
20994 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
20995 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
20996
20997 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
20998 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
20999
21000 @table @samp
21001 @item section
21002 The name of the section.
21003 @item section-size
21004 The size of the section.
21005 @item total-size
21006 The size of the overall executable to download.
21007 @end table
21008
21009 @noindent
21010 At the end, a summary is printed.
21011
21012 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21013
21014 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
21015
21016 @subsubheading Example
21017
21018 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
21019 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
21020
21021 @smallexample
21022 (gdb)
21023 -target-download
21024 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
21025 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
21026 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
21027 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
21028 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
21029 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
21030 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
21031 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
21032 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
21033 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
21034 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
21035 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
21036 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
21037 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
21038 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
21039 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
21040 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
21041 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
21042 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
21043 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
21044 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
21045 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
21046 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
21047 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
21048 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
21049 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
21050 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
21051 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
21052 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
21053 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
21054 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
21055 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
21056 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
21057 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
21058 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
21059 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
21060 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
21061 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
21062 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
21063 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
21064 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
21065 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
21066 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
21067 write-rate="429"
21068 (gdb)
21069 @end smallexample
21070
21071
21072 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
21073 @findex -target-exec-status
21074
21075 @subsubheading Synopsis
21076
21077 @smallexample
21078 -target-exec-status
21079 @end smallexample
21080
21081 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
21082 not, for instance).
21083
21084 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21085
21086 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
21087
21088 @subsubheading Example
21089 N.A.
21090
21091
21092 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
21093 @findex -target-list-available-targets
21094
21095 @subsubheading Synopsis
21096
21097 @smallexample
21098 -target-list-available-targets
21099 @end smallexample
21100
21101 List the possible targets to connect to.
21102
21103 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21104
21105 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
21106
21107 @subsubheading Example
21108 N.A.
21109
21110
21111 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
21112 @findex -target-list-current-targets
21113
21114 @subsubheading Synopsis
21115
21116 @smallexample
21117 -target-list-current-targets
21118 @end smallexample
21119
21120 Describe the current target.
21121
21122 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21123
21124 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
21125 other things).
21126
21127 @subsubheading Example
21128 N.A.
21129
21130
21131 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
21132 @findex -target-list-parameters
21133
21134 @subsubheading Synopsis
21135
21136 @smallexample
21137 -target-list-parameters
21138 @end smallexample
21139
21140 @c ????
21141
21142 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21143
21144 No equivalent.
21145
21146 @subsubheading Example
21147 N.A.
21148
21149
21150 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
21151 @findex -target-select
21152
21153 @subsubheading Synopsis
21154
21155 @smallexample
21156 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
21157 @end smallexample
21158
21159 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
21160
21161 @table @samp
21162 @item @var{type}
21163 The type of target, for instance @samp{async}, @samp{remote}, etc.
21164 @item @var{parameters}
21165 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
21166 Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details.
21167 @end table
21168
21169 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
21170 which the target program is, in the following form:
21171
21172 @smallexample
21173 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
21174 args=[@var{arg list}]
21175 @end smallexample
21176
21177 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21178
21179 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
21180
21181 @subsubheading Example
21182
21183 @smallexample
21184 (gdb)
21185 -target-select async /dev/ttya
21186 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
21187 (gdb)
21188 @end smallexample
21189
21190 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21191 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
21192 @section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
21193
21194 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
21195
21196 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
21197 @findex -gdb-exit
21198
21199 @subsubheading Synopsis
21200
21201 @smallexample
21202 -gdb-exit
21203 @end smallexample
21204
21205 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
21206
21207 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21208
21209 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
21210
21211 @subsubheading Example
21212
21213 @smallexample
21214 (gdb)
21215 -gdb-exit
21216 ^exit
21217 @end smallexample
21218
21219
21220 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
21221 @findex -exec-abort
21222
21223 @subsubheading Synopsis
21224
21225 @smallexample
21226 -exec-abort
21227 @end smallexample
21228
21229 Kill the inferior running program.
21230
21231 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21232
21233 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
21234
21235 @subsubheading Example
21236 N.A.
21237
21238
21239 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
21240 @findex -gdb-set
21241
21242 @subsubheading Synopsis
21243
21244 @smallexample
21245 -gdb-set
21246 @end smallexample
21247
21248 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
21249 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
21250
21251 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21252
21253 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
21254
21255 @subsubheading Example
21256
21257 @smallexample
21258 (gdb)
21259 -gdb-set $foo=3
21260 ^done
21261 (gdb)
21262 @end smallexample
21263
21264
21265 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
21266 @findex -gdb-show
21267
21268 @subsubheading Synopsis
21269
21270 @smallexample
21271 -gdb-show
21272 @end smallexample
21273
21274 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
21275
21276 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21277
21278 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
21279
21280 @subsubheading Example
21281
21282 @smallexample
21283 (gdb)
21284 -gdb-show annotate
21285 ^done,value="0"
21286 (gdb)
21287 @end smallexample
21288
21289 @c @subheading -gdb-source
21290
21291
21292 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
21293 @findex -gdb-version
21294
21295 @subsubheading Synopsis
21296
21297 @smallexample
21298 -gdb-version
21299 @end smallexample
21300
21301 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
21302
21303 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21304
21305 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
21306 default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
21307
21308 @subsubheading Example
21309
21310 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
21311 @c box in TeX.
21312 @smallexample
21313 (gdb)
21314 -gdb-version
21315 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
21316 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
21317 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
21318 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
21319 ~ certain conditions.
21320 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
21321 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
21322 ~ details.
21323 ~This GDB was configured as
21324 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
21325 ^done
21326 (gdb)
21327 @end smallexample
21328
21329 @subheading The @code{-list-features} Command
21330 @findex -list-features
21331
21332 Returns a list of particular features of the MI protocol that
21333 this version of gdb implements. A feature can be a command,
21334 or a new field in an output of some command, or even an
21335 important bugfix. While a frontend can sometimes detect presence
21336 of a feature at runtime, it is easier to perform detection at debugger
21337 startup.
21338
21339 The command returns a list of strings, with each string naming an
21340 available feature. Each returned string is just a name, it does not
21341 have any internal structure. The list of possible feature names
21342 is given below.
21343
21344 Example output:
21345
21346 @smallexample
21347 (gdb) -list-features
21348 ^done,result=["feature1","feature2"]
21349 @end smallexample
21350
21351 The current list of features is:
21352
21353 @itemize @minus
21354 @item
21355 @samp{frozen-varobjs}---indicates presence of the
21356 @code{-var-set-frozen} command, as well as possible presense of the
21357 @code{frozen} field in the output of @code{-varobj-create}.
21358 @end itemize
21359
21360 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
21361 @findex -interpreter-exec
21362
21363 @subheading Synopsis
21364
21365 @smallexample
21366 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
21367 @end smallexample
21368 @anchor{-interpreter-exec}
21369
21370 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
21371
21372 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
21373
21374 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
21375
21376 @subheading Example
21377
21378 @smallexample
21379 (gdb)
21380 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
21381 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
21382 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
21383 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
21384 ^done
21385 (gdb)
21386 @end smallexample
21387
21388 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
21389 @findex -inferior-tty-set
21390
21391 @subheading Synopsis
21392
21393 @smallexample
21394 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
21395 @end smallexample
21396
21397 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
21398
21399 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
21400
21401 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
21402
21403 @subheading Example
21404
21405 @smallexample
21406 (gdb)
21407 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
21408 ^done
21409 (gdb)
21410 @end smallexample
21411
21412 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
21413 @findex -inferior-tty-show
21414
21415 @subheading Synopsis
21416
21417 @smallexample
21418 -inferior-tty-show
21419 @end smallexample
21420
21421 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
21422
21423 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
21424
21425 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
21426
21427 @subheading Example
21428
21429 @smallexample
21430 (gdb)
21431 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
21432 ^done
21433 (gdb)
21434 -inferior-tty-show
21435 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
21436 (gdb)
21437 @end smallexample
21438
21439 @subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command
21440 @findex -enable-timings
21441
21442 @subheading Synopsis
21443
21444 @smallexample
21445 -enable-timings [yes | no]
21446 @end smallexample
21447
21448 Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI
21449 command as a field in its output. This command is to help frontend
21450 developers optimize the performance of their code. No argument is
21451 equivalent to @samp{yes}.
21452
21453 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
21454
21455 No equivalent.
21456
21457 @subheading Example
21458
21459 @smallexample
21460 (gdb)
21461 -enable-timings
21462 ^done
21463 (gdb)
21464 -break-insert main
21465 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
21466 addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c",
21467 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",times="0"@},
21468 time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@}
21469 (gdb)
21470 -enable-timings no
21471 ^done
21472 (gdb)
21473 -exec-run
21474 ^running
21475 (gdb)
21476 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
21477 frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},
21478 @{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c",
21479 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73"@}
21480 (gdb)
21481 @end smallexample
21482
21483 @node Annotations
21484 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
21485
21486 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
21487 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
21488 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
21489 relatively high level.
21490
21491 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
21492 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
21493
21494 @ignore
21495 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
21496 @end ignore
21497
21498 @menu
21499 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
21500 * Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state.
21501 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
21502 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
21503 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
21504 * Annotations for Running::
21505 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
21506 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
21507 @end menu
21508
21509 @node Annotations Overview
21510 @section What is an Annotation?
21511 @cindex annotations
21512
21513 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
21514 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
21515 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
21516 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
21517 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
21518 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
21519 cannot contain newline characters.
21520
21521 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
21522 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
21523 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
21524 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
21525 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
21526 means those three characters as output.
21527
21528 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
21529 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
21530 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
21531 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
21532 is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
21533 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
21534 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
21535 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
21536 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
21537
21538 @table @code
21539 @kindex set annotate
21540 @item set annotate @var{level}
21541 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
21542 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
21543
21544 @item show annotate
21545 @kindex show annotate
21546 Show the current annotation level.
21547 @end table
21548
21549 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
21550
21551 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
21552
21553 @smallexample
21554 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
21555 GNU gdb 6.0
21556 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
21557 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
21558 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
21559 under certain conditions.
21560 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
21561 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
21562 for details.
21563 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
21564
21565 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
21566 (@value{GDBP})
21567 ^Z^Zprompt
21568 @kbd{quit}
21569
21570 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
21571 $
21572 @end smallexample
21573
21574 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
21575 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
21576 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
21577 output from @value{GDBN}.
21578
21579 @node Server Prefix
21580 @section The Server Prefix
21581 @cindex server prefix
21582
21583 If you prefix a command with @samp{server } then it will not affect
21584 the command history, nor will it affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which
21585 command to repeat if @key{RET} is pressed on a line by itself. This
21586 means that commands can be run behind a user's back by a front-end in
21587 a transparent manner.
21588
21589 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
21590 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
21591 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
21592
21593 @node Prompting
21594 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
21595
21596 @cindex annotations for prompts
21597 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
21598 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
21599 over, etc.
21600
21601 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
21602 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
21603 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
21604 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
21605 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
21606 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
21607 features the following annotations:
21608
21609 @smallexample
21610 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
21611 ^Z^Zprompt
21612 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
21613 @end smallexample
21614
21615 The input types are
21616
21617 @table @code
21618 @findex pre-prompt annotation
21619 @findex prompt annotation
21620 @findex post-prompt annotation
21621 @item prompt
21622 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
21623
21624 @findex pre-commands annotation
21625 @findex commands annotation
21626 @findex post-commands annotation
21627 @item commands
21628 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
21629 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
21630
21631 @findex pre-overload-choice annotation
21632 @findex overload-choice annotation
21633 @findex post-overload-choice annotation
21634 @item overload-choice
21635 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
21636
21637 @findex pre-query annotation
21638 @findex query annotation
21639 @findex post-query annotation
21640 @item query
21641 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
21642
21643 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
21644 @findex prompt-for-continue annotation
21645 @findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
21646 @item prompt-for-continue
21647 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
21648 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
21649 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
21650 presence of annotations.
21651 @end table
21652
21653 @node Errors
21654 @section Errors
21655 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
21656
21657 @findex quit annotation
21658 @smallexample
21659 ^Z^Zquit
21660 @end smallexample
21661
21662 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
21663
21664 @findex error annotation
21665 @smallexample
21666 ^Z^Zerror
21667 @end smallexample
21668
21669 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
21670
21671 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
21672 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
21673 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
21674 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
21675 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
21676 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
21677 to the top level.
21678
21679 @findex error-begin annotation
21680 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
21681
21682 @smallexample
21683 ^Z^Zerror-begin
21684 @end smallexample
21685
21686 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
21687 message.
21688
21689 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
21690 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
21691 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
21692
21693 @node Invalidation
21694 @section Invalidation Notices
21695
21696 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
21697 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
21698 changed.
21699
21700 @table @code
21701 @findex frames-invalid annotation
21702 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
21703
21704 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
21705 have changed.
21706
21707 @findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
21708 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
21709
21710 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
21711 deleted a breakpoint.
21712 @end table
21713
21714 @node Annotations for Running
21715 @section Running the Program
21716 @cindex annotations for running programs
21717
21718 @findex starting annotation
21719 @findex stopping annotation
21720 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
21721 @code{step} or @code{continue},
21722
21723 @smallexample
21724 ^Z^Zstarting
21725 @end smallexample
21726
21727 is output. When the program stops,
21728
21729 @smallexample
21730 ^Z^Zstopped
21731 @end smallexample
21732
21733 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
21734 annotations describe how the program stopped.
21735
21736 @table @code
21737 @findex exited annotation
21738 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
21739 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
21740 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
21741
21742 @findex signalled annotation
21743 @findex signal-name annotation
21744 @findex signal-name-end annotation
21745 @findex signal-string annotation
21746 @findex signal-string-end annotation
21747 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
21748 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
21749 annotation continues:
21750
21751 @smallexample
21752 @var{intro-text}
21753 ^Z^Zsignal-name
21754 @var{name}
21755 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
21756 @var{middle-text}
21757 ^Z^Zsignal-string
21758 @var{string}
21759 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
21760 @var{end-text}
21761 @end smallexample
21762
21763 @noindent
21764 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
21765 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
21766 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}.
21767 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
21768 user's benefit and have no particular format.
21769
21770 @findex signal annotation
21771 @item ^Z^Zsignal
21772 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
21773 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
21774 terminated with it.
21775
21776 @findex breakpoint annotation
21777 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
21778 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
21779
21780 @findex watchpoint annotation
21781 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
21782 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
21783 @end table
21784
21785 @node Source Annotations
21786 @section Displaying Source
21787 @cindex annotations for source display
21788
21789 @findex source annotation
21790 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
21791
21792 @smallexample
21793 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
21794 @end smallexample
21795
21796 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
21797 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
21798 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
21799 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
21800 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
21801 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
21802 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
21803 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
21804 source which is being displayed. @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
21805 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
21806 depend on the language).
21807
21808 @node GDB Bugs
21809 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
21810 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
21811 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
21812
21813 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
21814
21815 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
21816 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
21817 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
21818 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
21819
21820 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
21821 information that enables us to fix the bug.
21822
21823 @menu
21824 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
21825 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
21826 @end menu
21827
21828 @node Bug Criteria
21829 @section Have You Found a Bug?
21830 @cindex bug criteria
21831
21832 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
21833
21834 @itemize @bullet
21835 @cindex fatal signal
21836 @cindex debugger crash
21837 @cindex crash of debugger
21838 @item
21839 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
21840 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
21841
21842 @cindex error on valid input
21843 @item
21844 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
21845 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
21846 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
21847
21848 @cindex invalid input
21849 @item
21850 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
21851 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
21852 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
21853 for traditional practice''.
21854
21855 @item
21856 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
21857 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
21858 @end itemize
21859
21860 @node Bug Reporting
21861 @section How to Report Bugs
21862 @cindex bug reports
21863 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
21864
21865 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
21866 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
21867 contact that organization first.
21868
21869 You can find contact information for many support companies and
21870 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
21871 distribution.
21872 @c should add a web page ref...
21873
21874 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
21875 @value{GDBN}. The preferred method is to submit them directly using
21876 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
21877 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
21878 be used.
21879
21880 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
21881 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
21882 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
21883 @samp{bug-gdb}.
21884
21885 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
21886 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
21887 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
21888 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
21889 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
21890 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
21891 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
21892 bug reports to the mailing list.
21893
21894 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
21895 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
21896 fact or leave it out, state it!
21897
21898 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
21899 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
21900 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
21901 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
21902 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
21903 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
21904 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
21905 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
21906 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
21907
21908 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
21909 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
21910 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
21911 self-contained.
21912
21913 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
21914 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
21915 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
21916 bugs properly.
21917
21918 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
21919
21920 @itemize @bullet
21921 @item
21922 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
21923 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
21924 version}.
21925
21926 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
21927 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
21928
21929 @item
21930 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
21931 version number.
21932
21933 @item
21934 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
21935 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
21936
21937 @item
21938 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
21939 debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
21940 C Compiler''. For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version}
21941 to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for
21942 those compilers.
21943
21944 @item
21945 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
21946 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
21947 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
21948 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
21949
21950 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
21951 and then we might not encounter the bug.
21952
21953 @item
21954 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
21955 reproduce the bug.
21956
21957 @item
21958 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
21959 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
21960
21961 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
21962 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
21963 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
21964 a chance to make a mistake.
21965
21966 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
21967 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
21968 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
21969 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
21970 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
21971 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
21972 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
21973 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
21974
21975 @pindex script
21976 @cindex recording a session script
21977 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
21978 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
21979 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
21980 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
21981
21982 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
21983 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
21984
21985 @item
21986 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
21987 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
21988 it by context, not by line number.
21989
21990 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
21991 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
21992
21993 @end itemize
21994
21995 Here are some things that are not necessary:
21996
21997 @itemize @bullet
21998 @item
21999 A description of the envelope of the bug.
22000
22001 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
22002 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
22003 changes will not affect it.
22004
22005 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
22006 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
22007 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
22008 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
22009
22010 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
22011 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
22012 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
22013 less time, and so on.
22014
22015 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
22016 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
22017
22018 @item
22019 A patch for the bug.
22020
22021 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
22022 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
22023 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
22024 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
22025
22026 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
22027 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
22028 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
22029 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
22030
22031 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
22032 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
22033 help us to understand.
22034
22035 @item
22036 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
22037
22038 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
22039 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
22040 @end itemize
22041
22042 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
22043 @c and consists of the two following files:
22044 @c rluser.texinfo
22045 @c inc-hist.texinfo
22046 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
22047 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
22048 @include rluser.texi
22049 @include inc-hist.texinfo
22050
22051
22052 @node Formatting Documentation
22053 @appendix Formatting Documentation
22054
22055 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
22056 @cindex reference card
22057 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
22058 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
22059 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
22060 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
22061 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
22062 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
22063
22064 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
22065 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
22066
22067 @smallexample
22068 make refcard.dvi
22069 @end smallexample
22070
22071 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
22072 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
22073 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
22074 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
22075 your @sc{dvi} output program.
22076
22077 @cindex documentation
22078
22079 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
22080 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
22081 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
22082 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
22083 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
22084 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
22085
22086 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
22087 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
22088 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
22089 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
22090 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
22091 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
22092 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
22093 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
22094
22095 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
22096 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
22097 @code{makeinfo}.
22098
22099 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
22100 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
22101 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
22102
22103 @smallexample
22104 cd gdb
22105 make gdb.info
22106 @end smallexample
22107
22108 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
22109 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
22110 Texinfo definitions file.
22111
22112 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
22113 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
22114 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
22115 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
22116 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
22117 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
22118 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
22119
22120 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
22121 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
22122 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
22123 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
22124 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
22125 directory.
22126
22127 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
22128 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the @file{gdb}
22129 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
22130 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
22131
22132 @smallexample
22133 make gdb.dvi
22134 @end smallexample
22135
22136 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
22137
22138 @node Installing GDB
22139 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
22140 @cindex installation
22141
22142 @menu
22143 * Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
22144 * Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script
22145 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
22146 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
22147 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
22148 @end menu
22149
22150 @node Requirements
22151 @section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN}
22152 @cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
22153
22154 Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
22155 Other packages will be used only if they are found.
22156
22157 @heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN}
22158 @table @asis
22159 @item ISO C90 compiler
22160 @value{GDBN} is written in ISO C90. It should be buildable with any
22161 working C90 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
22162
22163 @end table
22164
22165 @heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN}
22166 @table @asis
22167 @item Expat
22168 @anchor{Expat}
22169 @value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
22170 included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
22171 can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
22172 The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several
22173 standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
22174 use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
22175
22176 Expat is used for remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format})
22177 and for target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions}).
22178
22179 @end table
22180
22181 @node Running Configure
22182 @section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script
22183 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
22184 @value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process
22185 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
22186 build the @code{gdb} program.
22187 @iftex
22188 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
22189 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
22190 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
22191 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
22192 @end iftex
22193
22194 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
22195 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
22196 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
22197
22198 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
22199 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
22200
22201 @table @code
22202 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
22203 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
22204
22205 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
22206 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
22207
22208 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
22209 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
22210
22211 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
22212 @sc{gnu} include files
22213
22214 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
22215 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
22216
22217 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
22218 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
22219
22220 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
22221 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
22222
22223 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
22224 source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
22225
22226 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
22227 source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
22228 @end table
22229
22230 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure}
22231 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
22232 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
22233
22234 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
22235 if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}. Pass the
22236 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
22237 argument.
22238
22239 For example:
22240
22241 @smallexample
22242 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
22243 ./configure @var{host}
22244 make
22245 @end smallexample
22246
22247 @noindent
22248 where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
22249 @samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
22250 (You can often leave off @var{host}; @file{configure} tries to guess the
22251 correct value by examining your system.)
22252
22253 Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
22254 @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
22255 libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
22256 binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
22257
22258 @need 750
22259 @file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
22260 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
22261 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
22262
22263 @smallexample
22264 sh configure @var{host}
22265 @end smallexample
22266
22267 If you run @file{configure} from a directory that contains source
22268 directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
22269 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN},
22270 @file{configure}
22271 creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
22272 you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
22273
22274 You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the
22275 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
22276 @file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
22277 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
22278 if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
22279 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
22280 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
22281 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
22282 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
22283
22284 You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
22285 However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
22286 the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
22287 that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
22288 let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
22289
22290 @node Separate Objdir
22291 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory
22292
22293 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
22294 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
22295 host and target. @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by
22296 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
22297 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
22298 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
22299 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
22300 program specified there.
22301
22302 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure}
22303 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
22304 (You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure}
22305 itself from your working directory. If the path to @file{configure}
22306 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
22307 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
22308
22309 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
22310 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
22311
22312 @smallexample
22313 @group
22314 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
22315 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
22316 cd ../gdb-sun4
22317 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
22318 make
22319 @end group
22320 @end smallexample
22321
22322 When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
22323 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
22324 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
22325 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
22326 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
22327 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
22328
22329 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
22330 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
22331 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
22332 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
22333 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
22334
22335 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
22336 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
22337 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
22338 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
22339 You specify a cross-debugging target by
22340 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}.
22341
22342 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
22343 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
22344 called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
22345
22346 The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source
22347 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
22348 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
22349 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
22350 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
22351
22352 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
22353 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
22354 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
22355 with each other.
22356
22357 @node Config Names
22358 @section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets
22359
22360 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure}
22361 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
22362 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
22363 of information in the following pattern:
22364
22365 @smallexample
22366 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
22367 @end smallexample
22368
22369 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
22370 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
22371 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
22372
22373 The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
22374 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
22375 aliases. @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
22376 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
22377 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
22378 abbreviations---for example:
22379
22380 @smallexample
22381 % sh config.sub i386-linux
22382 i386-pc-linux-gnu
22383 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
22384 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
22385 % sh config.sub hp9k700
22386 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
22387 % sh config.sub sun4
22388 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
22389 % sh config.sub sun3
22390 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
22391 % sh config.sub i986v
22392 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
22393 @end smallexample
22394
22395 @noindent
22396 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
22397 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
22398
22399 @node Configure Options
22400 @section @file{configure} Options
22401
22402 Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that
22403 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @file{configure} also has
22404 several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
22405 Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @file{configure}.
22406
22407 @smallexample
22408 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
22409 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
22410 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
22411 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
22412 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
22413 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
22414 @var{host}
22415 @end smallexample
22416
22417 @noindent
22418 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
22419 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
22420 @samp{--}.
22421
22422 @table @code
22423 @item --help
22424 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}.
22425
22426 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
22427 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
22428 @file{@var{dir}}.
22429
22430 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
22431 Configure the source to install programs under directory
22432 @file{@var{dir}}.
22433
22434 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
22435 @need 2000
22436 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
22437 @strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
22438 @code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
22439 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
22440 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
22441 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
22442 directories. @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in
22443 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
22444 directory @var{dirname}. @file{configure} creates directories under
22445 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
22446 @var{dirname}.
22447
22448 @item --norecursion
22449 Configure only the directory level where @file{configure} is executed; do not
22450 propagate configuration to subdirectories.
22451
22452 @item --target=@var{target}
22453 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
22454 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
22455 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
22456
22457 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
22458
22459 @item @var{host} @dots{}
22460 Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
22461
22462 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
22463 @end table
22464
22465 There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
22466 needed for special purposes only.
22467
22468 @node Maintenance Commands
22469 @appendix Maintenance Commands
22470 @cindex maintenance commands
22471 @cindex internal commands
22472
22473 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
22474 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
22475 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
22476 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
22477 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
22478
22479 @table @code
22480 @kindex maint agent
22481 @item maint agent @var{expression}
22482 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
22483 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
22484 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}).
22485
22486 @kindex maint info breakpoints
22487 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
22488 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
22489 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
22490 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
22491 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
22492 is shown:
22493
22494 @table @code
22495 @item breakpoint
22496 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
22497
22498 @item watchpoint
22499 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
22500
22501 @item longjmp
22502 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
22503 @code{longjmp} calls.
22504
22505 @item longjmp resume
22506 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
22507
22508 @item until
22509 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
22510
22511 @item finish
22512 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
22513
22514 @item shlib events
22515 Shared library events.
22516
22517 @end table
22518
22519 @kindex maint check-symtabs
22520 @item maint check-symtabs
22521 Check the consistency of psymtabs and symtabs.
22522
22523 @kindex maint cplus first_component
22524 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
22525 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
22526
22527 @kindex maint cplus namespace
22528 @item maint cplus namespace
22529 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
22530
22531 @kindex maint demangle
22532 @item maint demangle @var{name}
22533 Demangle a C@t{++} or Objective-C mangled @var{name}.
22534
22535 @kindex maint deprecate
22536 @kindex maint undeprecate
22537 @cindex deprecated commands
22538 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
22539 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
22540 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
22541 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
22542 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
22543 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
22544 the replacement as part of the warning.
22545
22546 @kindex maint dump-me
22547 @item maint dump-me
22548 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
22549 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
22550 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
22551 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
22552
22553 @kindex maint internal-error
22554 @kindex maint internal-warning
22555 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
22556 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
22557 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error}
22558 or @code{internal_warning} and hence behave as though an internal error
22559 or internal warning has been detected. In addition to reporting the
22560 internal problem, these functions give the user the opportunity to
22561 either quit @value{GDBN} or create a core file of the current
22562 @value{GDBN} session.
22563
22564 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
22565 used as the text of the error or warning message.
22566
22567 Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}:
22568
22569 @smallexample
22570 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
22571 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
22572 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
22573 debugging may prove unreliable.
22574 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
22575 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
22576 (@value{GDBP})
22577 @end smallexample
22578
22579 @kindex maint packet
22580 @item maint packet @var{text}
22581 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
22582 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
22583 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
22584 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
22585 checksum.
22586
22587 @kindex maint print architecture
22588 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22589 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
22590 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
22591
22592 @kindex maint print c-tdesc
22593 @item maint print c-tdesc
22594 Print the current target description (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) as
22595 a C source file. The created source file can be used in @value{GDBN}
22596 when an XML parser is not available to parse the description.
22597
22598 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
22599 @item maint print dummy-frames
22600 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
22601
22602 @smallexample
22603 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
22604 @dots{}
22605 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
22606 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
22607 58 return (a + b);
22608 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
22609 @dots{}
22610 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
22611 0x1a57c80: pc=0x01014068 fp=0x0200bddc sp=0x0200bdd6
22612 top=0x0200bdd4 id=@{stack=0x200bddc,code=0x101405c@}
22613 call_lo=0x01014000 call_hi=0x01014001
22614 (@value{GDBP})
22615 @end smallexample
22616
22617 Takes an optional file parameter.
22618
22619 @kindex maint print registers
22620 @kindex maint print raw-registers
22621 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
22622 @kindex maint print register-groups
22623 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22624 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22625 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22626 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22627 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
22628
22629 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
22630 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print cooked-registers}
22631 includes the (cooked) value of all registers; and the command
22632 @code{maint print register-groups} includes the groups that each
22633 register is a member of. @xref{Registers,, Registers, gdbint,
22634 @value{GDBN} Internals}.
22635
22636 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
22637 write the information.
22638
22639 @kindex maint print reggroups
22640 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22641 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
22642 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
22643 information.
22644
22645 The register groups info looks like this:
22646
22647 @smallexample
22648 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
22649 Group Type
22650 general user
22651 float user
22652 all user
22653 vector user
22654 system user
22655 save internal
22656 restore internal
22657 @end smallexample
22658
22659 @kindex flushregs
22660 @item flushregs
22661 This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
22662
22663 @kindex maint print objfiles
22664 @cindex info for known object files
22665 @item maint print objfiles
22666 Print a dump of all known object files. For each object file, this
22667 command prints its name, address in memory, and all of its psymtabs
22668 and symtabs.
22669
22670 @kindex maint print statistics
22671 @cindex bcache statistics
22672 @item maint print statistics
22673 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
22674 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
22675 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
22676 of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
22677 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
22678 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
22679 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
22680 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
22681 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
22682 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
22683 lengths.
22684
22685 @kindex maint print target-stack
22686 @cindex target stack description
22687 @item maint print target-stack
22688 A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular
22689 kind of file or process. Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata},
22690 so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request.
22691 In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets
22692 until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular
22693 address.
22694
22695 This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on
22696 the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one.
22697
22698 @kindex maint print type
22699 @cindex type chain of a data type
22700 @item maint print type @var{expr}
22701 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
22702 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
22703 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
22704 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
22705 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
22706
22707 @kindex maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
22708 @kindex maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
22709 @item maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
22710 @itemx maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
22711 Control the DWARF 2 compilation unit cache.
22712
22713 @cindex DWARF 2 compilation units cache
22714 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
22715 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF 2
22716 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
22717 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
22718 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
22719 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
22720 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
22721 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
22722
22723 @kindex maint set profile
22724 @kindex maint show profile
22725 @cindex profiling GDB
22726 @item maint set profile
22727 @itemx maint show profile
22728 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
22729
22730 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
22731 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
22732 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
22733 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
22734 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
22735 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
22736 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
22737
22738 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
22739 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
22740
22741 @kindex maint show-debug-regs
22742 @cindex x86 hardware debug registers
22743 @item maint show-debug-regs
22744 Control whether to show variables that mirror the x86 hardware debug
22745 registers. Use @code{ON} to enable, @code{OFF} to disable. If
22746 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or
22747 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
22748 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
22749
22750 @kindex maint space
22751 @cindex memory used by commands
22752 @item maint space
22753 Control whether to display memory usage for each command. If set to a
22754 nonzero value, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
22755 took, following the command's own output. This can also be requested
22756 by invoking @value{GDBN} with the @option{--statistics} command-line
22757 switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
22758
22759 @kindex maint time
22760 @cindex time of command execution
22761 @item maint time
22762 Control whether to display the execution time for each command. If
22763 set to a nonzero value, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
22764 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
22765 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
22766 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
22767
22768 @kindex maint translate-address
22769 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
22770 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
22771 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
22772 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
22773 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
22774 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
22775 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
22776
22777 @end table
22778
22779 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
22780 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
22781
22782 @table @code
22783 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
22784 @kindex set watchdog
22785 @cindex watchdog timer
22786 @cindex timeout for commands
22787 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
22788 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
22789 reports and error and the command is aborted.
22790
22791 @item show watchdog
22792 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
22793 @end table
22794
22795 @node Remote Protocol
22796 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
22797
22798 @menu
22799 * Overview::
22800 * Packets::
22801 * Stop Reply Packets::
22802 * General Query Packets::
22803 * Register Packet Format::
22804 * Tracepoint Packets::
22805 * Interrupts::
22806 * Examples::
22807 * File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension::
22808 * Library List Format::
22809 * Memory Map Format::
22810 @end menu
22811
22812 @node Overview
22813 @section Overview
22814
22815 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
22816 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
22817 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
22818 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
22819
22820 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
22821 transmitted and received data, respectively.
22822
22823 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
22824 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
22825 @cindex remote serial protocol
22826 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments) are
22827 sent as a @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
22828 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
22829 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
22830
22831 @smallexample
22832 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
22833 @end smallexample
22834 @noindent
22835
22836 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
22837 @noindent
22838 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
22839 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
22840 eight bit unsigned checksum).
22841
22842 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
22843 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
22844
22845 @smallexample
22846 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
22847 @end smallexample
22848
22849 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
22850 @noindent
22851 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
22852 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
22853 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
22854
22855 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
22856 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
22857 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
22858 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
22859 retransmission):
22860
22861 @smallexample
22862 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
22863 <- @code{+}
22864 @end smallexample
22865 @noindent
22866
22867 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
22868 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
22869 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
22870 when the operation has completed (the target has again stopped).
22871
22872 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
22873 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
22874 exceptions).
22875
22876 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
22877 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
22878 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
22879 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
22880
22881 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
22882 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
22883 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
22884
22885 @cindex remote protocol, binary data
22886 @anchor{Binary Data}
22887 Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
22888 digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
22889 protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
22890 Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
22891 connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
22892 binary data.
22893
22894 The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
22895 as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
22896 character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
22897 For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
22898 bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
22899 @code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
22900 @samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
22901 must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
22902 is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
22903 (described next).
22904
22905 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space. A @samp{*}
22906 means that the next character is an @sc{ascii} encoding giving a repeat count
22907 which stands for that many repetitions of the character preceding the
22908 @samp{*}. The encoding is @code{n+29}, yielding a printable character
22909 where @code{n >=3} (which is where rle starts to win). The printable
22910 characters @samp{$}, @samp{#}, @samp{+} and @samp{-} or with a numeric
22911 value greater than 126 should not be used.
22912
22913 So:
22914 @smallexample
22915 "@code{0* }"
22916 @end smallexample
22917 @noindent
22918 means the same as "0000".
22919
22920 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
22921 error number. That number is not well defined.
22922
22923 @cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
22924 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
22925 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
22926 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
22927 on that response.
22928
22929 A stub is required to support the @samp{g}, @samp{G}, @samp{m}, @samp{M},
22930 @samp{c}, and @samp{s} @var{command}s. All other @var{command}s are
22931 optional.
22932
22933 @node Packets
22934 @section Packets
22935
22936 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
22937 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
22938 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File
22939 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
22940
22941 Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
22942 syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
22943 include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
22944 part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
22945 separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
22946 @var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
22947 bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
22948 @var{baz}. @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the
22949 @samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
22950 @var{baz}.
22951
22952 Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
22953 letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
22954
22955 Here are the packet descriptions.
22956
22957 @table @samp
22958
22959 @item !
22960 @cindex @samp{!} packet
22961 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
22962 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
22963 debugged.
22964
22965 Reply:
22966 @table @samp
22967 @item OK
22968 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
22969 @end table
22970
22971 @item ?
22972 @cindex @samp{?} packet
22973 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
22974 step and continue.
22975
22976 Reply:
22977 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
22978
22979 @item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
22980 @cindex @samp{A} packet
22981 Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
22982 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
22983 @var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
22984
22985 Reply:
22986 @table @samp
22987 @item OK
22988 The arguments were set.
22989 @item E @var{NN}
22990 An error occurred.
22991 @end table
22992
22993 @item b @var{baud}
22994 @cindex @samp{b} packet
22995 (Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
22996 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
22997
22998 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
22999 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
23000 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
23001
23002 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
23003 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
23004 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
23005 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
23006 of view, nothing actually happened.}
23007
23008 @item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
23009 @cindex @samp{B} packet
23010 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
23011 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
23012
23013 Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
23014 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
23015
23016 @item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
23017 @cindex @samp{c} packet
23018 Continue. @var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted,
23019 resume at current address.
23020
23021 Reply:
23022 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
23023
23024 @item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
23025 @cindex @samp{C} packet
23026 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
23027 @samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
23028
23029 Reply:
23030 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
23031
23032 @item d
23033 @cindex @samp{d} packet
23034 Toggle debug flag.
23035
23036 Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
23037 (@pxref{General Query Packets}).
23038
23039 @item D
23040 @cindex @samp{D} packet
23041 Detach @value{GDBN} from the remote system. Sent to the remote target
23042 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
23043
23044 Reply:
23045 @table @samp
23046 @item OK
23047 for success
23048 @item E @var{NN}
23049 for an error
23050 @end table
23051
23052 @item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
23053 @cindex @samp{F} packet
23054 A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
23055 This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
23056 Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification.
23057
23058 @item g
23059 @anchor{read registers packet}
23060 @cindex @samp{g} packet
23061 Read general registers.
23062
23063 Reply:
23064 @table @samp
23065 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
23066 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
23067 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
23068 each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
23069 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal gdbarch functions
23070 @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{gdbarch_register_name}. The
23071 specification of several standard @samp{g} packets is specified below.
23072 @item E @var{NN}
23073 for an error.
23074 @end table
23075
23076 @item G @var{XX@dots{}}
23077 @cindex @samp{G} packet
23078 Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
23079 description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
23080
23081 Reply:
23082 @table @samp
23083 @item OK
23084 for success
23085 @item E @var{NN}
23086 for an error
23087 @end table
23088
23089 @item H @var{c} @var{t}
23090 @cindex @samp{H} packet
23091 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
23092 @samp{G}, et.al.). @var{c} depends on the operation to be performed: it
23093 should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations, @samp{g} for other
23094 operations. The thread designator @var{t} may be @samp{-1}, meaning all
23095 the threads, a thread number, or @samp{0} which means pick any thread.
23096
23097 Reply:
23098 @table @samp
23099 @item OK
23100 for success
23101 @item E @var{NN}
23102 for an error
23103 @end table
23104
23105 @c FIXME: JTC:
23106 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
23107 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
23108 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
23109 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
23110 @c described. For example:
23111 @c
23112 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
23113 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
23114 @c otherwise returns current registers.
23115 @c
23116 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
23117 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
23118 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
23119
23120 @item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
23121 @anchor{cycle step packet}
23122 @cindex @samp{i} packet
23123 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
23124 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
23125 step starting at that address.
23126
23127 @item I
23128 @cindex @samp{I} packet
23129 Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
23130 step packet}.
23131
23132 @item k
23133 @cindex @samp{k} packet
23134 Kill request.
23135
23136 FIXME: @emph{There is no description of how to operate when a specific
23137 thread context has been selected (i.e.@: does 'k' kill only that
23138 thread?)}.
23139
23140 @item m @var{addr},@var{length}
23141 @cindex @samp{m} packet
23142 Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
23143 Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to any particular boundary.
23144
23145 The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
23146 data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
23147 and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
23148 use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
23149 suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
23150 @cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
23151 @cindex size of remote memory accesses
23152 @cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
23153
23154 Reply:
23155 @table @samp
23156 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
23157 Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal
23158 number. The reply may contain fewer bytes than requested if the
23159 server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
23160 @item E @var{NN}
23161 @var{NN} is errno
23162 @end table
23163
23164 @item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
23165 @cindex @samp{M} packet
23166 Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
23167 @var{XX@dots{}} is the data; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit
23168 hexadecimal number.
23169
23170 Reply:
23171 @table @samp
23172 @item OK
23173 for success
23174 @item E @var{NN}
23175 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
23176 written).
23177 @end table
23178
23179 @item p @var{n}
23180 @cindex @samp{p} packet
23181 Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
23182 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
23183 register value is encoded.
23184
23185 Reply:
23186 @table @samp
23187 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
23188 the register's value
23189 @item E @var{NN}
23190 for an error
23191 @item
23192 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
23193 @end table
23194
23195 @item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
23196 @anchor{write register packet}
23197 @cindex @samp{P} packet
23198 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
23199 number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
23200 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
23201
23202 Reply:
23203 @table @samp
23204 @item OK
23205 for success
23206 @item E @var{NN}
23207 for an error
23208 @end table
23209
23210 @item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
23211 @itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
23212 @cindex @samp{q} packet
23213 @cindex @samp{Q} packet
23214 General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
23215 described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
23216
23217 @item r
23218 @cindex @samp{r} packet
23219 Reset the entire system.
23220
23221 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
23222
23223 @item R @var{XX}
23224 @cindex @samp{R} packet
23225 Restart the program being debugged. @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
23226 This packet is only available in extended mode.
23227
23228 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
23229
23230 @item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
23231 @cindex @samp{s} packet
23232 Single step. @var{addr} is the address at which to resume. If
23233 @var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
23234
23235 Reply:
23236 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
23237
23238 @item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
23239 @anchor{step with signal packet}
23240 @cindex @samp{S} packet
23241 Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
23242 requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
23243
23244 Reply:
23245 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
23246
23247 @item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
23248 @cindex @samp{t} packet
23249 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
23250 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}. @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4 bytes.
23251 @var{addr} must be at least 3 digits.
23252
23253 @item T @var{XX}
23254 @cindex @samp{T} packet
23255 Find out if the thread XX is alive.
23256
23257 Reply:
23258 @table @samp
23259 @item OK
23260 thread is still alive
23261 @item E @var{NN}
23262 thread is dead
23263 @end table
23264
23265 @item v
23266 Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
23267 up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
23268
23269 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{tid}@r{]]}@dots{}
23270 @cindex @samp{vCont} packet
23271 Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
23272 If an action is specified with no @var{tid}, then it is applied to any
23273 threads that don't have a specific action specified; if no default action is
23274 specified then other threads should remain stopped. Specifying multiple
23275 default actions is an error; specifying no actions is also an error.
23276 Thread IDs are specified in hexadecimal. Currently supported actions are:
23277
23278 @table @samp
23279 @item c
23280 Continue.
23281 @item C @var{sig}
23282 Continue with signal @var{sig}. @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
23283 @item s
23284 Step.
23285 @item S @var{sig}
23286 Step with signal @var{sig}. @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
23287 @end table
23288
23289 The optional @var{addr} argument normally associated with these packets is
23290 not supported in @samp{vCont}.
23291
23292 Reply:
23293 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
23294
23295 @item vCont?
23296 @cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
23297 Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet.
23298
23299 Reply:
23300 @table @samp
23301 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
23302 The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
23303 command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
23304 @item
23305 The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
23306 @end table
23307
23308 @item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
23309 @cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
23310 Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
23311 @var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
23312 its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
23313 flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map
23314 Format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
23315 together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
23316 stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
23317 packet is received.
23318
23319 Reply:
23320 @table @samp
23321 @item OK
23322 for success
23323 @item E @var{NN}
23324 for an error
23325 @end table
23326
23327 @item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
23328 @cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
23329 Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
23330 is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
23331 packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
23332 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
23333 not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
23334 (although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
23335 have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
23336 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
23337 neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
23338 target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
23339
23340
23341 Reply:
23342 @table @samp
23343 @item OK
23344 for success
23345 @item E.memtype
23346 for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
23347 @item E @var{NN}
23348 for an error
23349 @end table
23350
23351 @item vFlashDone
23352 @cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
23353 Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
23354 The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
23355 @samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
23356 @samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
23357 regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
23358 request is completed.
23359
23360 @item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
23361 @anchor{X packet}
23362 @cindex @samp{X} packet
23363 Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
23364 @var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes,
23365 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
23366
23367 Reply:
23368 @table @samp
23369 @item OK
23370 for success
23371 @item E @var{NN}
23372 for an error
23373 @end table
23374
23375 @item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{length}
23376 @itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{length}
23377 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
23378 @cindex @samp{z} packet
23379 @cindex @samp{Z} packets
23380 Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
23381 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} and covering the next
23382 @var{length} bytes.
23383
23384 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
23385 separately.
23386
23387 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
23388 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
23389 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
23390 @samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
23391 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
23392 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
23393
23394 @item z0,@var{addr},@var{length}
23395 @itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{length}
23396 @cindex @samp{z0} packet
23397 @cindex @samp{Z0} packet
23398 Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a memory breakpoint at address
23399 @var{addr} of size @var{length}.
23400
23401 A memory breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
23402 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
23403 @var{length} is used by targets that indicates the size of the
23404 breakpoint (in bytes) that should be inserted (e.g., the @sc{arm} and
23405 @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint).
23406
23407 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
23408 code that contains memory breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
23409 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
23410 target, is not defined.}
23411
23412 Reply:
23413 @table @samp
23414 @item OK
23415 success
23416 @item
23417 not supported
23418 @item E @var{NN}
23419 for an error
23420 @end table
23421
23422 @item z1,@var{addr},@var{length}
23423 @itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{length}
23424 @cindex @samp{z1} packet
23425 @cindex @samp{Z1} packet
23426 Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
23427 address @var{addr} of size @var{length}.
23428
23429 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
23430 dependant on being able to modify the target's memory.
23431
23432 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
23433 movement.}
23434
23435 Reply:
23436 @table @samp
23437 @item OK
23438 success
23439 @item
23440 not supported
23441 @item E @var{NN}
23442 for an error
23443 @end table
23444
23445 @item z2,@var{addr},@var{length}
23446 @itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{length}
23447 @cindex @samp{z2} packet
23448 @cindex @samp{Z2} packet
23449 Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint.
23450
23451 Reply:
23452 @table @samp
23453 @item OK
23454 success
23455 @item
23456 not supported
23457 @item E @var{NN}
23458 for an error
23459 @end table
23460
23461 @item z3,@var{addr},@var{length}
23462 @itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{length}
23463 @cindex @samp{z3} packet
23464 @cindex @samp{Z3} packet
23465 Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint.
23466
23467 Reply:
23468 @table @samp
23469 @item OK
23470 success
23471 @item
23472 not supported
23473 @item E @var{NN}
23474 for an error
23475 @end table
23476
23477 @item z4,@var{addr},@var{length}
23478 @itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{length}
23479 @cindex @samp{z4} packet
23480 @cindex @samp{Z4} packet
23481 Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint.
23482
23483 Reply:
23484 @table @samp
23485 @item OK
23486 success
23487 @item
23488 not supported
23489 @item E @var{NN}
23490 for an error
23491 @end table
23492
23493 @end table
23494
23495 @node Stop Reply Packets
23496 @section Stop Reply Packets
23497 @cindex stop reply packets
23498
23499 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s} and @samp{?} packets can
23500 receive any of the below as a reply. In the case of the @samp{C},
23501 @samp{c}, @samp{S} and @samp{s} packets, that reply is only returned
23502 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
23503 number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
23504 @value{GDBN} source code.
23505
23506 As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
23507 reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
23508 syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
23509 components.
23510
23511 @table @samp
23512
23513 @item S @var{AA}
23514 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
23515 number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
23516 @var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
23517
23518 @item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
23519 @cindex @samp{T} packet reply
23520 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
23521 number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
23522 @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
23523 and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
23524 round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
23525 this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
23526
23527 @itemize @bullet
23528 @item
23529 If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
23530 corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. @var{r} is a
23531 series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
23532 two-digit hex number.
23533
23534 @item
23535 If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the thread process ID, in
23536 hex.
23537
23538 @item
23539 If @var{n} is a recognized @dfn{stop reason}, it describes a more
23540 specific event that stopped the target. The currently defined stop
23541 reasons are listed below. @var{aa} should be @samp{05}, the trap
23542 signal. At most one stop reason should be present.
23543
23544 @item
23545 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
23546 and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
23547 future.
23548 @end itemize
23549
23550 The currently defined stop reasons are:
23551
23552 @table @samp
23553 @item watch
23554 @itemx rwatch
23555 @itemx awatch
23556 The packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
23557 hex.
23558
23559 @cindex shared library events, remote reply
23560 @item library
23561 The packet indicates that the loaded libraries have changed.
23562 @value{GDBN} should use @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} to fetch a new
23563 list of loaded libraries. @var{r} is ignored.
23564 @end table
23565
23566 @item W @var{AA}
23567 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
23568 applicable to certain targets.
23569
23570 @item X @var{AA}
23571 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
23572
23573 @item O @var{XX}@dots{}
23574 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
23575 written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
23576 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
23577 for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc.
23578
23579 @item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
23580 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
23581 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
23582 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
23583 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented
23584 system calls.
23585
23586 @samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
23587 this very system call.
23588
23589 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
23590 call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
23591 with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
23592 reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
23593 or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O Remote
23594 Protocol Extension}, for more details.
23595
23596 @end table
23597
23598 @node General Query Packets
23599 @section General Query Packets
23600 @cindex remote query requests
23601
23602 Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
23603 packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
23604 query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
23605 sending information to and from the stub.
23606
23607 The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
23608 indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
23609 @value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
23610 definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
23611 conventions:
23612
23613 @itemize @bullet
23614 @item
23615 The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
23616 @item
23617 Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
23618 letter.
23619 @item
23620 The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
23621 lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
23622 the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
23623 foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
23624 @end itemize
23625
23626 The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
23627 parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
23628 separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
23629 full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
23630 in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
23631 with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
23632 packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
23633 for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
23634 are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
23635 existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
23636 packet.}.
23637
23638 Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
23639 has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
23640 explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
23641 templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
23642 @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
23643
23644 Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
23645
23646 @table @samp
23647
23648 @item qC
23649 @cindex current thread, remote request
23650 @cindex @samp{qC} packet
23651 Return the current thread id.
23652
23653 Reply:
23654 @table @samp
23655 @item QC @var{pid}
23656 Where @var{pid} is an unsigned hexadecimal process id.
23657 @item @r{(anything else)}
23658 Any other reply implies the old pid.
23659 @end table
23660
23661 @item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
23662 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
23663 @cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
23664 Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory.
23665 Reply:
23666 @table @samp
23667 @item E @var{NN}
23668 An error (such as memory fault)
23669 @item C @var{crc32}
23670 The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
23671 @end table
23672
23673 @item qfThreadInfo
23674 @itemx qsThreadInfo
23675 @cindex list active threads, remote request
23676 @cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
23677 @cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
23678 Obtain a list of all active thread ids from the target (OS). Since there
23679 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
23680 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
23681 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
23682 be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
23683 sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
23684
23685 NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
23686
23687 Reply:
23688 @table @samp
23689 @item m @var{id}
23690 A single thread id
23691 @item m @var{id},@var{id}@dots{}
23692 a comma-separated list of thread ids
23693 @item l
23694 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
23695 @end table
23696
23697 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
23698 more thread ids, in big-endian unsigned hex, separated by commas.
23699 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
23700 ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
23701 with @samp{l} (lower-case el, for @dfn{last}).
23702
23703 @item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
23704 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
23705 @cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
23706 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
23707 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
23708
23709 @var{thread-id} is the (big endian, hex encoded) thread id associated with the
23710 thread for which to fetch the TLS address.
23711
23712 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
23713 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
23714 information associated with the variable.)
23715
23716 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the
23717 the load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
23718 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
23719 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
23720 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
23721 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
23722
23723 Reply:
23724 @table @samp
23725 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
23726 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
23727 local storage requested.
23728
23729 @item E @var{nn}
23730 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
23731
23732 @item
23733 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
23734 @end table
23735
23736 @item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
23737 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
23738 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
23739 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
23740 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
23741 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
23742 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
23743
23744 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
23745
23746 Reply:
23747 @table @samp
23748 @item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
23749 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
23750 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
23751 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
23752 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
23753 is a sequence of thread IDs from the target. @var{threadid} (eight hex
23754 digits). See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
23755 @end table
23756
23757 @item qOffsets
23758 @cindex section offsets, remote request
23759 @cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
23760 Get section offsets that the target used when relocating the downloaded
23761 image.
23762
23763 Reply:
23764 @table @samp
23765 @item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy}@r{[};Bss=@var{zzz}@r{]}
23766 Relocate the @code{Text} section by @var{xxx} from its original address.
23767 Relocate the @code{Data} section by @var{yyy} from its original address.
23768 If the object file format provides segment information (e.g.@: @sc{elf}
23769 @samp{PT_LOAD} program headers), @value{GDBN} will relocate entire
23770 segments by the supplied offsets.
23771
23772 @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset may be included in the response,
23773 @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data} offset
23774 to the @code{Bss} section.}
23775
23776 @item TextSeg=@var{xxx}@r{[};DataSeg=@var{yyy}@r{]}
23777 Relocate the first segment of the object file, which conventionally
23778 contains program code, to a starting address of @var{xxx}. If
23779 @samp{DataSeg} is specified, relocate the second segment, which
23780 conventionally contains modifiable data, to a starting address of
23781 @var{yyy}. @value{GDBN} will report an error if the object file
23782 does not contain segment information, or does not contain at least
23783 as many segments as mentioned in the reply. Extra segments are
23784 kept at fixed offsets relative to the last relocated segment.
23785 @end table
23786
23787 @item qP @var{mode} @var{threadid}
23788 @cindex thread information, remote request
23789 @cindex @samp{qP} packet
23790 Returns information on @var{threadid}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
23791 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{threadid} is a hex encoded 64 bit thread ID.
23792
23793 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
23794 (see below).
23795
23796 Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
23797
23798 @item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
23799 @cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
23800 @cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
23801 @anchor{QPassSignals}
23802 Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
23803 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
23804 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
23805 strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop
23806 the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be
23807 reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
23808 combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
23809 new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
23810 @var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
23811
23812 Reply:
23813 @table @samp
23814 @item OK
23815 The request succeeded.
23816
23817 @item E @var{nn}
23818 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
23819
23820 @item
23821 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
23822 the stub.
23823 @end table
23824
23825 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
23826 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
23827 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
23828 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
23829
23830 @item qRcmd,@var{command}
23831 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
23832 @cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
23833 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
23834 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
23835 string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
23836 with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
23837 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
23838 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
23839
23840 Reply:
23841 @table @samp
23842 @item OK
23843 A command response with no output.
23844 @item @var{OUTPUT}
23845 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
23846 @item E @var{NN}
23847 Indicate a badly formed request.
23848 @item
23849 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
23850 @end table
23851
23852 (Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
23853 command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
23854 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
23855 packets.)
23856
23857 @item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
23858 @cindex supported packets, remote query
23859 @cindex features of the remote protocol
23860 @cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
23861 @anchor{qSupported}
23862 Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
23863 query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
23864 @value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
23865 features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
23866 at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
23867 packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
23868 high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
23869 be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
23870 stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
23871 automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
23872 reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
23873 unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
23874 helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
23875 versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
23876
23877 Reply:
23878 @table @samp
23879 @item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
23880 The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
23881 depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
23882 possible forms).
23883 @item
23884 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
23885 or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
23886 @end table
23887
23888 The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
23889 @samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
23890 are:
23891
23892 @table @samp
23893 @item @var{name}=@var{value}
23894 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
23895 with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
23896 on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
23897 @item @var{name}+
23898 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
23899 need an associated value.
23900 @item @var{name}-
23901 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
23902 @item @var{name}?
23903 The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
23904 @value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
23905 needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
23906 but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
23907 @end table
23908
23909 Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
23910 supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
23911 request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
23912 state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
23913 a different version of @value{GDBN}.
23914
23915 No values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
23916 are defined yet. Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
23917 @var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
23918 packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
23919 versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Values
23920 for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
23921 advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
23922 improvements in the remote protocol---support for unlimited length
23923 responses would be a @var{gdbfeature} example, if it were not implied by
23924 the @samp{qSupported} query. The stub's reply should be independent
23925 of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
23926 describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
23927 all the features it supports.
23928
23929 Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
23930 responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
23931
23932 Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
23933 should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
23934 require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
23935 form response.
23936
23937 Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
23938 @samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
23939 in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
23940 stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
23941
23942 Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
23943 mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
23944 architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
23945 about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
23946 stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
23947
23948 These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
23949
23950 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.2 0.12 0.2
23951 @c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
23952 @c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
23953 @item Feature Name
23954 @tab Value Required
23955 @tab Default
23956 @tab Probe Allowed
23957
23958 @item @samp{PacketSize}
23959 @tab Yes
23960 @tab @samp{-}
23961 @tab No
23962
23963 @item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
23964 @tab No
23965 @tab @samp{-}
23966 @tab Yes
23967
23968 @item @samp{qXfer:features:read}
23969 @tab No
23970 @tab @samp{-}
23971 @tab Yes
23972
23973 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
23974 @tab No
23975 @tab @samp{-}
23976 @tab Yes
23977
23978 @item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
23979 @tab No
23980 @tab @samp{-}
23981 @tab Yes
23982
23983 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:read}
23984 @tab No
23985 @tab @samp{-}
23986 @tab Yes
23987
23988 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:write}
23989 @tab No
23990 @tab @samp{-}
23991 @tab Yes
23992
23993 @item @samp{QPassSignals}
23994 @tab No
23995 @tab @samp{-}
23996 @tab Yes
23997
23998 @end multitable
23999
24000 These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
24001
24002 @table @samp
24003 @cindex packet size, remote protocol
24004 @item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
24005 The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
24006 length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
24007 transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
24008 data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
24009 There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
24010 stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
24011 byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
24012 @value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
24013
24014 @item qXfer:auxv:read
24015 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
24016 (@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
24017
24018 @item qXfer:features:read
24019 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet
24020 (@pxref{qXfer target description read}).
24021
24022 @item qXfer:libraries:read
24023 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet
24024 (@pxref{qXfer library list read}).
24025
24026 @item qXfer:memory-map:read
24027 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet
24028 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}).
24029
24030 @item qXfer:spu:read
24031 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:read} packet
24032 (@pxref{qXfer spu read}).
24033
24034 @item qXfer:spu:write
24035 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:write} packet
24036 (@pxref{qXfer spu write}).
24037
24038 @item QPassSignals
24039 The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet
24040 (@pxref{QPassSignals}).
24041
24042 @end table
24043
24044 @item qSymbol::
24045 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
24046 @cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
24047 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
24048 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
24049
24050 Reply:
24051 @table @samp
24052 @item OK
24053 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
24054 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
24055 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
24056 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
24057 @samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
24058 below.
24059 @end table
24060
24061 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
24062 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
24063
24064 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
24065 target has previously requested.
24066
24067 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
24068 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
24069 will be empty.
24070
24071 Reply:
24072 @table @samp
24073 @item OK
24074 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
24075 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
24076 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
24077 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
24078 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
24079 @end table
24080
24081 @item QTDP
24082 @itemx QTFrame
24083 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
24084
24085 @item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{id}
24086 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
24087 @cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
24088 Obtain a printable string description of a thread's attributes from
24089 the target OS. @var{id} is a thread-id in big-endian hex. This
24090 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
24091 for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
24092 displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
24093 examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
24094 @samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
24095
24096 Reply:
24097 @table @samp
24098 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
24099 Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
24100 comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
24101 the thread's attributes.
24102 @end table
24103
24104 (Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
24105 the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
24106 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
24107 packets.)
24108
24109 @item QTStart
24110 @itemx QTStop
24111 @itemx QTinit
24112 @itemx QTro
24113 @itemx qTStatus
24114 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
24115
24116 @item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
24117 @cindex read special object, remote request
24118 @cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
24119 @anchor{qXfer read}
24120 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
24121 identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
24122 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
24123 encoding of @var{annex} is specific to @var{object}; it can supply
24124 additional details about what data to access.
24125
24126 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
24127 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
24128 formats, listed below.
24129
24130 @table @samp
24131 @item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
24132 @anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
24133 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
24134 auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
24135
24136 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
24137 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
24138
24139 @item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
24140 @anchor{qXfer target description read}
24141 Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The
24142 annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is
24143 always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex.
24144
24145 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
24146 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
24147
24148 @item qXfer:libraries:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
24149 @anchor{qXfer library list read}
24150 Access the target's list of loaded libraries. @xref{Library List Format}.
24151 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
24152 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
24153
24154 Targets which maintain a list of libraries in the program's memory do
24155 not need to implement this packet; it is designed for platforms where
24156 the operating system manages the list of loaded libraries.
24157
24158 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
24159 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
24160
24161 @item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
24162 @anchor{qXfer memory map read}
24163 Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory Map Format}. The
24164 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
24165 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
24166
24167 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
24168 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
24169
24170 @item qXfer:spu:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
24171 @anchor{qXfer spu read}
24172 Read contents of an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
24173 annex specifies which file to read; it must be of the form
24174 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
24175 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
24176 in that context to be accessed.
24177
24178 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
24179 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
24180 @end table
24181
24182 Reply:
24183 @table @samp
24184 @item m @var{data}
24185 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
24186 target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
24187 it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
24188 block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
24189 @var{data} may have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
24190 request.
24191
24192 @item l @var{data}
24193 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
24194 There is no more data to be read. @var{data} may have fewer bytes
24195 than the @var{length} in the request.
24196
24197 @item l
24198 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
24199 There is no more data to be read.
24200
24201 @item E00
24202 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
24203
24204 @item E @var{nn}
24205 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
24206 @var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
24207
24208 @item
24209 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
24210 the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
24211 @end table
24212
24213 @item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
24214 @cindex write data into object, remote request
24215 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
24216 identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
24217 into the data. @var{data}@dots{} is the binary-encoded data
24218 (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be written. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
24219 is specific to @var{object}; it can supply additional details about what data
24220 to access.
24221
24222 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
24223 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:write:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
24224 formats, listed below.
24225
24226 @table @samp
24227 @item qXfer:@var{spu}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
24228 @anchor{qXfer spu write}
24229 Write @var{data} to an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
24230 annex specifies which file to write; it must be of the form
24231 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
24232 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
24233 in that context to be accessed.
24234
24235 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
24236 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
24237 @end table
24238
24239 Reply:
24240 @table @samp
24241 @item @var{nn}
24242 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
24243 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
24244
24245 @item E00
24246 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
24247
24248 @item E @var{nn}
24249 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
24250 @var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
24251
24252 @item
24253 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
24254 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
24255 @end table
24256
24257 @item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
24258 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
24259 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
24260 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
24261 must respond with an empty packet.
24262
24263 @end table
24264
24265 @node Register Packet Format
24266 @section Register Packet Format
24267
24268 The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
24269 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
24270 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
24271 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
24272 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
24273 most-significant - least-significant.
24274
24275 @table @r
24276
24277 @item MIPS32
24278
24279 All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
24280 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
24281 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
24282
24283 @item MIPS64
24284
24285 All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
24286 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
24287 as @code{MIPS32}.
24288
24289 @end table
24290
24291 @node Tracepoint Packets
24292 @section Tracepoint Packets
24293 @cindex tracepoint packets
24294 @cindex packets, tracepoint
24295
24296 Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
24297 tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
24298
24299 @table @samp
24300
24301 @item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}@r{[}-@r{]}
24302 Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
24303 is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
24304 the tracepoint is disabled. @var{step} is the tracepoint's step
24305 count, and @var{pass} is its pass count. If the trailing @samp{-} is
24306 present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this
24307 tracepoint's actions.
24308
24309 Replies:
24310 @table @samp
24311 @item OK
24312 The packet was understood and carried out.
24313 @item
24314 The packet was not recognized.
24315 @end table
24316
24317 @item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
24318 Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. @var{n} and
24319 @var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
24320 this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
24321 another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
24322 trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
24323 specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
24324
24325 In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
24326 can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
24327 is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
24328 actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
24329 taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
24330 @samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
24331 tracepoint actions.
24332
24333 The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
24334 actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
24335 following forms:
24336
24337 @table @samp
24338
24339 @item R @var{mask}
24340 Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask}. @var{mask} is
24341 a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
24342 @var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
24343 zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
24344 not fit in a 32-bit word.
24345
24346 @item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
24347 Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
24348 number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
24349 @samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
24350 address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
24351 @var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
24352 values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
24353
24354 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
24355 Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
24356 it directs. @var{expr} is an agent expression, as described in
24357 @ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
24358 two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
24359 in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
24360 packet).
24361
24362 @end table
24363
24364 Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
24365 packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
24366 length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
24367 action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
24368 actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
24369 must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
24370 ``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
24371 separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
24372
24373 Replies:
24374 @table @samp
24375 @item OK
24376 The packet was understood and carried out.
24377 @item
24378 The packet was not recognized.
24379 @end table
24380
24381 @item QTFrame:@var{n}
24382 Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
24383 register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
24384 request packets from @value{GDBN}.
24385
24386 A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
24387 requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
24388 without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
24389 one of the following forms:
24390
24391 @table @samp
24392 @item F @var{f}
24393 The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
24394 @var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
24395 was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
24396
24397 @item T @var{t}
24398 The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
24399 @var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
24400
24401 @end table
24402
24403 @item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
24404 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
24405 currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
24406 @var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
24407
24408 @item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
24409 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
24410 currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
24411 is a hexadecimal number.
24412
24413 @item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
24414 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
24415 currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
24416 and @var{end} (exclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
24417 numbers.
24418
24419 @item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
24420 Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
24421 frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses.
24422
24423 @item QTStart
24424 Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from tracepoint
24425 hits in the trace frame buffer.
24426
24427 @item QTStop
24428 End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
24429
24430 @item QTinit
24431 Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
24432
24433 @item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
24434 Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
24435 will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
24436 if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
24437
24438 @value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
24439 containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
24440 still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
24441 there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
24442
24443 @item qTStatus
24444 Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
24445
24446 Replies:
24447 @table @samp
24448 @item T0
24449 There is no trace experiment running.
24450 @item T1
24451 There is a trace experiment running.
24452 @end table
24453
24454 @end table
24455
24456
24457 @node Interrupts
24458 @section Interrupts
24459 @cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
24460
24461 When a program on the remote target is running, @value{GDBN} may
24462 attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C} or a @code{BREAK},
24463 control of which is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{remotebreak}
24464 setting (@pxref{set remotebreak}).
24465
24466 The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
24467 mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does
24468 not currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
24469 interfaces.
24470
24471 @samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
24472 transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
24473 @code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
24474 the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
24475 transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
24476 and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
24477 (@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
24478 @code{0x03} as part of its packet.
24479
24480 Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
24481 precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
24482 implementation defined. If the stub is successful at interrupting the
24483 running program, it is expected that it will send one of the Stop
24484 Reply Packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
24485 of successfully stopping the program. Interrupts received while the
24486 program is stopped will be discarded.
24487
24488 @node Examples
24489 @section Examples
24490
24491 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
24492 does not get any direct output:
24493
24494 @smallexample
24495 -> @code{R00}
24496 <- @code{+}
24497 @emph{target restarts}
24498 -> @code{?}
24499 <- @code{+}
24500 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
24501 -> @code{+}
24502 @end smallexample
24503
24504 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
24505
24506 @smallexample
24507 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
24508 <- @code{+}
24509 -> @code{s}
24510 <- @code{+}
24511 @emph{time passes}
24512 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
24513 -> @code{+}
24514 -> @code{g}
24515 <- @code{+}
24516 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
24517 -> @code{+}
24518 @end smallexample
24519
24520 @node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
24521 @section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
24522 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
24523
24524 @menu
24525 * File-I/O Overview::
24526 * Protocol Basics::
24527 * The F Request Packet::
24528 * The F Reply Packet::
24529 * The Ctrl-C Message::
24530 * Console I/O::
24531 * List of Supported Calls::
24532 * Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes::
24533 * Constants::
24534 * File-I/O Examples::
24535 @end menu
24536
24537 @node File-I/O Overview
24538 @subsection File-I/O Overview
24539 @cindex file-i/o overview
24540
24541 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
24542 target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
24543 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
24544 remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
24545 actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
24546 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
24547
24548 The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
24549 It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
24550 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
24551 translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
24552 protocol representations when data is transmitted.
24553
24554 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
24555 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
24556 or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
24557 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
24558 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
24559 the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
24560 (@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
24561
24562 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
24563 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
24564 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
24565 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
24566 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
24567
24568 @smallexample
24569 (@value{GDBP}) continue
24570 <- target requests 'system call X'
24571 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
24572 -> @value{GDBN} returns result
24573 ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target
24574 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
24575 @end smallexample
24576
24577 The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
24578 the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
24579 named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
24580 system are not supported by this protocol.
24581
24582 @node Protocol Basics
24583 @subsection Protocol Basics
24584 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
24585
24586 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
24587 as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
24588 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
24589 the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
24590 of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
24591 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
24592 to call the appropriate host system call:
24593
24594 @itemize @bullet
24595 @item
24596 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
24597
24598 @item
24599 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
24600 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
24601 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
24602 Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation.
24603
24604 @end itemize
24605
24606 At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
24607
24608 @itemize @bullet
24609 @item
24610 If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
24611 system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
24612 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
24613 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
24614 packet.
24615
24616 @item
24617 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
24618 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
24619
24620 @item
24621 @value{GDBN} calls the system call.
24622
24623 @item
24624 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
24625
24626 @item
24627 If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
24628 by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
24629 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
24630 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
24631 packet.
24632
24633 @end itemize
24634
24635 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
24636 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
24637
24638 @itemize @bullet
24639 @item
24640 Return value.
24641
24642 @item
24643 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
24644
24645 @item
24646 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
24647
24648 @end itemize
24649
24650 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
24651 the latest continue or step action.
24652
24653 @node The F Request Packet
24654 @subsection The @code{F} Request Packet
24655 @cindex file-i/o request packet
24656 @cindex @code{F} request packet
24657
24658 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
24659
24660 @table @samp
24661 @item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
24662
24663 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
24664 This is just the name of the function.
24665
24666 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
24667 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
24668 of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
24669 datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
24670 of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
24671 comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
24672 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
24673
24674 @end table
24675
24676
24677
24678 @node The F Reply Packet
24679 @subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet
24680 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
24681 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
24682
24683 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
24684
24685 @table @samp
24686
24687 @item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific attachment}
24688
24689 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
24690
24691 @var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific
24692 representation.
24693 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
24694
24695 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
24696 case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
24697 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
24698
24699 @smallexample
24700 F0,0,C
24701 @end smallexample
24702
24703 @noindent
24704 or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
24705
24706 @smallexample
24707 F-1,4,C
24708 @end smallexample
24709
24710 @noindent
24711 assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
24712
24713 @end table
24714
24715
24716 @node The Ctrl-C Message
24717 @subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message
24718 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
24719
24720 If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
24721 reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}),
24722 the target should behave as if it had
24723 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
24724 interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
24725 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
24726 packet.
24727
24728 It's important for the target to know in which
24729 state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
24730
24731 @itemize @bullet
24732 @item
24733 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
24734
24735 @item
24736 The system call on the host has been finished.
24737
24738 @end itemize
24739
24740 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
24741 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
24742 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
24743 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
24744 system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
24745 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
24746
24747 @value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
24748 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
24749 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
24750 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
24751 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
24752 The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
24753 or the full action has been completed.
24754
24755 @node Console I/O
24756 @subsection Console I/O
24757 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
24758
24759 By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file
24760 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
24761 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
24762 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
24763 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
24764 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
24765 conditions is met:
24766
24767 @itemize @bullet
24768 @item
24769 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
24770 @code{read}
24771 system call is treated as finished.
24772
24773 @item
24774 The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
24775 newline.
24776
24777 @item
24778 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
24779 character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
24780
24781 @end itemize
24782
24783 If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
24784 the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
24785 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
24786 is stopped at the user's request.
24787
24788
24789 @node List of Supported Calls
24790 @subsection List of Supported Calls
24791 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
24792
24793 @menu
24794 * open::
24795 * close::
24796 * read::
24797 * write::
24798 * lseek::
24799 * rename::
24800 * unlink::
24801 * stat/fstat::
24802 * gettimeofday::
24803 * isatty::
24804 * system::
24805 @end menu
24806
24807 @node open
24808 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
24809 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
24810
24811 @table @asis
24812 @item Synopsis:
24813 @smallexample
24814 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
24815 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
24816 @end smallexample
24817
24818 @item Request:
24819 @samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
24820
24821 @noindent
24822 @var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
24823
24824 @table @code
24825 @item O_CREAT
24826 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
24827 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
24828 are concerned.
24829
24830 @item O_EXCL
24831 When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
24832 an error and open() fails.
24833
24834 @item O_TRUNC
24835 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
24836 writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
24837 truncated to zero length.
24838
24839 @item O_APPEND
24840 The file is opened in append mode.
24841
24842 @item O_RDONLY
24843 The file is opened for reading only.
24844
24845 @item O_WRONLY
24846 The file is opened for writing only.
24847
24848 @item O_RDWR
24849 The file is opened for reading and writing.
24850 @end table
24851
24852 @noindent
24853 Other bits are silently ignored.
24854
24855
24856 @noindent
24857 @var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
24858
24859 @table @code
24860 @item S_IRUSR
24861 User has read permission.
24862
24863 @item S_IWUSR
24864 User has write permission.
24865
24866 @item S_IRGRP
24867 Group has read permission.
24868
24869 @item S_IWGRP
24870 Group has write permission.
24871
24872 @item S_IROTH
24873 Others have read permission.
24874
24875 @item S_IWOTH
24876 Others have write permission.
24877 @end table
24878
24879 @noindent
24880 Other bits are silently ignored.
24881
24882
24883 @item Return value:
24884 @code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
24885 occurred.
24886
24887 @item Errors:
24888
24889 @table @code
24890 @item EEXIST
24891 @var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
24892
24893 @item EISDIR
24894 @var{pathname} refers to a directory.
24895
24896 @item EACCES
24897 The requested access is not allowed.
24898
24899 @item ENAMETOOLONG
24900 @var{pathname} was too long.
24901
24902 @item ENOENT
24903 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
24904
24905 @item ENODEV
24906 @var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
24907
24908 @item EROFS
24909 @var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
24910 write access was requested.
24911
24912 @item EFAULT
24913 @var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
24914
24915 @item ENOSPC
24916 No space on device to create the file.
24917
24918 @item EMFILE
24919 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
24920
24921 @item ENFILE
24922 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
24923 has been reached.
24924
24925 @item EINTR
24926 The call was interrupted by the user.
24927 @end table
24928
24929 @end table
24930
24931 @node close
24932 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
24933 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
24934
24935 @table @asis
24936 @item Synopsis:
24937 @smallexample
24938 int close(int fd);
24939 @end smallexample
24940
24941 @item Request:
24942 @samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
24943
24944 @item Return value:
24945 @code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
24946
24947 @item Errors:
24948
24949 @table @code
24950 @item EBADF
24951 @var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
24952
24953 @item EINTR
24954 The call was interrupted by the user.
24955 @end table
24956
24957 @end table
24958
24959 @node read
24960 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
24961 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
24962
24963 @table @asis
24964 @item Synopsis:
24965 @smallexample
24966 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
24967 @end smallexample
24968
24969 @item Request:
24970 @samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
24971
24972 @item Return value:
24973 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
24974 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
24975 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
24976
24977 @item Errors:
24978
24979 @table @code
24980 @item EBADF
24981 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
24982 reading.
24983
24984 @item EFAULT
24985 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
24986
24987 @item EINTR
24988 The call was interrupted by the user.
24989 @end table
24990
24991 @end table
24992
24993 @node write
24994 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
24995 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
24996
24997 @table @asis
24998 @item Synopsis:
24999 @smallexample
25000 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
25001 @end smallexample
25002
25003 @item Request:
25004 @samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
25005
25006 @item Return value:
25007 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
25008 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
25009 is returned.
25010
25011 @item Errors:
25012
25013 @table @code
25014 @item EBADF
25015 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
25016 writing.
25017
25018 @item EFAULT
25019 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
25020
25021 @item EFBIG
25022 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
25023 host-specific maximum file size allowed.
25024
25025 @item ENOSPC
25026 No space on device to write the data.
25027
25028 @item EINTR
25029 The call was interrupted by the user.
25030 @end table
25031
25032 @end table
25033
25034 @node lseek
25035 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
25036 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
25037
25038 @table @asis
25039 @item Synopsis:
25040 @smallexample
25041 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
25042 @end smallexample
25043
25044 @item Request:
25045 @samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
25046
25047 @var{flag} is one of:
25048
25049 @table @code
25050 @item SEEK_SET
25051 The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
25052
25053 @item SEEK_CUR
25054 The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
25055 bytes.
25056
25057 @item SEEK_END
25058 The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
25059 bytes.
25060 @end table
25061
25062 @item Return value:
25063 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
25064 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
25065 value of -1 is returned.
25066
25067 @item Errors:
25068
25069 @table @code
25070 @item EBADF
25071 @var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
25072
25073 @item ESPIPE
25074 @var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
25075
25076 @item EINVAL
25077 @var{flag} is not a proper value.
25078
25079 @item EINTR
25080 The call was interrupted by the user.
25081 @end table
25082
25083 @end table
25084
25085 @node rename
25086 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
25087 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
25088
25089 @table @asis
25090 @item Synopsis:
25091 @smallexample
25092 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
25093 @end smallexample
25094
25095 @item Request:
25096 @samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
25097
25098 @item Return value:
25099 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
25100
25101 @item Errors:
25102
25103 @table @code
25104 @item EISDIR
25105 @var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
25106 directory.
25107
25108 @item EEXIST
25109 @var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
25110
25111 @item EBUSY
25112 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
25113 process.
25114
25115 @item EINVAL
25116 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
25117 of itself.
25118
25119 @item ENOTDIR
25120 A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
25121 path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
25122 and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
25123
25124 @item EFAULT
25125 @var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
25126
25127 @item EACCES
25128 No access to the file or the path of the file.
25129
25130 @item ENAMETOOLONG
25131
25132 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
25133
25134 @item ENOENT
25135 A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
25136
25137 @item EROFS
25138 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
25139
25140 @item ENOSPC
25141 The device containing the file has no room for the new
25142 directory entry.
25143
25144 @item EINTR
25145 The call was interrupted by the user.
25146 @end table
25147
25148 @end table
25149
25150 @node unlink
25151 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
25152 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
25153
25154 @table @asis
25155 @item Synopsis:
25156 @smallexample
25157 int unlink(const char *pathname);
25158 @end smallexample
25159
25160 @item Request:
25161 @samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
25162
25163 @item Return value:
25164 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
25165
25166 @item Errors:
25167
25168 @table @code
25169 @item EACCES
25170 No access to the file or the path of the file.
25171
25172 @item EPERM
25173 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
25174
25175 @item EBUSY
25176 The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
25177 being used by another process.
25178
25179 @item EFAULT
25180 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
25181
25182 @item ENAMETOOLONG
25183 @var{pathname} was too long.
25184
25185 @item ENOENT
25186 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
25187
25188 @item ENOTDIR
25189 A component of the path is not a directory.
25190
25191 @item EROFS
25192 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
25193
25194 @item EINTR
25195 The call was interrupted by the user.
25196 @end table
25197
25198 @end table
25199
25200 @node stat/fstat
25201 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
25202 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
25203 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
25204
25205 @table @asis
25206 @item Synopsis:
25207 @smallexample
25208 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
25209 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
25210 @end smallexample
25211
25212 @item Request:
25213 @samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
25214 @samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
25215
25216 @item Return value:
25217 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
25218
25219 @item Errors:
25220
25221 @table @code
25222 @item EBADF
25223 @var{fd} is not a valid open file.
25224
25225 @item ENOENT
25226 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
25227 path is an empty string.
25228
25229 @item ENOTDIR
25230 A component of the path is not a directory.
25231
25232 @item EFAULT
25233 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
25234
25235 @item EACCES
25236 No access to the file or the path of the file.
25237
25238 @item ENAMETOOLONG
25239 @var{pathname} was too long.
25240
25241 @item EINTR
25242 The call was interrupted by the user.
25243 @end table
25244
25245 @end table
25246
25247 @node gettimeofday
25248 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
25249 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
25250
25251 @table @asis
25252 @item Synopsis:
25253 @smallexample
25254 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
25255 @end smallexample
25256
25257 @item Request:
25258 @samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
25259
25260 @item Return value:
25261 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
25262
25263 @item Errors:
25264
25265 @table @code
25266 @item EINVAL
25267 @var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
25268
25269 @item EFAULT
25270 @var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
25271 @end table
25272
25273 @end table
25274
25275 @node isatty
25276 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
25277 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
25278
25279 @table @asis
25280 @item Synopsis:
25281 @smallexample
25282 int isatty(int fd);
25283 @end smallexample
25284
25285 @item Request:
25286 @samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
25287
25288 @item Return value:
25289 Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
25290
25291 @item Errors:
25292
25293 @table @code
25294 @item EINTR
25295 The call was interrupted by the user.
25296 @end table
25297
25298 @end table
25299
25300 Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
25301 1 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
25302 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
25303 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
25304 needed.
25305
25306
25307 @node system
25308 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
25309 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
25310
25311 @table @asis
25312 @item Synopsis:
25313 @smallexample
25314 int system(const char *command);
25315 @end smallexample
25316
25317 @item Request:
25318 @samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
25319
25320 @item Return value:
25321 If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
25322 available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
25323 For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
25324 return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
25325 command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
25326 return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
25327 @file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
25328
25329 @item Errors:
25330
25331 @table @code
25332 @item EINTR
25333 The call was interrupted by the user.
25334 @end table
25335
25336 @end table
25337
25338 @value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
25339 to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
25340 the host is simplified before it's returned
25341 to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
25342 is discarded, and the return value consists
25343 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
25344
25345 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
25346 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
25347 @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
25348
25349 @table @code
25350 @item set remote system-call-allowed
25351 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
25352 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
25353 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
25354
25355 @item show remote system-call-allowed
25356 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
25357 Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
25358 protocol.
25359 @end table
25360
25361 @node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
25362 @subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
25363 @cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
25364
25365 @menu
25366 * Integral Datatypes::
25367 * Pointer Values::
25368 * Memory Transfer::
25369 * struct stat::
25370 * struct timeval::
25371 @end menu
25372
25373 @node Integral Datatypes
25374 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes
25375 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
25376
25377 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
25378 @code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
25379 @code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
25380
25381 @code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
25382 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
25383
25384 @code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
25385
25386 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
25387 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
25388
25389 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
25390
25391 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
25392 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
25393 byte order.
25394
25395 @node Pointer Values
25396 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values
25397 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
25398
25399 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
25400 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
25401 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
25402 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
25403
25404 @smallexample
25405 @code{1aaf/12}
25406 @end smallexample
25407
25408 @noindent
25409 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
25410 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
25411 the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
25412 at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
25413
25414 @smallexample
25415 @code{123456/d}
25416 @end smallexample
25417
25418 @node Memory Transfer
25419 @unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer
25420 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
25421
25422 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
25423 example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format
25424 with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
25425 this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
25426 packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
25427 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
25428 data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
25429
25430
25431 @node struct stat
25432 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
25433 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
25434
25435 The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
25436 is defined as follows:
25437
25438 @smallexample
25439 struct stat @{
25440 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
25441 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
25442 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
25443 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
25444 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
25445 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
25446 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
25447 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
25448 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
25449 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
25450 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
25451 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
25452 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
25453 @};
25454 @end smallexample
25455
25456 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
25457 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
25458 structure is of size 64 bytes.
25459
25460 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
25461 range of values.
25462
25463 @table @code
25464
25465 @item st_dev
25466 A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
25467
25468 @item st_ino
25469 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
25470
25471 @item st_mode
25472 Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
25473 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
25474
25475 @item st_uid
25476 @itemx st_gid
25477 @itemx st_rdev
25478 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
25479
25480 @item st_atime
25481 @itemx st_mtime
25482 @itemx st_ctime
25483 These values have a host and file system dependent
25484 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
25485 support exact timing values.
25486 @end table
25487
25488 The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
25489 responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
25490 continuing.
25491
25492 Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
25493 representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
25494 get truncated on the target.
25495
25496 @node struct timeval
25497 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
25498 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
25499
25500 The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
25501 is defined as follows:
25502
25503 @smallexample
25504 struct timeval @{
25505 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
25506 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
25507 @};
25508 @end smallexample
25509
25510 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
25511 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
25512 structure is of size 8 bytes.
25513
25514 @node Constants
25515 @subsection Constants
25516 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
25517
25518 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
25519 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
25520 values before and after the call as needed.
25521
25522 @menu
25523 * Open Flags::
25524 * mode_t Values::
25525 * Errno Values::
25526 * Lseek Flags::
25527 * Limits::
25528 @end menu
25529
25530 @node Open Flags
25531 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags
25532 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
25533
25534 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
25535
25536 @smallexample
25537 O_RDONLY 0x0
25538 O_WRONLY 0x1
25539 O_RDWR 0x2
25540 O_APPEND 0x8
25541 O_CREAT 0x200
25542 O_TRUNC 0x400
25543 O_EXCL 0x800
25544 @end smallexample
25545
25546 @node mode_t Values
25547 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values
25548 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
25549
25550 All values are given in octal representation.
25551
25552 @smallexample
25553 S_IFREG 0100000
25554 S_IFDIR 040000
25555 S_IRUSR 0400
25556 S_IWUSR 0200
25557 S_IXUSR 0100
25558 S_IRGRP 040
25559 S_IWGRP 020
25560 S_IXGRP 010
25561 S_IROTH 04
25562 S_IWOTH 02
25563 S_IXOTH 01
25564 @end smallexample
25565
25566 @node Errno Values
25567 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values
25568 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
25569
25570 All values are given in decimal representation.
25571
25572 @smallexample
25573 EPERM 1
25574 ENOENT 2
25575 EINTR 4
25576 EBADF 9
25577 EACCES 13
25578 EFAULT 14
25579 EBUSY 16
25580 EEXIST 17
25581 ENODEV 19
25582 ENOTDIR 20
25583 EISDIR 21
25584 EINVAL 22
25585 ENFILE 23
25586 EMFILE 24
25587 EFBIG 27
25588 ENOSPC 28
25589 ESPIPE 29
25590 EROFS 30
25591 ENAMETOOLONG 91
25592 EUNKNOWN 9999
25593 @end smallexample
25594
25595 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
25596 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
25597
25598 @node Lseek Flags
25599 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags
25600 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
25601
25602 @smallexample
25603 SEEK_SET 0
25604 SEEK_CUR 1
25605 SEEK_END 2
25606 @end smallexample
25607
25608 @node Limits
25609 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
25610 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
25611
25612 All values are given in decimal representation.
25613
25614 @smallexample
25615 INT_MIN -2147483648
25616 INT_MAX 2147483647
25617 UINT_MAX 4294967295
25618 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
25619 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
25620 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
25621 @end smallexample
25622
25623 @node File-I/O Examples
25624 @subsection File-I/O Examples
25625 @cindex file-i/o examples
25626
25627 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
25628 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
25629
25630 @smallexample
25631 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
25632 @emph{request memory read from target}
25633 -> @code{m1234,6}
25634 <- XXXXXX
25635 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
25636 -> @code{F6}
25637 @end smallexample
25638
25639 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
25640 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
25641
25642 @smallexample
25643 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
25644 @emph{request memory write to target}
25645 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
25646 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
25647 -> @code{F6}
25648 @end smallexample
25649
25650 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
25651 file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
25652
25653 @smallexample
25654 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
25655 -> @code{F-1,9}
25656 @end smallexample
25657
25658 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
25659 host is called:
25660
25661 @smallexample
25662 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
25663 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
25664 <- @code{T02}
25665 @end smallexample
25666
25667 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
25668 host is called:
25669
25670 @smallexample
25671 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
25672 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
25673 <- @code{T02}
25674 @end smallexample
25675
25676 @node Library List Format
25677 @section Library List Format
25678 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
25679
25680 On some platforms, a dynamic loader (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) runs in the
25681 same process as your application to manage libraries. In this case,
25682 @value{GDBN} can use the loader's symbol table and normal memory
25683 operations to maintain a list of shared libraries. On other
25684 platforms, the operating system manages loaded libraries.
25685 @value{GDBN} can not retrieve the list of currently loaded libraries
25686 through memory operations, so it uses the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
25687 packet (@pxref{qXfer library list read}) instead. The remote stub
25688 queries the target's operating system and reports which libraries
25689 are loaded.
25690
25691 The @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet returns an XML document which
25692 lists loaded libraries and their offsets. Each library has an
25693 associated name and one or more segment base addresses, which report
25694 where the library was loaded in memory. The segment bases are start
25695 addresses, not relocation offsets; they do not depend on the library's
25696 link-time base addresses.
25697
25698 A simple memory map, with one loaded library relocated by a single
25699 offset, looks like this:
25700
25701 @smallexample
25702 <library-list>
25703 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6">
25704 <segment address="0x10000000"/>
25705 </library>
25706 </library-list>
25707 @end smallexample
25708
25709 The format of a library list is described by this DTD:
25710
25711 @smallexample
25712 <!-- library-list: Root element with versioning -->
25713 <!ELEMENT library-list (library)*>
25714 <!ATTLIST library-list version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
25715 <!ELEMENT library (segment)*>
25716 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
25717 <!ELEMENT segment EMPTY>
25718 <!ATTLIST segment address CDATA #REQUIRED>
25719 @end smallexample
25720
25721 @node Memory Map Format
25722 @section Memory Map Format
25723 @cindex memory map format
25724
25725 To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
25726 memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
25727 memory map.
25728
25729 The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
25730 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
25731 lists memory regions. The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
25732
25733 @smallexample
25734 <?xml version="1.0"?>
25735 <!DOCTYPE memory-map
25736 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
25737 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
25738 <memory-map>
25739 region...
25740 </memory-map>
25741 @end smallexample
25742
25743 Each region can be either:
25744
25745 @itemize
25746
25747 @item
25748 A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
25749 bytes from there:
25750
25751 @smallexample
25752 <memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
25753 @end smallexample
25754
25755
25756 @item
25757 A region of read-only memory:
25758
25759 @smallexample
25760 <memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
25761 @end smallexample
25762
25763
25764 @item
25765 A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
25766 bytes in length:
25767
25768 @smallexample
25769 <memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
25770 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
25771 </memory>
25772 @end smallexample
25773
25774 @end itemize
25775
25776 Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
25777 by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
25778 packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
25779
25780 The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
25781
25782 @smallexample
25783 <!-- ................................................... -->
25784 <!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
25785 <!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
25786 <!-- .................................... .............. -->
25787 <!-- memory-map.dtd -->
25788 <!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
25789 <!ELEMENT memory-map (memory | property)>
25790 <!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
25791 <!ELEMENT memory (property)>
25792 <!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
25793 and its type, or device. -->
25794 <!ATTLIST memory type CDATA #REQUIRED
25795 start CDATA #REQUIRED
25796 length CDATA #REQUIRED
25797 device CDATA #IMPLIED>
25798 <!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
25799 <!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
25800 <!ATTLIST property name CDATA #REQUIRED>
25801 @end smallexample
25802
25803 @include agentexpr.texi
25804
25805 @node Target Descriptions
25806 @appendix Target Descriptions
25807 @cindex target descriptions
25808
25809 @strong{Warning:} target descriptions are still under active development,
25810 and the contents and format may change between @value{GDBN} releases.
25811 The format is expected to stabilize in the future.
25812
25813 One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems
25814 is that there are so many minor variants of each processor
25815 architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with
25816 a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or MIPS, for example ---
25817 and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some
25818 architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of
25819 vendors. This leads to a number of problems:
25820
25821 @itemize @bullet
25822 @item
25823 With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for
25824 the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes.
25825 @item
25826 Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited
25827 audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every
25828 variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree.
25829 @item
25830 When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system
25831 at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the
25832 @command{set architecture} command can be error-prone.
25833 @end itemize
25834
25835 To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a
25836 target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to
25837 actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support
25838 processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the
25839 descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them.
25840
25841 @value{GDBN} must be compiled with Expat support to support XML target
25842 descriptions. @xref{Expat}.
25843
25844 @menu
25845 * Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target.
25846 * Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description.
25847 * Predefined Target Types:: Standard types available for target
25848 descriptions.
25849 * Standard Target Features:: Features @value{GDBN} knows about.
25850 @end menu
25851
25852 @node Retrieving Descriptions
25853 @section Retrieving Descriptions
25854
25855 Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or
25856 specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the
25857 description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote
25858 protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets,
25859 qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be
25860 @samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an
25861 XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description
25862 Format}.
25863
25864 Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description.
25865 If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to
25866 specify a file are:
25867
25868 @table @code
25869 @cindex set tdesc filename
25870 @item set tdesc filename @var{path}
25871 Read the target description from @var{path}.
25872
25873 @cindex unset tdesc filename
25874 @item unset tdesc filename
25875 Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN}
25876 will use the description supplied by the current target.
25877
25878 @cindex show tdesc filename
25879 @item show tdesc filename
25880 Show the filename to read for a target description, if any.
25881 @end table
25882
25883
25884 @node Target Description Format
25885 @section Target Description Format
25886 @cindex target descriptions, XML format
25887
25888 A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML}
25889 document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in
25890 the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This
25891 means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to
25892 check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid.
25893 However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for
25894 their targets, we also describe the grammar here.
25895
25896 Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target
25897 and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register
25898 sets. @value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your
25899 target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target.
25900
25901 Here is a simple target description:
25902
25903 @smallexample
25904 <target version="1.0">
25905 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
25906 </target>
25907 @end smallexample
25908
25909 @noindent
25910 This minimal description only says that the target uses
25911 the x86-64 architecture.
25912
25913 A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking
25914 optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements. The elements
25915 are explained further below.
25916
25917 @smallexample
25918 <?xml version="1.0"?>
25919 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
25920 <target version="1.0">
25921 @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]}
25922 @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]}
25923 </target>
25924 @end smallexample
25925
25926 @noindent
25927 The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line
25928 breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version
25929 declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted
25930 (@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be
25931 useful for XML validation tools. The @samp{version} attribute for
25932 @samp{<target>} may also be omitted, but we recommend
25933 including it; if future versions of @value{GDBN} use an incompatible
25934 revision of @file{gdb-target.dtd}, they will detect and report
25935 the version mismatch.
25936
25937 @subsection Inclusion
25938 @cindex target descriptions, inclusion
25939 @cindex XInclude
25940 @ifnotinfo
25941 @cindex <xi:include>
25942 @end ifnotinfo
25943
25944 It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into
25945 several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to
25946 share files between different possible target descriptions. You can
25947 divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of
25948 the target description with an inclusion directive of the form:
25949
25950 @smallexample
25951 <xi:include href="@var{document}"/>
25952 @end smallexample
25953
25954 @noindent
25955 When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve
25956 the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with
25957 the contents of that document. If the current description was read
25958 using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document;
25959 @var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the
25960 current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for
25961 @var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the
25962 original description.
25963
25964 @subsection Architecture
25965 @cindex <architecture>
25966
25967 An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form:
25968
25969 @smallexample
25970 <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture>
25971 @end smallexample
25972
25973 @var{arch} is an architecture name from the same selection
25974 accepted by @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a
25975 Debugging Target}).
25976
25977 @subsection Features
25978 @cindex <feature>
25979
25980 Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target
25981 system. Features are currently used to describe available CPU
25982 registers and the types of their contents. A @samp{<feature>} element
25983 has this form:
25984
25985 @smallexample
25986 <feature name="@var{name}">
25987 @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]}
25988 @var{reg}@dots{}
25989 </feature>
25990 @end smallexample
25991
25992 @noindent
25993 Each feature's name should be unique within the description. The name
25994 of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special
25995 knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature
25996 should have its standard name. @xref{Standard Target Features}.
25997
25998 @subsection Types
25999
26000 Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must
26001 interpret. The default interpretation is a two's complement integer,
26002 but other types can be requested by name in the register description.
26003 Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined
26004 Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite types.
26005
26006 Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives
26007 a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type.
26008 Types must be defined before they are used.
26009
26010 @cindex <vector>
26011 Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays
26012 of scalar elements. These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements,
26013 specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements,
26014 @var{count}:
26015
26016 @smallexample
26017 <vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/>
26018 @end smallexample
26019
26020 @cindex <union>
26021 If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it
26022 with a union type containing the useful representations. The
26023 @samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements,
26024 each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}:
26025
26026 @smallexample
26027 <union id="@var{id}">
26028 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
26029 @dots{}
26030 </union>
26031 @end smallexample
26032
26033 @subsection Registers
26034 @cindex <reg>
26035
26036 Each register is represented as an element with this form:
26037
26038 @smallexample
26039 <reg name="@var{name}"
26040 bitsize="@var{size}"
26041 @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]}
26042 @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]}
26043 @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]}
26044 @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/>
26045 @end smallexample
26046
26047 @noindent
26048 The components are as follows:
26049
26050 @table @var
26051
26052 @item name
26053 The register's name; it must be unique within the target description.
26054
26055 @item bitsize
26056 The register's size, in bits.
26057
26058 @item regnum
26059 The register's number. If omitted, a register's number is one greater
26060 than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in
26061 a preceeding feature); the first register in the target description
26062 defaults to zero. This register number is used to read or write
26063 the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P}
26064 packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets
26065 in order of increasing register number.
26066
26067 @item save-restore
26068 Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function
26069 calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}. The default is
26070 @code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for
26071 some system control registers; this is not related to the target's
26072 ABI.
26073
26074 @item type
26075 The type of the register. @var{type} may be a predefined type, a type
26076 defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int}
26077 and @code{float}. @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size
26078 for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the
26079 architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for
26080 @var{bitsize}. The default is @code{int}.
26081
26082 @item group
26083 The register group to which this register belongs. @var{group} must
26084 be either @code{general}, @code{float}, or @code{vector}. If no
26085 @var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register
26086 in @code{info registers}.
26087
26088 @end table
26089
26090 @node Predefined Target Types
26091 @section Predefined Target Types
26092 @cindex target descriptions, predefined types
26093
26094 Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types
26095 from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types. Instead,
26096 standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental
26097 types. The currently supported types are:
26098
26099 @table @code
26100
26101 @item int8
26102 @itemx int16
26103 @itemx int32
26104 @itemx int64
26105 @itemx int128
26106 Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits.
26107
26108 @item uint8
26109 @itemx uint16
26110 @itemx uint32
26111 @itemx uint64
26112 @itemx uint128
26113 Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits.
26114
26115 @item code_ptr
26116 @itemx data_ptr
26117 Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and
26118 any dedicated return address register may be marked as code
26119 pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic
26120 address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers
26121 may be marked as data pointers.
26122
26123 @item ieee_single
26124 Single precision IEEE floating point.
26125
26126 @item ieee_double
26127 Double precision IEEE floating point.
26128
26129 @item arm_fpa_ext
26130 The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers.
26131
26132 @end table
26133
26134 @node Standard Target Features
26135 @section Standard Target Features
26136 @cindex target descriptions, standard features
26137
26138 A target description must contain either no registers or all the
26139 target's registers. If the description contains no registers, then
26140 @value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on
26141 the architecture. If the description contains any registers, the
26142 default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be
26143 described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN}
26144 can recognize them.
26145
26146 This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements
26147 which contain standard registers. @value{GDBN} will look for features
26148 with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers;
26149 if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required
26150 feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target
26151 description. You can add additional registers to any of the
26152 standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if
26153 they were added to an unrecognized feature.
26154
26155 This section lists the known features and their expected contents.
26156 Sample XML documents for these features are included in the
26157 @value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}.
26158
26159 Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the
26160 company or organization which selected the name, and the overall
26161 architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature
26162 containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}.
26163
26164 The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose
26165 of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display
26166 registers using the capitalization used in the description.
26167
26168 @menu
26169 * ARM Features::
26170 * M68K Features::
26171 @end menu
26172
26173
26174 @node ARM Features
26175 @subsection ARM Features
26176 @cindex target descriptions, ARM features
26177
26178 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for ARM targets.
26179 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp},
26180 @samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
26181
26182 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional. If present, it
26183 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}.
26184
26185 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional. If present,
26186 it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and
26187 @samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}. The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon},
26188 @samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional.
26189
26190 @subsection MIPS Features
26191 @cindex target descriptions, MIPS features
26192
26193 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cpu} feature is required for MIPS targets.
26194 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, @samp{lo},
26195 @samp{hi}, and @samp{pc}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending
26196 on the target.
26197
26198 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cp0} feature is also required. It should
26199 contain at least the @samp{status}, @samp{badvaddr}, and @samp{cause}
26200 registers. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
26201
26202 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.fpu} feature is currently required, though
26203 it may be optional in a future version of @value{GDBN}. It should
26204 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fcsr}, and
26205 @samp{fir}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
26206
26207 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.linux} feature is optional. It should
26208 contain a single register, @samp{restart}, which is used by the
26209 Linux kernel to control restartable syscalls.
26210
26211 @node M68K Features
26212 @subsection M68K Features
26213 @cindex target descriptions, M68K features
26214
26215 @table @code
26216 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.m68k.core}
26217 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.core}
26218 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.fido.core}
26219 One of those features must be always present.
26220 The feature that is present determines which flavor of m86k is
26221 used. The feature that is present should contain registers
26222 @samp{d0} through @samp{d7}, @samp{a0} through @samp{a5}, @samp{fp},
26223 @samp{sp}, @samp{ps} and @samp{pc}.
26224
26225 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.fp}
26226 This feature is optional. If present, it should contain registers
26227 @samp{fp0} through @samp{fp7}, @samp{fpcontrol}, @samp{fpstatus} and
26228 @samp{fpiaddr}.
26229 @end table
26230
26231 @subsection PowerPC Features
26232 @cindex target descriptions, PowerPC features
26233
26234 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} feature is required for PowerPC
26235 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
26236 @samp{pc}, @samp{msr}, @samp{cr}, @samp{lr}, @samp{ctr}, and
26237 @samp{xer}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
26238
26239 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} feature is optional. It should
26240 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31} and @samp{fpscr}.
26241
26242 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec} feature is optional. It should
26243 contain registers @samp{vr0} through @samp{vr31}, @samp{vscr},
26244 and @samp{vrsave}.
26245
26246 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.spe} feature is optional. It should
26247 contain registers @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}, @samp{acc}, and
26248 @samp{spefscr}. SPE targets should provide 32-bit registers in
26249 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} and provide the upper halves in
26250 @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}. @value{GDBN} will combine
26251 these to present registers @samp{ev0} through @samp{ev31} to the
26252 user.
26253
26254 @include gpl.texi
26255
26256 @raisesections
26257 @include fdl.texi
26258 @lowersections
26259
26260 @node Index
26261 @unnumbered Index
26262
26263 @printindex cp
26264
26265 @tex
26266 % I think something like @colophon should be in texinfo. In the
26267 % meantime:
26268 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
26269 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
26270 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
26271 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
26272 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
26273 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
26274 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
26275 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
26276 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
26277 \page\colophon
26278 % Blame: doc@cygnus.com, 1991.
26279 @end tex
26280
26281 @bye
This page took 0.632718 seconds and 4 git commands to generate.